Register or Login To Download This Patent As A PDF
| United States Patent Application |
20100081910
|
| Kind Code
|
A1
|
|
Brister; Mark
;   et al.
|
April 1, 2010
|
ANALYTE SENSOR
Abstract
Systems and methods of use for continuous analyte measurement of a host's
vascular system are provided. In some embodiments, a continuous glucose
measurement system includes a vascular access device, a sensor and sensor
electronics, the system being configured for insertion into communication
with a host's circulatory system.
| Inventors: |
Brister; Mark; (Encinitas, CA)
; Shults; Mark; (Madison, WI)
; Saint; Sean; (San Diego, CA)
; Petisce; James R.; (San Clemente, CA)
; Wong; David K.; (Del Mar, CA)
; Woo; Kum Ming; (San Diego, CA)
|
| Correspondence Address:
|
KNOBBE, MARTENS, OLSEN & BEAR, LLP
2040 MAIN STREET, FOURTEENTH FLOOR
IRVINE
CA
92614
US
|
| Assignee: |
DexCom, Inc.
San Diego
CA
|
| Serial No.:
|
630628 |
| Series Code:
|
12
|
| Filed:
|
December 3, 2009 |
| Current U.S. Class: |
600/365 |
| Class at Publication: |
600/365 |
| International Class: |
A61B 5/145 20060101 A61B005/145 |
Claims
1. A method for measuring a concentration of an analyte in a vein of a
host, the method comprising:passing a reference solution at a flow rate
of from about 0.001 ml/min to about 0.02 ml/min past an analyte sensor
configured to measure an analyte concentration, wherein the analyte
sensor is a component of an analyte measuring system comprising a
vascular access device, the analyte sensor, and electronics operatively
connected to the analyte sensor and configured to generate a signal
associated with the analyte concentration, wherein the analyte sensor
resides within the vascular access device, and wherein the vascular
access device and the analyte sensor are in fluid communication with a
vein of a host;measuring a signal associated with an analyte
concentration of the reference solution;drawing back a sample from the
vein of the host; andmeasuring a signal associated with an analyte
concentration of the sample.
2. The method of claim 1, wherein the analyte is glucose, and wherein
measuring the concentration of the analyte comprises measuring a glucose
concentration.
3. The method of claim 1, further comprising repeating passing and
drawing.
4. The method of claim 3, wherein repeating is at least one of
periodically repeating or intermittently repeating.
5. The method of claim 1, further comprising calibrating the analyte
sensor using a baseline measurement obtained from the signal associated
with the analyte concentration of the reference solution.
6. The method of claim 1, further comprising calibrating the analyte
sensor using a sensitivity measurement obtained from the signal
associated with the analyte concentration of the reference solution.
7. The method of claim 1, wherein the vascular access device and the
analyte sensor are configured for fluid communication with a central vein
of the host.
8. The method of claim 1, wherein drawing back a sample comprises drawing
back a sample at a flow rate of from about 0.001 ml/min to about 2
ml/min.
9. A method for measuring a concentration of an analyte in a vein of a
host, the method comprising:passing a reference solution at a first flow
rate controlled by a flow control device past an analyte sensor
configured to measure an analyte concentration, wherein the analyte
sensor is a component of an analyte measuring system comprising a
vascular access device, the analyte sensor, and electronics operatively
connected to the analyte sensor and configured to generate a signal
associated with the analyte concentration, wherein the analyte sensor
resides within the vascular access device, and wherein the vascular
access device and the analyte sensor are in fluid communication with a
vein of a host;measuring a signal associated with an analyte
concentration of the reference solution;drawing back a sample from the
vein of the host at a second flow rate of from about 0.001 ml/min to
about 2 ml/min; andmeasuring a signal associated with an analyte
concentration of the sample, wherein the second flow rate is different
from the first flow rate.
10. The method of claim 9, wherein the second flow rate is from about 0.02
ml/min to about 0.35 ml/min.
11. The method of claim 9, wherein drawing back a sample comprises
substantially blocking mixing of the reference solution and the sample.
12. The method of claim 9, wherein drawing back a sample comprises drawing
back a sample volume of from about 1 .mu.l to about 2 ml from the vein.
13. The method of claim 9, wherein the analyte is glucose, and wherein
measuring the concentration of the analyte comprises measuring a glucose
concentration.
14. The method of claim 9, further comprising repeating passing and
drawing.
15. The method of claim 14, wherein repeating is at least one of
periodically repeating or intermittently repeating.
16. The method of claim 9, further comprising calibrating the analyte
sensor using a baseline measurement obtained from the signal associated
with the analyte concentration of the reference solution.
17. The method of claim 9, further comprising calibrating the analyte
sensor using a sensitivity measurement obtained from the signal
associated with the analyte concentration of the reference solution.
18. The method of claim 9, wherein the vascular access device and the
analyte sensor are configured for fluid communication with a central vein
of the host.
19. The method of claim 9, wherein the first flow rate is from about 0.25
.mu.l/min to about 10 ml/min.
20. The method of claim 9, wherein the first flow rate is from about 0.001
ml/min to about 2 ml/min.
21. A method for measuring a concentration of an analyte in a circulatory
system of a host, the method comprising:passing a reference solution past
an analyte sensor configured to measure an analyte concentration, the
analyte sensor comprising a component of an analyte measuring system
comprising a vascular access device, the analyte sensor, and electronics
operatively connected to the analyte sensor and configured to generate a
signal associated with the analyte concentration, wherein the analyte
sensor resides within the vascular access device, and wherein the
vascular access device and the analyte sensor are in fluid communication
with a circulatory system of a host;measuring a signal associated with an
analyte concentration of the reference solution;drawing back a sample
from the circulatory system; andmeasuring a signal associated with an
analyte concentration of the sample, wherein the analyte measuring system
further comprises a flow control device, wherein the flow control device
is configured to meter flow during passing and drawing, and wherein the
flow control device comprises a valve having a first pinch position and a
second pinch position, wherein the first pinch position and the second
pinch position are configured to at least partially pinch at least a
portion of a tubing through which at least one of the reference solution
is passed or the sample is drawn.
22. The method of claim 21, wherein passing a reference solution comprises
moving the valve from the first position to the second position.
23. The method of claim 21, wherein drawing back a sample comprises moving
the valve from the second position to the first position.
24. The method of claim 21, further comprising keeping the vein open by
metering a flow of the reference solution through the vascular access
device at a predetermined rate.
25. The method of claim 24, wherein metering the flow is controlled at
least in part by a timing of the valve movement between the first
position and the second position.
26. The method of claim 21, wherein the valve meters a volume of at least
one of the reference solution or the sample of from about 1 .mu.l to
about 2 ml during movement between the first pinch position and the
second pinch position.
27. The method of claim 21, wherein the valve meters a flow of at least
one of the reference solution and the sample at a flow rate of from about
0.001 ml/min to about 2 ml/min during movement between the first pinch
position and the second pinch position.
28. The method of claim 21, wherein the valve is a rotating pinch valve.
29. A method for measuring a concentration of an analyte in a circulatory
system of a host, the method comprising:passing a reference solution past
an analyte sensor configured to measure an analyte concentration, wherein
the analyte sensor is a component of an analyte measuring system
comprising a vascular access device, the analyte sensor, and electronics
operatively connected to the analyte sensor and configured to generate a
signal associated with the analyte concentration, wherein the analyte
sensor resides within the vascular access device, and wherein the
vascular access device and the analyte sensor are in fluid communication
with a circulatory system of a host;measuring a signal associated with an
analyte concentration of the reference solution;drawing back a sample
from the circulatory system; andmeasuring a signal associated with the
analyte concentration of the sample, wherein the analyte measuring system
further comprises a flow control device, wherein the flow control device
comprises a valve comprising a first discrete position and a second
discrete position, wherein the valve is configured to meter flow in a
first direction during passing and in a second direction opposite to the
first direction during drawing, wherein drawing back a sample comprises
drawing back a sample volume of about 500 microliters or less during
movement of the valve from the second discrete position to the first
discrete position.
30. The method of claim 29, wherein a sample volume of about 300
microliters or less is drawn back.
Description
CROSS-REFERENCE TO RELATED APPLICATIONS
[0001]This application is a continuation of U.S. application Ser. No.
11/691,424 filed Mar. 26, 2007. U.S. application Ser. No. 11/691,424 is a
continuation-in-part of U.S. application Ser. No. 11/543,396 filed Oct.
4, 2006; and is a continuation-in-part of U.S. application Ser. No.
11/543,490 filed Oct. 4, 2006; and is a continuation-in-part of U.S.
application Ser. No. 11/543,404 filed Oct. 4, 2006. The disclosures of
each of the above-referenced applications are hereby expressly
incorporated by reference in their entirety and are hereby expressly made
a portion of this application.
FIELD OF THE INVENTION
[0002]The preferred embodiments relate generally to systems and methods
for measuring an analyte in a host.
BACKGROUND OF THE INVENTION
[0003]Diabetes mellitus is a disorder in which the pancreas cannot create
sufficient insulin (Type I or insulin dependent) and/or in which insulin
is not effective (Type 2 or non-insulin dependent). In the diabetic
state, the victim suffers from high blood sugar, which can cause an array
of physiological derangements associated with the deterioration of small
blood vessels, for example, kidney failure, skin ulcers, or bleeding into
the vitreous of the eye. A hypoglycemic reaction (low blood sugar) can be
induced by an inadvertent overdose of insulin, or after a normal dose of
insulin or glucose-lowering agent accompanied by extraordinary exercise
or insufficient food intake.
[0004]Conventionally, a person admitted to a hospital for certain
conditions (with or without diabetes) is tested for blood sugar level by
a single point blood glucose meter, which typically requires
uncomfortable finger pricking methods or blood draws and can produce a
burden on the hospital staff during a patient's hospital stay. Due to the
lack of convenience, blood sugar glucose levels are generally measured as
little as once per day or up to once per hour. Unfortunately, such time
intervals are so far spread apart that hyperglycemic or hypoglycemic
conditions unknowingly occur, incurring dangerous side effects. It is not
only unlikely that a single point value will not catch some hyperglycemic
or hypoglycemic conditions, it is also likely that the trend (direction)
of the blood glucose value is unknown based on conventional methods. This
inhibits the ability to make educated insulin therapy decisions.
[0005]A variety of sensors are known that use an electrochemical cell to
provide output signals by which the presence or absence of an analyte,
such as glucose, in a sample can be determined. For example, in an
electrochemical cell, an analyte (or a species derived from it) that is
electro-active generates a detectable signal at an electrode, and this
signal can be used to detect or measure the presence and/or amount within
a biological sample. In some conventional sensors, an enzyme is provided
that reacts with the analyte to be measured, and the byproduct of the
reaction is qualified or quantified at the electrode. An enzyme has the
advantage that it can be very specific to an analyte and also, when the
analyte itself is not sufficiently electro-active, can be used to
interact with the analyte to generate another species which is
electro-active and to which the sensor can produce a desired output. In
one conventional amperometric glucose oxidase-based glucose sensor,
immobilized glucose oxidase catalyses the oxidation of glucose to form
hydrogen peroxide, which is then quantified by amperometric measurement
(for example, change in electrical current) through a polarized
electrode.
SUMMARY OF THE INVENTION
[0006]In a first aspect, a system for measuring an analyte is provided,
the system comprising: a vascular access device configured to be in
communication with a circulatory system of a host; and an analyte sensor
configured to reside within the vascular access device, wherein the
analyte sensor is configured to measure a concentration of an analyte
within the circulatory system.
[0007]In an embodiment of the first aspect, the system further comprises a
flow control device.
[0008]In an embodiment of the first aspect, the flow control device
comprises at least one of a pump and a valve.
[0009]In an embodiment of the first aspect, the flow control device is
configured to draw back a sample from the circulatory system.
[0010]In an embodiment of the first aspect, the sample has a volume of
about 500 microliters or less.
[0011]In an embodiment of the first aspect, the sample has a volume of
about 50 microliters or less.
[0012]In an embodiment of the first aspect, the flow control device is
configured to draw back the sample at a rate of from about 0.001 ml/min
to about 2.0 ml/min.
[0013]In an embodiment of the first aspect, the rate is from about 0.01
ml/min to about 1.0 ml/min.
[0014]In an embodiment of the first aspect, the flow control device is
configured to draw back a sample substantially no farther than the
vascular access device.
[0015]In an embodiment of the first aspect, the flow control device is
configured to draw back a sample substantially no farther than a plane
defined by skin of the host.
[0016]In an embodiment of the first aspect, the flow control device is
configured to infuse a fluid through the vascular access device and into
the circulatory system.
[0017]In an embodiment of the first aspect, the flow control device is
configured to infuse the fluid at a rate such that a temperature of the
fluid substantially equilibrates with a temperature of the host.
[0018]In an embodiment of the first aspect, the fluid has a known
concentration of the analyte and the sensor comprises electronics
configured to measure a signal associated with the known concentration of
the analyte.
[0019]In an embodiment of the first aspect, an in vivo portion of the
analyte sensor has a width of less than about 0.020 inches.
[0020]In an embodiment of the first aspect, the in vivo portion of the
analyte sensor has a width of less than about 0.010 inches.
[0021]In an embodiment of the first aspect, the vascular access device
comprises a single lumen.
[0022]In an embodiment of the first aspect, the vascular access device
comprises an 18 gauge or smaller catheter.
[0023]In an embodiment of the first aspect, the vascular access device
comprises a 22 gauge or smaller catheter.
[0024]In an embodiment of the first aspect, the vascular access device
comprises a sidewall and at least one orifice disposed within the
sidewall, wherein the orifice is configured to allow blood to pass
therethrough.
[0025]In an embodiment of the first aspect, the orifice is configured to
allow blood to contact at least a portion of the sensor.
[0026]In an embodiment of the first aspect, the sensor comprises a tip,
and wherein the tip of the sensor is disposed within the vascular access
device.
[0027]In an embodiment of the first aspect, the tip of the sensor is
disposed about 2 cm or less from a tip of the vascular access device.
[0028]In an embodiment of the first aspect, at least a portion of the
sensor is configured to extend out of the vascular access device.
[0029]In an embodiment of the first aspect, at least a portion of the
sensor is configured to intermittently protrude out of the vascular
access device.
[0030]In an embodiment of the first aspect, the analyte sensor further
comprises a bioinert material or a bioactive agent incorporated therein
or thereon.
[0031]In an embodiment of the first aspect, the bioactive agent comprises
at least one agent selected from the group consisting of vitamin K
antagonists, heparin group anticoagulants, platelet aggregation
inhibitors, enzymes, direct thrombin inhibitors, Dabigatran, Defibrotide,
Dermatan sulfate, Fondaparinux, and Rivaroxaban.
[0032]In a second aspect, a system for measuring an analyte is provided,
the system comprising: a vascular access device configured to be in
communication with a circulatory system of a host; an analyte sensor
configured to reside within the vascular access device, wherein the
analyte sensor is configured to measure a concentration of an analyte
within the circulatory system; and a flow control device.
[0033]In an embodiment of the second aspect, the flow control device
comprises a valve.
[0034]In an embodiment of the second aspect, the valve comprises a first
discreet position and a second discreet position.
[0035]In an embodiment of the second aspect, the valve is configured to
move between the first position and the second position over a time
period of from about 0.5 seconds to about 10.0 seconds.
[0036]In an embodiment of the second aspect, the system further comprises
tubing fluidly connected to the valve, wherein the valve is configured to
meter a flow through the tubing at a predetermined flow rate.
[0037]In an embodiment of the second aspect, the predetermined flow rate
is from about 0.001 ml/min to about 2.0 ml/min.
[0038]In an embodiment of the second aspect, the predetermined flow rate
flow rate is from about 0.02 ml/min to about 0.35 ml/min.
[0039]In an embodiment of the second aspect, the system further comprises
tubing connected to the valve, wherein the valve is configured such that
about 500 microliters or less of a fluid passes through the tubing during
movement of the valve between the first position and the second position.
[0040]In an embodiment of the second aspect, the system is configured to
push fluid through the tubing during movement of the valve from the first
position to the second position.
[0041]In an embodiment of the second aspect, the system is configured to
draw back a sample into the tubing during movement of the valve from the
second position to the first position.
[0042]In an embodiment of the second aspect, the valve is configured such
that about 50 microliters or less of a fluid passes through the tubing
during the movement of the valve between the first position and the
second position.
[0043]In an embodiment of the second aspect, the system further comprises
a bag containing a fluid.
[0044]In an embodiment of the second aspect, the system further comprises
a flow regulator configured to regulate a flow of the fluid.
[0045]In an embodiment of the second aspect, the system further comprises
a local analyzer.
[0046]In an embodiment of the second aspect, the local analyzer comprises
a potentiostat.
[0047]In an embodiment of the second aspect, the local analyzer comprises
a data processing module.
[0048]In an embodiment of the second aspect, the local analyzer comprises
a data storage module.
[0049]In an embodiment of the second aspect, the system further comprises
a remote analyzer.
[0050]In an embodiment of the second aspect, the remote analyzer comprises
a touch screen.
[0051]In an embodiment of the second aspect, the remote analyzer is
configured to control the flow control device.
[0052]In an embodiment of the second aspect, the remote analyzer is
detachably operably connected to a local analyzer.
[0053]In an embodiment of the second aspect, the remote analyzer comprises
a data processing module.
[0054]In an embodiment of the second aspect, the remote analyzer comprises
a data storage module.
[0055]In an embodiment of the second aspect, the flow control device
comprises a processor configured to control the flow control device, and
wherein the processor is operably connected to the remote analyzer.
[0056]In an embodiment of the second aspect, the flow control device
comprises a pump.
[0057]In a third aspect, a method for measuring a concentration of an
analyte in of a host is provided, the method comprising: a) providing an
analyte measuring system comprising a vascular access device, an analyte
sensor configured measure an analyte concentration, and electronics
operatively connected to the sensor and configured to generate a signal
associated with the analyte concentration; wherein the analyte sensor is
configured to reside within the vascular access device; b) placing the
vascular access device and sensor in fluid communication with the
circulatory system; c) passing a reference solution past the analyte
sensor and measuring a signal associated with an analyte concentration of
the reference solution; and d) drawing back a sample from the circulatory
system and measuring a signal associated with the analyte concentration
of the sample.
[0058]In an embodiment of the third aspect, the step of passing a
reference solution comprises passing the reference solution at a first
flow rate of from about 0.001 ml/min to about 2 ml/min.
[0059]In an embodiment of the third aspect, the step of passing a
reference solution comprises passing the reference solution at a first
flow rate of from about 0.02 ml/min to about 0.35 ml/min.
[0060]In an embodiment of the third aspect, the step of passing a
reference solution comprises allowing a temperature of the reference
solution to equilibrate with a temperature of the host.
[0061]In an embodiment of the third aspect, the step of drawing back a
sample comprises drawing back a sample at a second flow rate of from
about 0.001 ml/min to about 2 ml/min.
[0062]In an embodiment of the third aspect, the step of drawing back a
sample comprises drawing back a sample at a second flow rate of from
about 0.02 ml/min to about 0.35 ml/min.
[0063]In an embodiment of the third aspect, the step of drawing back a
sample comprises substantially blocking mixing of the reference solution
and the sample.
[0064]In an embodiment of the third aspect, the second flow rate is
substantially equal to the first flow rate.
[0065]In an embodiment of the third aspect, the vascular access device is
in fluid communication with a vein, the method further comprising a step
of keeping the vein open by passing the reference solution past the
sensor at a third flow rate.
[0066]In an embodiment of the third aspect, the third flow rate is less
than the first flow rate.
[0067]In an embodiment of the third aspect, the third flow rate is from
about 1.0 ml/min.
[0068]In an embodiment of the third aspect, the third flow rate is from
about 0.02 ml/min to about 0.2 ml/min.
[0069]In an embodiment of the third aspect, the analyte measuring system
further comprises a flow control device, wherein the flow control device
is configured to meter flow during steps c) and d).
[0070]In an embodiment of the third aspect, the flow control device
comprises a valve comprising a first discreet position and a second
discreet position.
[0071]In an embodiment of the third aspect, the step of passing a
reference solution comprises moving the valve from the first position to
the second position.
[0072]In an embodiment of the third aspect, the step of passing a
reference solution comprises passing a solution volume of about 500
microliters or less during movement of the valve from the first position
to the second position.
[0073]In an embodiment of the third aspect, the step of drawing back a
sample comprises moving the valve from the second position to the first
position.
[0074]In an embodiment of the third aspect, the step of drawing back a
sample comprises drawing back a sample volume of about 500 microliters or
less during movement of the valve from the second position to the first
position.
[0075]In an embodiment of the third aspect, the step of drawing back a
sample comprises drawing back a sample volume of about 50 microliters or
less during movement of the valve from the second position to the first
position.
[0076]In an embodiment of the third aspect, the vascular access device is
in fluid communication with a vein, the method further comprising a step
of keeping the vein open by metering flow of the reference solution
through the vascular access device at a predetermined rate.
[0077]In an embodiment of the third aspect, the step of metering the flow
is controlled at least in part by a timing for the valve to move between
the first position and the second position.
[0078]In an embodiment of the third aspect, the step of drawing back the
sample from the circulatory system comprises drawing back the sample
substantially no farther than the vascular access device.
[0079]In an embodiment of the third aspect, the step of drawing back the
sample from the circulatory system comprises drawing back the sample into
the vascular access device substantially no farther than a plane defined
by the skin of the host.
[0080]In an embodiment of the third aspect, the analyte is glucose, and
wherein the step of measuring the concentration of the analyte comprises
measuring a glucose concentration.
[0081]In an embodiment of the third aspect, the flow control device
comprises a valve.
[0082]In an embodiment of the third aspect, the flow control device
comprises a pump.
[0083]In an embodiment of the third aspect, steps c) through d) are
repeated.
[0084]In a fourth aspect, a method for measuring a concentration of an
analyte in a circulatory system of a host is provided, the method
comprising: a) providing an analyte measuring system comprising a
vascular access device, an analyte sensor, a flow control device, a
fluids bag, an IV tubing, and a processor, wherein the processor is
operatively connected to the flow control device and analyte sensor; b)
inserting the vascular access device and the analyte sensor into fluid
communication with the host's circulatory system; c) injecting a first
reference solution into the IV tubing; d) coupling the fluids bag to the
IV tubing, the fluids bag comprising a second reference solution; and e)
initiating the analyte measuring system, wherein the processor is
configured to auto-calibrate the analyte sensor without additional user
interaction with the system.
[0085]In an embodiment of the fourth aspect, the first reference solution
has a first known analyte concentration and wherein the second reference
solution comprises a second known reference solution.
[0086]In an embodiment of the fourth aspect, the system is configured to
auto-calibrate the analyte sensor using the first reference solution and
the second reference solution.
[0087]In an embodiment of the fourth aspect, the system provides
calibrated sensor data for at least about 24 hours prior to injection of
another reference solution into the IV tubing.
[0088]In a fifth aspect, a system for monitoring analyte concentration in
a biological sample of a host is provided, the system comprising: a
substantially continuous analyte sensor configured to produce a data
signal indicative of an analyte concentration in a host during exposure
of the sensor to a biological sample; a reference solution having a known
analyte concentration, wherein the system is configured to expose the
sensor to the reference solution, and wherein the system is configured to
produce a data signal indicative of an analyte concentration in the
reference solution during exposure of the sensor to the reference
solution; and a computer system comprising programming configured to
determine calibration information and to calibrate a signal associated
with a biological sample therefrom, wherein the calibration information
comprises steady state information and transient information.
[0089]In an embodiment of the fifth aspect, the calibration information is
determined from a signal associated with exposure of the sensor to the
reference solution and a signal associated with exposure of the sensor to
the biological sample.
[0090]In an embodiment of the fifth aspect, the steady state information
comprises at least one of sensitivity information and baseline
information.
[0091]In an embodiment of the fifth aspect, the steady state information
comprises both sensitivity information and baseline information.
[0092]In an embodiment of the fifth aspect, the steady state information
comprises information associated with a signal produced during exposure
of the sensor to the reference solution.
[0093]In an embodiment of the fifth aspect, the reference solution
comprises a known analyte concentration of about zero, and wherein the
steady state information comprises baseline information about the sensor
in the reference solution.
[0094]In an embodiment of the fifth aspect, the reference solution
comprises a known analyte concentration of more than zero, and wherein
the steady state information comprises sensitivity information about the
sensor.
[0095]In an embodiment of the fifth aspect, the steady state calibration
information comprises reference data from an analyte sensor other than
the substantially continuous analyte sensor.
[0096]In an embodiment of the fifth aspect, transient information
comprises a rate of change of a signal produced during exposure of the
sensor to a step change in analyte concentration.
[0097]In an embodiment of the fifth aspect, the rate of change comprises a
rate change of a signal produced during exposure of the sensor to a
biological sample of an unknown analyte concentration or an uncalibrated
analyte concentration.
[0098]In an embodiment of the fifth aspect, the rate of change comprises a
rate change of a signal produced during exposure of the sensor to a
biological sample, and wherein the steady state information comprises
reference data from an analyte sensor other than the substantially
continuous analyte sensor.
[0099]In an embodiment of the fifth aspect, transient information
comprises an impulse response of a signal produced during exposure of the
sensor to a step change in analyte concentration.
[0100]In an embodiment of the fifth aspect, the impulse response is used
to determine an offset between a baseline measurement associated with the
reference solution and a baseline measurement associated with a
biological sample.
[0101]In an embodiment of the fifth aspect, the impulse response is used
to determine a time point of a steady state measurement during which an
analyte concentration can be obtained.
[0102]In an embodiment of the fifth aspect, the transient information
comprises a comparison of steady state information and transient
information for a plurality of time-spaced signals associated with
biological samples of unknown analyte concentration or uncalibrated
analyte concentration.
[0103]In an embodiment of the fifth aspect, the comparison of steady state
information and transient information is used to determine an offset
between a baseline measurement associated with the reference solution and
a baseline measurement associated with a biological sample.
[0104]In an embodiment of the fifth aspect, the system further comprises
programming to detect a shift in baseline or sensitivity based on a
comparison of steady state information and transient information.
[0105]In an embodiment of the fifth aspect, the system further comprises
programming configured to initiate calibration of the signal to correct
for a shift in at least one of baseline and sensitivity based on a
comparison of steady state information and transient information.
[0106]In an embodiment of the fifth aspect, the system further comprises
programming configured to calibrate of the signal to correct for a shift
in at least one of baseline and sensitivity based on a comparison of
steady state information and transient information.
[0107]In an embodiment of the fifth aspect, the programming is configured
to calibrate a signal is configured to perform at least one of initial
calibration and update calibration.
[0108]In an embodiment of the fifth aspect, the analyte sensor is a
glucose sensor.
[0109]In a sixth aspect, a system for monitoring analyte concentration in
a biological sample of a host is provided, the system comprising: a
substantially continuous analyte sensor configured to produce a data
signal indicative of an analyte concentration in a host during exposure
of the sensor to a biological sample; a reference solution having a known
analyte concentration, wherein the system is configured to expose the
sensor to the reference solution, and wherein the system is configured to
produce a data signal indicative of an analyte concentration in the
reference solution during exposure of the sensor to the reference
solution; and a computer system comprising programming configured to
determine calibration information and to calibrate a signal associated
with a biological sample therefrom, wherein the calibration information
is determined from a signal associated with exposure of the sensor to the
reference solution and a signal associated with exposure of the sensor a
biological sample, wherein the biological sample is of unknown analyte
concentration or uncalibrated analyte concentration.
[0110]In an embodiment of the sixth aspect, calibration information
comprises steady state information and transient information
[0111]In an embodiment of the sixth aspect, the steady state information
comprises at least one of sensitivity information and baseline
information
[0112]In an embodiment of the sixth aspect, transient information
comprises a rate of change of the sensor's signal responsive to exposure
of the sensor to a change in analyte concentration
[0113]In an embodiment of the sixth aspect, transient information
comprises a rate of change of a signal produced during exposure of the
sensor to a step change in analyte concentration.
[0114]In an embodiment of the sixth aspect, the analyte sensor is a
glucose sensor.
[0115]In a seventh aspect, a system for monitoring analyte concentration
in a biological sample of a host is provided, the system comprising: a
substantially continuous analyte sensor configured to produce a data
signal indicative of an analyte concentration in a host during exposure
of the sensor to a biological sample; a reference solution having a known
analyte concentration, wherein the system is configured to expose the
sensor to the reference solution, and wherein the system is configured to
produce a data signal indicative of an analyte concentration in the
reference solution during exposure of the sensor to the reference
solution; and a computer system comprising programming configured to
determine calibration information and calibrate a signal associated with
a biological sample therefrom, wherein the calibration information is
determined from at least one of a signal associated with exposure of the
sensor to the reference solution and a signal associated with exposure of
the sensor to a biological sample, wherein the biological sample is of
unknown analyte concentration or uncalibrated analyte concentration.
[0116]In an embodiment of the seventh aspect, the computer system further
comprises programming configured to diagnose a condition of at least one
of the sensor and the host responsive to calibration information.
[0117]In an embodiment of the seventh aspect, calibration information
comprises baseline information, and wherein the system comprises
programming configured to determine an offset between a baseline
associated with a reference solution and a baseline associated with a
biological sample.
[0118]In an embodiment of the seventh aspect, the offset is determined by
processing an impulse response of the sensor's signal during exposure of
the sensor to a step change in analyte concentration.
[0119]In an embodiment of the seventh aspect, the offset is determined by
a comparison of steady state information and transient information for a
plurality of time-spaced samples of a biological sample of unknown
analyte concentration or uncalibrated analyte concentration.
[0120]In an embodiment of the seventh aspect, the computer system further
comprises programming configured to detect an interfering species
responsive to a change in the offset above a predetermined amount.
[0121]In an embodiment of the seventh aspect, the computer system further
comprises programming configured to diagnose a condition of the host's
metabolic processes responsive to a change in the offset above a
predetermined amount.
[0122]In an embodiment of the seventh aspect, the computer system further
comprises programming configured to display or transmit a message
associated with the host's condition responsive to diagnosing the
condition.
[0123]In an embodiment of the seventh aspect, the computer system further
comprises programming configured to diagnose an error and fail-safe
responsive to a change in the offset above a predetermined amount.
[0124]In an embodiment of the seventh aspect, the computer system further
comprises programming configured to recalibrate the sensor responsive to
a change in the offset above a predetermined amount.
[0125]In an embodiment of the seventh aspect, calibration information
comprises sensitivity information, and wherein the system comprises
programming configured to diagnose an error responsive to a change in
sensitivity above a predetermined amount.
[0126]In an embodiment of the seventh aspect, the computer system further
comprises programming configured to calculate an impulse response of a
signal produced during exposure of the sensor to a step change in analyte
concentration, and wherein a time constant for the step change is
determined from the time of the peak impulse response.
[0127]In an embodiment of the seventh aspect, the step of calculating an
impulse response is repeated more than one time, and wherein the computer
system further comprises programming configured to diagnose a sensor
condition or error responsive to a change in the time constants
associated with the plurality of step changes above a predetermined
threshold.
BRIEF DESCRIPTION OF THE DRAWINGS
[0128]FIG. 1A is a perspective view of one embodiment of an analyte sensor
system, including a vascular access device (e.g., a catheter), a sensor,
a fluid connector, and a protective sheath.
[0129]FIG. 1B is a side view of the analyte sensor system of FIG. 1A,
showing the protective sheath removed.
[0130]FIG. 1C1 is a close-up cut away view of a portion of the analyte
sensor system of FIG. 1A.
[0131]FIG. 1C2 is a close-up cut away view of a portion of the analyte
sensor system of FIG. 1A.
[0132]FIG. 1D is a close-up cut away view of a portion of the analyte
sensor system of FIG. 1A.
[0133]FIG. 1E is a close-up cut away view of a portion of the analyte
sensor system of FIG. 1A.
[0134]FIG. 2A is a perspective view of another embodiment of the analyte
sensor system, including a catheter with a sensor integrally formed
thereon.
[0135]FIG. 2B is a perspective view of the analyte sensor system of FIG.
2A.
[0136]FIG. 2C is a close-up view of a portion of the analyte sensor system
of FIG. 2A in an alternative configuration of an embodiment having three
electrodes disposed on the catheter.
[0137]FIG. 2D is a close-up view of a portion of the analyte sensor system
of FIG. 2A in an alternative configuration of an embodiment having three
electrodes disposed on the catheter.
[0138]FIG. 2E is a close-up view of a portion of the analyte sensor system
of FIG. 2A in an alternative embodiment having two electrodes disposed on
the catheter.
[0139]FIG. 2F is a close-up view of a portion of the analyte sensor system
of FIG. 2A in an alternative embodiment having one electrode disposed on
the catheter.
[0140]FIG. 3A is a perspective view of a first portion of one embodiment
of an analyte sensor.
[0141]FIG. 3B is a perspective view of a second portion of the analyte
sensor of FIG. 3A.
[0142]FIG. 3C is a cross section of the analyte sensor of FIG. 3B, taken
on line C-C.
[0143]FIG. 4 is a graph illustrating in vivo function of an analyte sensor
system of the embodiment shown in FIG. 1A.
[0144]FIG. 5 is a graph illustrating in vivo function of an analyte sensor
system of the embodiment shown in FIG. 1A.
[0145]FIG. 6 is a schematic of an integrated sensor system.
[0146]FIG. 7 is a block diagram of an integrated sensor system
[0147]FIGS. 8A through 8C are schematic illustrations of a flow control
device in one exemplary embodiment, including is relative
movement/positions and the consequential effect on the flow of fluids
through the sensor/catheter inserted in a host.
[0148]FIG. 9 is a cut-away illustration of one exemplary embodiment of a
catheter implanted in a host's vessel.
[0149]FIG. 10 is a graph that schematically illustrates a signal produced
during exposure of the sensor to a step change in analyte concentration,
in one exemplary embodiment.
[0150]FIG. 11 is a graph that schematically illustrates a derivative of
the step response shown in FIG. 9.
[0151]FIG. 12 is a graph that illustrates level vs. rate for a plurality
of time-spaced signals associated with exposure of the sensor to
biological samples of unknown or uncalibrated analyte concentration.
[0152]FIG. 13 is a graphical representation showing exemplary glucose
sensor data and corresponding blood glucose values over time in a pig.
[0153]FIG. 14 is a graphical representation showing exemplary calibrated
glucose sensor data (test) and corresponding blood glucose values (YSI
control) over time in a human.
DETAILED DESCRIPTION OF THE PREFERRED EMBODIMENT
[0154]The following description and examples illustrate some exemplary
embodiments of the disclosed invention in detail. Those of skill in the
art will recognize that there are numerous variations and modifications
of this invention that are encompassed by its scope. Accordingly, the
description of a certain exemplary embodiment should not be deemed to
limit the scope of the preferred embodiments.
DEFINITIONS
[0155]In order to facilitate an understanding of the preferred
embodiments, a number of terms are defined below.
[0156]The term "analyte" as used herein is a broad term, and is to be
given its ordinary and customary meaning to a person of ordinary skill in
the art (and is not to be limited to a special or customized meaning),
and refers without limitation to a substance or chemical constituent in a
biological fluid (for example, blood, interstitial fluid, cerebral spinal
fluid, lymph fluid or urine) that can be analyzed. Analytes can include
naturally occurring substances, artificial substances, metabolites,
and/or reaction products. In some embodiments, the analyte for
measurement by the sensing regions, devices, and methods is glucose.
However, other analytes are contemplated as well, including but not
limited to acarboxyprothrombin; acylcarnitine; adenine phosphoribosyl
transferase; adenosine deaminase; albumin; alpha-fetoprotein; amino acid
profiles (arginine (Krebs cycle), histidine/urocanic acid, homocysteine,
phenylalanine/tyrosine, tryptophan); andrenostenedione; antipyrine;
arabinitol enantiomers; arginase; benzoylecgonine (cocaine); biotimidase;
biopterin; c-reactive protein; carnitine; carnosinase; CD4;
ceruloplasmin; chenodeoxycholic acid; chloroquine; cholesterol;
cholinesterase; conjugated 1-.beta. hydroxy-cholic acid; cortisol;
creatine kinase; creatine kinase MM isoenzyme; cyclosporin A;
d-penicillamine; de-ethylchloroquine; dehydroepiandrosterone sulfate; DNA
(acetylator polymorphism, alcohol dehydrogenase, alpha 1-antitrypsin,
cystic fibrosis, Duchenne/Becker muscular dystrophy, glucose-6-phosphate
dehydrogenase, hemoglobin A, hemoglobin S. hemoglobin C, hemoglobin D,
hemoglobin E, hemoglobin F, D-Punjab, beta-thalassemia, hepatitis B
virus, HCMV, HIV-1, HTLV-1, Leber hereditary optic neuropathy, MCAD, RNA,
PKU, Plasmodium vivax, sexual differentiation, 21-deoxycortisol);
desbutylhalofantrine; dihydropteridine reductase; diptheria/tetanus
antitoxin; erythrocyte arginase; erythrocyte protoporphyrin; esterase D;
fatty acids/acylglycines; free .beta.-human chorionic gonadotropin; free
erythrocyte porphyrin; free thyroxine (FT4); free tri-iodothyronine
(FT3); fumarylacetoacetase; galactose/gal-1-phosphate;
galactose-1-phosphate uridyltransferase; gentamicin; glucose-6-phosphate
dehydrogenase; glutathione; glutathione perioxidase; glycocholic acid;
glycosylated hemoglobin; halofantrine; hemoglobin variants;
hexosaminidase A; human erythrocyte carbonic anhydrase I;
17-alpha-hydroxyprogesterone; hypoxanthine phosphoribosyl transferase;
immunoreactive trypsin; lactate; lead; lipoproteins ((a), B/A-1, .beta.);
lysozyme; mefloquine; netilmicin; phenobarbitone; phenyloin;
phytanic/pristanic acid; progesterone; prolactin; prolidase; purine
nucleoside phosphorylase; quinine; reverse tri-iodothyronine (rT3);
selenium; serum pancreatic lipase; sissomicin; somatomedin C; specific
antibodies (adenovirus, anti-nuclear antibody, anti-zeta antibody,
arbovirus, Aujeszky's disease virus, dengue virus, Dracunculus
medinensis, Echinococcus granulosus, Entamoeba histolytica, enterovirus,
Giardia duodenalisa, Helicobacter pylori, hepatitis B virus, herpes
virus, HIV-1, IgE (atopic disease), influenza virus, Leishmania donovani,
leptospira, measles/mumps/rubella, Mycobacterium leprae, Mycoplasma
pneumoniae, Myoglobin, Onchocerca volvulus, parainfluenza virus,
Plasmodium falciparum, poliovirus, Pseudomonas aeruginosa, respiratory
syncytial virus, rickettsia (scrub typhus), Schistosoma mansoni,
Toxoplasma gondii, Trepenoma pallidium, Trypanosoma cruzi/rangeli,
vesicular stomatis virus, Wuchereria bancrofti, yellow fever virus);
specific antigens (hepatitis B virus, HIV-1); succinylacetone;
sulfadoxine; theophylline; thyrotropin (TSH); thyroxine (T4);
thyroxine-binding globulin; trace elements; transferrin;
UDP-galactose-4-epimerase; urea; uroporphyrinogen I synthase; vitamin A;
white blood cells; and zinc protoporphyrin. Salts, sugar, protein, fat,
vitamins, and hormones naturally occurring in blood or interstitial
fluids can also constitute analytes in certain embodiments. The analyte
can be naturally present in the biological fluid, for example, a
metabolic product, a hormone, an antigen, an antibody, and the like.
Alternatively, the analyte can be introduced into the body, for example,
a contrast agent for imaging, a radioisotope, a chemical agent, a
fluorocarbon-based synthetic blood, or a drug or pharmaceutical
composition, including but not limited to insulin; ethanol; cannabis
(marijuana, tetrahydrocannabinol, hashish); inhalants (nitrous oxide,
amyl nitrite, butyl nitrite, chlorohydrocarbons, hydrocarbons); cocaine
(crack cocaine); stimulants (amphetamines, methamphetamines, Ritalin,
Cylert, Preludin, Didrex, PreState, Voranil, Sandrex, Plegine);
depressants (barbituates, methaqualone, tranquilizers such as Valium,
Librium, Miltown, Serax, Equanil, Tranxene); hallucinogens
(phencyclidine, lysergic acid, mescaline, peyote, psilocybin); narcotics
(heroin, codeine, morphine, opium, meperidine, Percocet, Percodan,
Tussionex, Fentanyl, Darvon, Talwin, Lomotil); designer drugs (analogs of
fentanyl, meperidine, amphetamines, methamphetamines, and phencyclidine,
for example, Ecstasy); anabolic steroids; and nicotine. The metabolic
products of drugs and pharmaceutical compositions are also contemplated
analytes. Analytes such as neurochemicals and other chemicals generated
within the body can also be analyzed, such as, for example, ascorbic
acid, uric acid, dopamine, noradrenaline, 3-methoxytyramine (3MT),
3,4-dihydroxyphenylacetic acid (DOPAC), homovanillic acid (HVA),
5-hydroxytryptamine (5HT), histamine, Advanced Glycation End Products
(AGEs) and 5-hydroxyindoleacetic acid (FHIAA).
[0157]The term "sensor break-in" as used herein is a broad term, and is to
be given its ordinary and customary meaning to a person of ordinary skill
in the art (and is not to be limited to a special or customized meaning),
and refers without limitation to the time (after implantation) in which
the sensor's signal level becomes substantially representative of the
analyte (e.g., glucose) concentration (e.g., where the current output
from the sensor is stable relative to the glucose level). The signal may
not be `flat` at that point (e.g., when the sensor has broken-in), but,
in general, variation in the signal level at that point is due to a
change in the analyte (e.g., glucose) concentration. Thus "sensor
break-in" generally refers to the time required for the sensor's output
signal to provide a substantially linear response to the analyte
concentration (e.g., glucose level). In some preferred embodiments,
sensor break-in occurs prior to obtaining a meaningful calibration of the
sensor output. In some embodiments, sensor break-in generally includes
both electrochemical break-in and membrane break-in.
[0158]The term "membrane break-in" as used herein is a broad term, and is
to be given its ordinary and customary meaning to a person of ordinary
skill in the art (and is not to be limited to a special or customized
meaning), and refers without limitation to an amount of time necessary
for the membrane to equilibrate to its surrounding environment (e.g.,
physiological environment in vivo).
[0159]The term "electrochemical break-in" as used herein is a broad term,
and is to be given its ordinary and customary meaning to a person of
ordinary skill in the art (and is not to be limited to a special or
customized meaning), and refers without limitation to the time, after
sensor insertion in vitro and/or in vivo, at which the current output
from the sensor settles to a stable value following the application of
the potential to the sensor. Generally, prior to this time, the output
may not be clinically useful. Accordingly, reductions in the length of
time required to reach electrochemical break-in can be desirable, for
example, in acute care environments." Numerous methods of accelerating
electrochemical break-in can be used, such as, but not limited to,
configuring the sensor electronics to aid in decreasing the break-in time
of the sensor by applying different voltage settings (for example,
starting with a higher voltage setting and then reducing the voltage
setting). Additional methods of accelerating sensor break-in time are
described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,411,647, for example, which is incorporated
herein by reference.
[0160]The term "host" as used herein is a broad term, and is to be given
its ordinary and customary meaning to a person of ordinary skill in the
art (and is not to be limited to a special or customized meaning), and
refers without limitation to animals or plants, for example humans.
[0161]The term "continuous (or continual) analyte sensing" as used herein
is a broad term, and is to be given its ordinary and customary meaning to
a person of ordinary skill in the art (and is not to be limited to a
special or customized meaning), and refers without limitation to the
period in which monitoring of analyte concentration is continuously,
continually, and or intermittently (regularly or irregularly) performed,
for example, about every 5 to 10 minutes.
[0162]The term "electrochemically reactive surface" as used herein is a
broad term, and is to be given its ordinary and customary meaning to a
person of ordinary skill in the art (and is not to be limited to a
special or customized meaning), and refers without limitation to a
surface where an electrochemical reaction takes place. For example, a
working electrode measures hydrogen peroxide produced by the
enzyme-catalyzed reaction of the analyte detected, which reacts to create
an electric current. Glucose analyte can be detected utilizing glucose
oxidase, which produces H.sub.2O.sub.2 as a byproduct. H.sub.2O.sub.2
reacts with the surface of the working electrode, producing two protons
(2H.sup.+), two electrons (2e.sup.-) and one molecule of oxygen
(O.sub.2), which produces the electronic current being detected.
[0163]The terms "electronic connection," "electrical connection,"
"electrical contact" as used herein are broad terms, and are to be given
their ordinary and customary meaning to a person of ordinary skill in the
art (and is not to be limited to a special or customized meaning), and
refer without limitation to any connection between two electrical
conductors known to those in the art. In one embodiment, electrodes are
in electrical connection with the electronic circuitry of a device.
[0164]The term "sensing region" as used herein is a broad term, and is to
be given its ordinary and customary meaning to a person of ordinary skill
in the art (and is not to be limited to a special or customized meaning),
and refers without limitation to the region of a monitoring device
responsible for the detection of a particular analyte. The sensing region
generally comprises a non-conductive body, a working electrode (anode),
and can include a reference electrode (optional), and/or a counter
electrode (cathode) forming electrochemically reactive surfaces on the
body.
[0165]The term "domain" as used herein is a broad term, and is to be given
its ordinary and customary meaning to a person of ordinary skill in the
art (and is not to be limited to a special or customized meaning), and
refers without limitation to a region of the membrane system that can be
a layer, a uniform or non-uniform gradient (for example, an anisotropic
region of a membrane), or a portion of a membrane.
[0166]The term "distal to" as used herein is a broad term, and is to be
given its ordinary and customary meaning to a person of ordinary skill in
the art (and is not to be limited to a special or customized meaning),
and refers without limitation to the spatial relationship between various
elements in comparison to a particular point of reference. In general,
the term indicates an element is located relatively far from the
reference point than another element.
[0167]The term "proximal to" as used herein is a broad term, and is to be
given its ordinary and customary meaning to a person of ordinary skill in
the art (and is not to be limited to a special or customized meaning),
and refers without limitation to the spatial relationship between various
elements in comparison to a particular point of reference. In general,
the term indicates an element is located relatively near to the reference
point than another element.
[0168]The term "in vivo portion" as used herein is a broad term, and is to
be given its ordinary and customary meaning to a person of ordinary skill
in the art (and is not to be limited to a special or customized meaning),
and refers without limitation to a portion of a device (for example, a
sensor) adapted for insertion into and/or existence within a living body
of a host.
[0169]The term "ex vivo portion" as used herein is a broad term, and is to
be given its ordinary and customary meaning to a person of ordinary skill
in the art (and is not to be limited to a special or customized meaning),
and refers without limitation to a portion of a device (for example, a
sensor) adapted to remain and/or exist outside of a living body of a
host.
[0170]The terms "raw data," "raw data stream", "raw data signal", "data
signal", and "data stream" as used herein are broad terms, and are to be
given their ordinary and customary meaning to a person of ordinary skill
in the art (and are not to be limited to a special or customized
meaning), and refer without limitation to an analog or digital signal
from the analyte sensor directly related to the measured analyte. For
example, the raw data stream is digital data in "counts" converted by an
A/D converter from an analog signal (for example, voltage or amps)
representative of an analyte concentration. The terms can include a
plurality of time spaced data points from a substantially continuous
analyte sensor, each of which comprises individual measurements taken at
time intervals ranging from fractions of a second up to, for example, 1,
2, or 5 minutes or longer. In some embodiments, the terms can refer to
data that has been integrated or averaged over a time period (e.g., 5
minutes).
[0171]The term "count" as used herein is a broad term, and is to be given
its ordinary and customary meaning to a person of ordinary skill in the
art (and is not to be limited to a special or customized meaning), and
refers without limitation to a unit of measurement of a digital signal.
For example, a raw data stream or raw data signal measured in counts is
directly related to a voltage (for example, converted by an A/D
converter), which is directly related to current from the working
electrode. In some embodiments, the terms can refer to data that has been
integrated or averaged over a time period (e.g., 5 minutes).
[0172]The terms "sensor" and "sensor system" as used herein are broad
terms, and are to be given their ordinary and customary meaning to a
person of ordinary skill in the art (and are not to be limited to a
special or customized meaning), and refer without limitation to a device,
component, or region of a device by which an analyte can be quantified.
[0173]The term "needle" as used herein is a broad term, and is to be given
its ordinary and customary meaning to a person of ordinary skill in the
art (and is not to be limited to a special or customized meaning), and
refers without limitation to a slender hollow instrument for introducing
material into or removing material from the body.
[0174]The terms "operatively connected," "operatively linked," "operably
connected," and "operably linked" as used herein are broad terms, and are
to be given their ordinary and customary meaning to a person of ordinary
skill in the art (and are not to be limited to a special or customized
meaning), and refer without limitation to one or more components linked
to one or more other components. The terms can refer to a mechanical
connection, an electrical connection, or any connection that allows
transmission of signals between the components. For example, one or more
electrodes can be used to detect the amount of analyte in a sample and to
convert that information into a signal; the signal can then be
transmitted to a circuit. In such an example, the electrode is "operably
linked" to the electronic circuitry. The terms include wired and wireless
connections.
[0175]The terms "membrane" and "membrane system" as used herein are broad
terms, and are to be given their ordinary and customary meaning to a
person of ordinary skill in the art (and are not to be limited to a
special or customized meaning), and refer without limitation to a
permeable or semi-permeable membrane that can be comprised of one or more
domains and is typically constructed of materials of one or more microns
in thickness, which is permeable to oxygen and to an analyte, e.g.,
glucose or another analyte. In one example, the membrane system comprises
an immobilized glucose oxidase enzyme, which enables a reaction to occur
between glucose and oxygen whereby a concentration of glucose can be
measured.
[0176]The terms "processor module" and "microprocessor" as used herein are
broad terms, and are to be given their ordinary and customary meaning to
a person of ordinary skill in the art (and are not to be limited to a
special or customized meaning), and refer without limitation to a
computer system, state machine, processor, and the like designed to
perform arithmetic or logic operations using logic circuitry that
responds to and processes the basic instructions that drive a computer.
[0177]The term "calibration" as used herein is a broad term, and is to be
given its ordinary and customary meaning to a person of ordinary skill in
the art (and is not to be limited to a special or customized meaning),
and refers without limitation to the relationship and/or process of
determining the relationship between the sensor data and the
corresponding reference data, which can be used to convert sensor data
into values substantially equivalent to the reference data. In some
embodiments, namely, in continuous analyte sensors, calibration can be
updated or recalibrated over time if changes in the relationship between
the sensor data and reference data occur, for example, due to changes in
sensitivity, baseline, transport, metabolism, and the like.
[0178]The terms "interferents" and "interfering species" as used herein
are broad terms, and are to be given their ordinary and customary meaning
to a person of ordinary skill in the art (and are not to be limited to a
special or customized meaning), and refer without limitation to effects
and/or species that interfere with the measurement of an analyte of
interest in a sensor to produce a signal that does not accurately
represent the analyte concentration. In one example of an electrochemical
sensor, interfering species are compounds with an oxidation potential
that substantially overlaps that of the analyte to be measured, thereby
producing a false positive signal.
[0179]The term "single point glucose monitor" as used herein is a broad
term, and is to be given its ordinary and customary meaning to a person
of ordinary skill in the art (and is not to be limited to a special or
customized meaning), and refers without limitation to a device that can
be used to measure a glucose concentration within a host at a single
point in time, for example, some embodiments utilize a small volume in
vitro glucose monitor that includes an enzyme membrane such as described
with reference to U.S. Pat. No. 4,994,167 and U.S. Pat. No. 4,757,022. It
should be understood that single point glucose monitors can measure
multiple samples (for example, blood, or interstitial fluid); however
only one sample is measured at a time and typically requires some user
initiation and/or interaction.
[0180]The term "specific gravity" as used herein is a broad term, and is
to be given its ordinary and customary meaning to a person of ordinary
skill in the art (and is not to be limited to a special or customized
meaning), and refers without limitation to the ratio of density of a
material (e.g., a liquid or a solid) to the density of distilled water.
[0181]The terms "substantial" and "substantially" as used herein are broad
terms, and are to be given their ordinary and customary meaning to a
person of ordinary skill in the art (and are not to be limited to a
special or customized meaning), and refer without limitation to a
sufficient amount that provides a desired function. For example, an
amount greater than 50 percent, an amount greater than 60 percent, an
amount greater than 70 percent, an amount greater than 80 percent, or an
amount greater than 90 percent.
[0182]The term "casting" as used herein is a broad term, and is to be
given its ordinary and customary meaning to a person of ordinary skill in
the art (and is not to be limited to a special or customized meaning),
and refers without limitation to a process where a fluid material is
applied to a surface or surfaces and allowed to cure or dry. The term is
broad enough to encompass a variety of coating techniques, for example,
using a draw-down machine (i.e., drawing-down), dip coating, spray
coating, spin coating, and the like.
[0183]The term "dip coating" as used herein is a broad term, and is to be
given its ordinary and customary meaning to a person of ordinary skill in
the art (and is not to be limited to a special or customized meaning),
and refers without limitation to coating, which involves dipping an
object or material into a liquid coating substance.
[0184]The term "spray coating" as used herein is a broad term, and is to
be given its ordinary and customary meaning to a person of ordinary skill
in the art (and is not to be limited to a special or customized meaning),
and refers without limitation to coating, which involves spraying a
liquid coating substance onto an object or material.
[0185]The term "spin coating" as used herein is a broad term, and is to be
given its ordinary and customary meaning to a person of ordinary skill in
the art (and is not to be limited to a special or customized meaning),
and refers without limitation to a coating process in which a thin film
is created by dropping a raw material solution onto a substrate while it
is rotating.
[0186]The terms "solvent" and "solvent system" as used herein are broad
terms, and are to be given their ordinary and customary meaning to a
person of ordinary skill in the art (and are not to be limited to a
special or customized meaning), and refer without limitation to
substances (e.g., liquids) capable of dissolving or dispersing one or
more other substances. Solvents and solvent systems can include compounds
and/or solutions that include components in addition to the solvent
itself.
[0187]The term "baseline," "noise" and "background signal" as used herein
are broad terms, and are to be given their ordinary and customary meaning
to a person of ordinary skill in the art (and is not to be limited to a
special or customized meaning), and refers without limitation to a
component of an analyte sensor signal that is not related to the analyte
concentration. In one example of a glucose sensor, the baseline is
composed substantially of signal contribution due to factors other than
glucose (for example, interfering species, non-reaction-related hydrogen
peroxide, or other electroactive species with an oxidation potential that
overlaps with hydrogen peroxide). In some embodiments wherein a
calibration is defined by solving for the equation y=m.times.+b, the
value of b represents the baseline, or background, of the signal.
[0188]The terms "sensitivity" and "slope" as used herein are broad terms,
and are to be given their ordinary and customary meaning to a person of
ordinary skill in the art (and are not to be limited to a special or
customized meaning), and refer without limitation to an amount of
electrical current produced by a predetermined amount (unit) of the
measured analyte. For example, in one preferred embodiment, a glucose
sensor has a sensitivity (or slope) of from about 1 to about 25 picoAmps
of current for every 1 mg/dL of glucose.
[0189]The terms "baseline and/or sensitivity shift," "baseline and/or
sensitivity drift," "shift," and "drift" as used herein are broad terms,
and are to be given their ordinary and customary meaning to a person of
ordinary skill in the art (and are not to be limited to a special or
customized meaning), and refer without limitation to a change in the
baseline and/or sensitivity of the sensor signal over time. While the
term "shift" generally refers to a substantially distinct change over a
relatively short time period, and the term "drift" generally refers to a
substantially gradual change over a relatively longer time period, the
terms can be used interchangeably and can also be generally referred to
as "change" in baseline and/or sensitivity.
[0190]The term "hypoglycemia" as used herein is a broad term, and is to be
given its ordinary and customary meaning to a person of ordinary skill in
the art (and are not to be limited to a special or customized meaning),
and refers without limitation to a condition in which a limited or low
amount of glucose exists in a host. Hypoglycemia can produce a variety of
symptoms and effects but the principal problems arise from an inadequate
supply of glucose as fuel to the brain, resulting in impairment of
function (neuroglycopemia). Derangements of function can range from
vaguely "feeling bad" to coma, and (rarely) permanent brain damage or
death.
[0191]The term "hyperglycemia" as used herein is a broad term, and is to
be given its ordinary and customary meaning to a person of ordinary skill
in the art (and are not to be limited to a special or customized
meaning), and refers without limitation to a condition in which an
excessive or high amount of glucose exists in a host. Hyperglycemia is
one of the classic symptoms of diabetes mellitus. Non-diabetic
hyperglycemia is associated with obesity and certain eating disorders,
such as bulimia nervosa. Hyperglycemia is also associated with other
diseases (or medications) affecting pancreatic function, such as
pancreatic cancer. Hyperglycemia is also associated with poor medical
outcomes in a variety of clinical settings, such as intensive or critical
care settings.
[0192]The term "potentiostat" as used herein is a broad term, and is to be
given its ordinary and customary meaning to a person of ordinary skill in
the art (and is not to be limited to a special or customized meaning),
and refers without limitation to an electronic instrument that controls
the electrical potential between the working and reference electrodes at
one or more preset values. Typically, a potentiostat works to keep the
potential constant by noticing changes in the resistance of the system
and compensating inversely with a change in the current. As a result, a
change to a higher resistance would cause the current to decrease to keep
the voltage constant in the system. In some embodiments, a potentiostat
forces whatever current is necessary to flow between the working and
counter electrodes to keep the desired potential, as long as the needed
cell voltage and current do not exceed the compliance limits of the
potentiostat.
[0193]The terms "electronics" and "sensor electronics" as used herein are
broad terms, and are to be given their ordinary and customary meaning to
a person of ordinary skill in the art (and are not to be limited to a
special or customized meaning), and refer without limitation to
electronics operatively coupled to the sensor and configured to measure,
process, receive, and/or transmit data associated with a sensor. In some
embodiments, the electronics include at least a potentiostat that
provides a bias to the electrodes and measures a current to provide the
raw data signal. The electronics are configured to calculate at least one
analyte sensor data point. For example, the electronics can include a
potentiostat, A/D converter, RAM, ROM, and/or transmitter. In some
embodiments, the potentiostat converts the raw data (e.g., raw counts)
collected from the sensor and converts it to a value familiar to the host
and/or medical personnel. For example, the raw counts from a glucose
sensor can be converted to milligrams of glucose per deciliter of blood
(e.g., mg/dl). In some embodiments, the sensor electronics include a
transmitter that transmits the signals from the potentiostat to a
receiver (e.g., a remote analyzer, such as but not limited to a remote
analyzer unit), where additional data analysis and glucose concentration
determination can occur.
[0194]The terms "coupling" and "operatively coupling" as used herein are
broad terms, and are to be given their ordinary and customary meanings to
a person of ordinary skill in the art (and are not to be limited to a
special or customized meaning), and refer without limitation to a joining
or linking together of two or more things, such as two parts of a device
or two devices, such that the things can function together. In one
example, two containers can be operatively coupled by tubing, such that
fluid can flow from one container to another. Coupling does not imply a
physical connection. For example, a transmitter and a receiver can be
operatively coupled by radio frequency (RF) transmission/communication.
[0195]The term "fluid communication" as used herein is a broad term, and
is to be given its ordinary and customary meaning to a person of ordinary
skill in the art (and are not to be limited to a special or customized
meaning), and refers without limitation to two or more components (e.g.,
things such as parts of a body or parts of a device) functionally linked
such that fluid can move from one component to another. These terms do
not imply directionality.
[0196]The terms "continuous" and "continuously" as used herein are broad
terms, and are to be given their ordinary and customary meanings to a
person of ordinary skill in the art (and are not to be limited to a
special or customized meaning), and refer without limitation to the
condition of being marked by substantially uninterrupted extension in
space, time or sequence. In one embodiment, an analyte concentration is
measured continuously or continually, for example at time intervals
ranging from fractions of a second up to, for example, 1, 2, or 5
minutes, or longer. It should be understood that continuous glucose
sensors generally continually measure glucose concentration without
required user initiation and/or interaction for each measurement, such as
described with reference to U.S. Pat. No. 6,001,067, for example. These
terms include situations wherein data gaps can exist (e.g., when a
continuous glucose sensor is temporarily not providing data).
[0197]The term "medical device" as used herein is a broad term, and is to
be given its ordinary and customary meaning to a person of ordinary skill
in the art (and are not to be limited to a special or customized
meaning), and refers without limitation to an instrument, apparatus,
implement, machine, contrivance, implant, in vitro reagent, or other
similar or related article, including a component part, or accessory
which is intended for use in the diagnosis of disease or other
conditions, or in the cure, mitigation, treatment, or prevention of
disease, in man or other animals, or intended to affect the structure or
any function of the body of man or other animals. Medical devices that
can be used in conjunction with various embodiments of the analyte sensor
system include any monitoring device requiring placement in a human
vessel, duct or body cavity, a dialysis machine, a heart-lung bypass
machine, blood collection equipment, a blood pressure monitor, an
automated blood chemistry analysis device and the like.
[0198]The term "blood pressure monitor" as used herein is a broad term,
and is to be given its ordinary and customary meaning to a person of
ordinary skill in the art (and are not to be limited to a special or
customized meaning), and refers without limitation to an instrument for
monitoring the blood pressure of a human or other animal. For example, a
blood pressure monitor can be an invasive blood pressure monitor, which
periodically monitors the host's blood pressure via a peripheral artery,
using a blood pressure transducer, such as but not limited to a
disposable blood pressure transducer. Utah Medical Products Inc.
(Midvale, Utah, USA) produces a variety of Deltran.RTM. Brand disposable
blood pressure transducers that are suitable for use with various
embodiments disclosed herein.
[0199]The term "pressure transducer" as used herein is a broad term, and
is to be given its ordinary and customary meaning to a person of ordinary
skill in the art (and are not to be limited to a special or customized
meaning), and refers without limitation to a component of an
intra-arterial blood pressure monitor that measures the host's blood
pressure.
[0200]The term "blood chemistry analysis device" as used herein is a broad
term, and is to be given its ordinary and customary meaning to a person
of ordinary skill in the art (and are not to be limited to a special or
customized meaning), and refers without limitation to a device that
measures a variety of blood components, characteristics or analytes
therein. In one embodiment, a blood chemistry analysis device
periodically withdraws an aliquot of blood from the host, measures
glucose, O.sub.2, CO.sub.2, PCO.sub.2, PO.sub.2, potassium, sodium, pH,
lactate, urea, bilirubin, creatinine, hematocrit, various minerals,
and/or various metabolites, and the like, and returns the blood to the
host's circulatory system. A variety of devices exist for testing various
blood properties/analytes at the bedside, such as but not limited to the
blood gas and chemistry devices manufactured by Via Medical (Austin,
Tex., USA).
[0201]The term "vascular access device" as used herein is a broad term,
and is to be given its ordinary and customary meaning to a person of
ordinary skill in the art (and are not to be limited to a special or
customized meaning), and refers without limitation to any device that is
in communication with the vascular system of a host. Vascular access
devices include but are not limited to catheters, shunts, blood
withdrawal devices and the like.
[0202]The term "catheter" as used herein is a broad term, and is to be
given its ordinary and customary meaning to a person of ordinary skill in
the art (and are not to be limited to a special or customized meaning),
and refers without limitation to a tube that can be inserted into a
host's body (e.g., cavity, duct or vessel). In some circumstances,
catheters allow drainage or injection of fluids or access by medical
instruments or devices. In some embodiments, a catheter is a thin,
flexible tube (e.g., a "soft" catheter). In alternative embodiments, the
catheter can be a larger, solid tube (e.g., a "hard" catheter). The term
"cannula" is interchangeable with the term "catheter" herein.
[0203]The term "indwell" as used herein is a broad term, and is to be
given its ordinary and customary meaning to a person of ordinary skill in
the art (and are not to be limited to a special or customized meaning),
and refers without limitation to reside within a host's body. Some
medical devices can indwell within a host's body for various lengths of
time, depending upon the purpose of the medical device, such as but not
limited to a few hours, days, weeks, to months, years, or even the host's
entire lifetime. In one exemplary embodiment, an arterial catheter may
indwell within the host's artery for a few hours, days, a week, or
longer, such as but not limited to the host's perioperative period (e.g.,
from the time the host is admitted to the hospital to the time he is
discharged).
[0204]The term "sheath" as used herein is a broad term, and is to be given
its ordinary and customary meaning to a person of ordinary skill in the
art (and are not to be limited to a special or customized meaning), and
refers without limitation to a covering or supporting structure that fits
closely around something, for example, in the way that a sheath covers a
blade. In one exemplary embodiment, a sheath is a slender, flexible,
polymer tube that covers and supports a wire-type sensor prior to and
during insertion of the sensor into a catheter.
[0205]The term "slot" as used herein is a broad term, and is to be given
its ordinary and customary meaning to a person of ordinary skill in the
art (and are not to be limited to a special or customized meaning), and
refers without limitation to a relatively narrow opening.
[0206]The term "regulator" as used herein is a broad term, and is to be
given its ordinary and customary meaning to a person of ordinary skill in
the art (and are not to be limited to a special or customized meaning),
and refers without limitation to a device that regulates the flow of a
fluid or gas. For example, a regulator can be a valve or a pump.
[0207]The term "pump" as used herein is a broad term, and is to be given
its ordinary and customary meaning to a person of ordinary skill in the
art (and are not to be limited to a special or customized meaning), and
refers without limitation to a device used to move liquids, or slurries.
In general, a pump moves liquids from lower pressure to higher pressure,
and overcomes this difference in pressure by adding energy to the system
(such as a water system).
[0208]The term "valve" as used herein is a broad term, and is to be given
its ordinary and customary meaning to a person of ordinary skill in the
art (and are not to be limited to a special or customized meaning), and
refers without limitation to a device that regulates the flow of
substances (either gases, fluidized solids, slurries, or liquids), for
example, by opening, closing, or partially obstructing a passageway
through which the substance flows. In general, a valve allows no flow,
free flow and/or metered flow through movement of the valve between one
or more discreet positions.
[0209]The term "retrograde" as used herein is a broad term, and is to be
given its ordinary and customary meaning to a person of ordinary skill in
the art (and are not to be limited to a special or customized meaning),
and refers without limitation to orientation (e.g., of a catheter)
against the direction of blood flow.
[0210]The term "antegrade" as used herein is a broad term, and is to be
given its ordinary and customary meaning to a person of ordinary skill in
the art (and are not to be limited to a special or customized meaning),
and refers without limitation to orientation (e.g., of a catheter) with
the direction of blood flow.
[0211]The term "biological sample" as used herein is a broad term, and is
to be given its ordinary and customary meaning to a person of ordinary
skill in the art (and are not to be limited to a special or customized
meaning), and refers without limitation to any biological material to be
tested for the presence and/or concentration of an analyte in a sample.
Examples biological samples that may be tested include blood, serum,
plasma, saliva, urine, ocular fluid, semen, and spinal fluid, tissue, and
the like.
[0212]The terms "small diameter sensor," "small structured sensor," and
"micro-sensor" as used herein are broad terms, and are to be given their
ordinary and customary meaning to a person of ordinary skill in the art
(and are not to be limited to a special or customized meaning), and refer
without limitation to sensing mechanisms that are less than about 2 mm in
at least one dimension, and more preferably less than about 1 mm in at
least one dimension. In some embodiments, the sensing mechanism (sensor)
is less than about 0.95, 0.9, 0.85, 0.8, 0.75, 0.7, 0.65, 0.6, 0.5, 0.4,
0.3, 0.2, or 0.1 mm. In some embodiments, the sensing mechanism is a
needle-type sensor, wherein the diameter is less than about 1 mm (see,
for example, U.S. Pat. No. 6,613,379 to Ward et al. and in U.S. Patent
Publication No. US-2006-0020187-A1, both of which are incorporated herein
by reference in their entirety). In some alternative embodiments, the
sensing mechanism includes electrodes deposited on a planar substrate,
wherein the thickness of the implantable portion is less than about 1 mm,
see, for example U.S. Pat. No. 6,175,752 to Say et al. and U.S. Pat. No.
5,779,665 to Mastrototaro et al., both of which are incorporated herein
by reference in their entirety.
Overview
[0213]Intensive care medicine or critical care medicine is concerned with
providing greater than ordinary medical care and/or observation to people
in a critical or unstable condition. In recent years, an increasingly
urgent need has arisen, for more intensive care medicine. People
requiring intensive care include those recovering after major surgery,
with severe head trauma, life-threatening acute illness, respiratory
insufficiency, coma, haemodynamic insufficiency, severe fluid imbalance
or with the failure of one or more of the major organ systems
(life-critical systems or others). More than 5 million people are
admitted annually to intensive care units (ICUs) and critical care units
(CCUs) in the United States.
[0214]Intensive care is generally the most expensive, high technology and
resource intensive area of medical care. In the United States estimates
of the year 2000 expenditure for critical care medicine ranged from
$15-55 billion accounting for about 0.5% of GDP and about 13% of national
health care expenditure. As the U.S. population ages, these costs will
increase substantially. Accordingly, there is an urgent need to reducing
costs while at the same time reducing ICU/CCU mortality rates by
improving care. Some embodiments disclosed herein are suitable for use in
an intensive care or critical care unit of a medical care facility for
substantially continuously measuring a host's analyte concentration.
[0215]Hyperglycemia is a medical condition in which an excessive amount of
glucose circulates in a host. Medical studies suggest a relationship
between hyperglycemia and host outcome in intensive/critical care
settings. For example, perioperative hyperglycemia is associated with
increased rates and severity of myocardial infarction (MI) and stroke,
while tight glucose control with intravenous (IV) insulin therapy is
linked to a 30% reduction in mortality one year after admission for acute
MI. Furthermore, strict in-hospital glucose control is associated with
40% reductions of morbidity, mortality, sepsis, dialysis, blood
transfusions, as well as reduced length of stay, reduced costs and the
like.
[0216]Hyperglycemia can also be an issue in non-critical care settings,
such as in the general hospital population, such as for diabetes hosts
admitted for non-glucose-related medical conditions, or in clinical
settings, such as the doctor's office, such as during glucose challenge
tests, or treatment of the elderly or the very young, or others who may
have difficulty with glucose control.
[0217]Unfortunately, using generally available technology, tight glucose
control requires frequent monitoring of the host by the clinical staff,
IV insulin or injections, and on-time feeding. Frequent monitoring
typically requires a nurse or other staff member to measure the host's
glucose concentration using a lancet (to obtain a blood sample) and a
hand held glucose monitor. The nurse can perform this task many times a
day (e.g., every hour or more frequently). This task becomes an undue
burden that takes the nurse away from his/her other duties, or requires
extra staff. The preferred embodiments disclose systems and methods to
reduce and/or minimize the interaction required to regularly (e.g.,
continuously) measure the host's glucose concentration.
[0218]Unfortunately it has been shown that an effort to maintain tight
control of glucose levels (e.g., about 80-129 mg/dl) can increase the
risk of hypoglycemia using conventional systems and methods. For example,
administration of insulin, quality, and timing of meal ingestion, and the
like can lead to hypoglycemia. Because hypoglycemia can cause shock and
death (immediate problems), the clinical staff rigorously avoids it,
often by maintaining the host at elevated blood glucose concentrations
(which can degrade the clinical outcome in the long run) and causes the
problems of hyperglycemia discussed above.
[0219]Accordingly, in spite of clinically demonstrated improvements
associated with tight glucose control, institutions are slow to adopt the
therapy due to the increased workload on the staff as well as a pervasive
fear of hypoglycemia, which is potentially life ending. Therefore, there
is an urgent need for devices and methods that offer continuous, robust
glucose monitoring, to improve patient care and lower medical costs. The
preferred embodiments describe systems and methods for providing
continuous glucose monitoring while providing alarms or alerts that aid
in avoiding hypoglycemic events.
[0220]Hyperglycemia can be managed in a variety of ways. Currently, for
hosts in an intensive care setting, such as and ICU, CCU or emergency
room (ER), hyperglycemia is managed with sliding-scale IV insulin, that
stops insulin delivery at about 150 to 200 mg/dl. This generally requires
monitoring by a nurse (using a hand-held clinical glucose meter) and
insulin administration at least every six hours. Maintaining tight
glucose control within the normal range (e.g., 80-110 mg/dl) currently
requires hourly or even more frequent monitoring and insulin
administration. This places an undue burden on the nursing staff. The
preferred embodiments provide devices and methods for automated,
continuous glucose monitoring (e.g., indwelling in the circulatory
system), to enable tight glucose control.
[0221]The in vivo continuous analyte monitoring system of the preferred
embodiments can be used in clinical settings, such as in the hospital,
the doctor's office, long-term nursing facilities, or even in the home.
The present device can be used in any setting in which frequent or
continuous analyte monitoring is desirable. For example, in the ICU,
hosts are often recovering from serious illness, disease, or surgery, and
control of host glucose levels is important for host recovery. Use of a
continuous glucose sensor as described in the preferred embodiments
allows tight control of host glucose concentration and improved host
care, while reducing hypoglycemic episodes and reducing the ICU staff
work load. For example, the system can be used for the entire hospital
stay or for only a part of the hospital stay.
[0222]In another example, the continuous glucose monitor of the preferred
embodiments can be used in an ER setting. In the ER, a host may be unable
to communicate with the staff. Routine use of a continuous analyte
monitor (e.g., glucose, creatinine, phosphate, electrolytes, or drugs)
can enable the ER staff to monitor and respond to analyte concentration
changes indicative of the host's condition (e.g., the host's glucose
concentration) without host input.
[0223]In yet another example, a continuous analyte monitor can be used in
the general hospital population to monitor host analyte concentrations,
for various lengths of time, such as during the entire hospital stay or
for a portion of the hospital stay (e.g., only during surgery). For
example, a diabetic host's glucose concentration can be monitored during
his entire stay. In another example, a cardiac host's glucose can be
monitored during surgery and while in the ICU, but not after being moved
to the general host population. In another example, a jaundiced newborn
infant can have his bilirubin concentration continuously monitored by an
in-dwelling continuous analyte monitor until the condition has receded.
[0224]In addition to use in the circulatory system, the analyte sensor of
the preferred embodiments can be used in other body locations. In some
embodiments, the sensor is used subcutaneously. In another embodiment,
the sensor can be used intracranially. In another embodiment, the sensor
can be used within the spinal compartment, such as but not limited to the
epidural space. In some embodiments, the sensor of the preferred
embodiments can be used with or without a catheter.
Applications/Uses
[0225]One aspect of the preferred embodiments provides a system for in
vivo continuous analyte monitoring (e.g., glucose, O.sub.2, CO.sub.2,
PCO.sub.2, PO.sub.2, potassium, sodium, pH, lactate, urea, bilirubin,
creatinine, hematocrit, various minerals, various metabolites, and the
like) that can be operatively coupled to a catheter to measure analyte
concentration within the host's blood stream. In some embodiments, the
system includes an analyte sensor that extends a short distance into the
blood stream (e.g., out of the catheter) without substantially occluding
the catheter or the host's blood stream. The catheter can be fluidly
coupled to additional IV and diagnostic devices, such as a saline bag, an
automated blood pressure monitor, or a blood chemistry monitor device. In
some embodiments, blood samples can be removed from the host via the
sensor system, as described elsewhere herein. In one embodiment, the
sensor is a glucose sensor, and the medical staff monitors the host's
glucose level.
[0226]FIGS. 1A to 1E illustrate one embodiment of an exemplary analyte
sensor system 10 for measuring an analyte (e.g., glucose, urea,
potassium, pH, proteins, etc.) that includes a catheter 12 configured to
be inserted or pre-inserted into a host's blood stream. In clinical
settings, catheters are often inserted into hosts to allow direct access
to the circulatory system without frequent needle insertion (e.g.,
venipuncture). Suitable catheters can be sized as is known and
appreciated by one skilled in the art, such as but not limited to from
about 1 French (0.33 mm) or less to about 30 French (10 mm) or more; and
can be, for example, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16,
17, 18, 19, or 20 French (3 French is equivalent to about 1 mm) and/or
from about 33 gauge or less to about 16 gauge or more, for example, 33,
32, 31, 30, 29, 28, 27, 26, 25, 24, 23, 22, 21, 20, 19, 18, 17, or 16
gauge. Additionally, the catheter can be shorter or longer, for example
0.75, 1.0, 1.25, 1.5, 1.75, 2.0 inches in length or longer. The catheter
can be manufactured of any medical grade material known in the art, such
as but not limited to polymers and glass as described herein. A catheter
can include a single lumen or multiple lumens. A catheter can include one
or more perforations, to allow the passage of host fluid through the
lumen of the catheter.
[0227]The terms "inserted" or "pre-inserted" as used herein are broad
terms, and are to be given their ordinary and customary meaning to a
person of ordinary skill in the art (and are not to be limited to a
special or customized meaning), and refer without limitation to insertion
of one thing into another thing. For example, a catheter can be inserted
into a host's blood stream. In some embodiments, a catheter is
"pre-inserted," meaning inserted before another action is taken (e.g.,
insertion of a catheter into a host's blood stream prior to insertion of
a sensor into the catheter). In some exemplary embodiments, a sensor is
coupled to a pre-inserted catheter, namely, one that has been previously
inserted (or pre-inserted) into the host's circulatory system.
[0228]Referring now to FIGS. 1A to 1E, in some embodiments, the catheter
12 is a thin, flexible tube having a lumen 12a, such as is known in the
art. In some embodiments, the catheter can be rigid; in other
embodiments, the catheter can be custom manufactured to desired
specifications (e.g., rigidity, dimensions, etc). The catheter can be a
single-lumen catheter or a multi-lumen catheter. At the catheter's
proximal end is a small orifice 12b for fluid connection of the catheter
to the blood stream. At the catheter's distal end is a connector 18, such
as a leur connector or other fluid connector known in the art.
[0229]The illustrations of FIGS. 1A to 1E show one exemplary embodiment of
the connector 18 including a flange 18a and a duct 18b. In the exemplary
embodiment, the flange 18a is configured to enable connection of the
catheter to other medical equipment (e.g., saline bag, pressure
transducer, blood chemistry device, and the like) or capping (e.g., with
a bung and the like). Although one exemplary connector is shown, one
skilled in the art appreciates a variety of standard or custom made
connectors suitable for use with the preferred embodiments. The duct 18b
is in fluid communication with the catheter lumen and terminates in a
connector orifice 18c.
[0230]In some embodiments, the catheter is inserted into the host's blood
stream, such as into a vein or artery by any useful method known in the
art. Generally, prior to and during insertion, the catheter is supported
by a hollow needle or trochar (not shown). For example, the supported
catheter can be inserted into a peripheral vein or artery, such as in the
host's arm, leg, hand, or foot. Typically, the supporting needle is
removed (e.g., pulled out of the connector) and the catheter is connected
(e.g., via the connector 18) to IV tubing and a saline drip, for example.
However, in one embodiment, the catheter is configured to operatively
couple to medical equipment, such as but not limited to a sensor system
of the preferred embodiments. Additionally and/or alternatively, the
catheter can be configured to operatively couple to another medical
device, such as a pressure transducer, for measurement of the host's
blood pressure.
[0231]In some embodiments, the catheter and the analyte sensor are
configured to indwell within the host's blood stream in vivo. An
indwelling medical device, such as a catheter or implant, is disposed
within a portion of the body for a period of time, from a few minutes or
hours to a few days, months, or even years. An indwelling catheter is
typically inserted within a host's vein or artery for a period of time,
often 2 or more days, a month, or even a few months. In some embodiments,
the catheter can indwell in a host's artery or vein for the length of a
perioperative period (e.g., the entire hospital stay) or for shorter or
longer periods. In some embodiments, the use of an indwelling catheter
permits continuous access of an analyte sensor to a blood stream while
simultaneously allowing continuous access to the host's blood stream for
other purposes, for example, the administration of therapeutics (e.g.,
fluids, drugs, etc.), measurement of physiologic properties (e.g., blood
pressure), fluid removal, and the like.
[0232]Referring again to FIGS. 1A to 1E, the system 10 also includes an
analyte sensor 14 configured to extend through the catheter lumen 12a
(see FIG. 1E), out of the catheter orifice 12b and into the host's blood
stream by about 0.010 inches to about 1 inch, or shorter or longer
lengths. In some embodiments, however, the sensor may not extend out of
the catheter, for example, can reside just inside the catheter tip. The
sensor can extend through the catheter in any functional manner. In some
embodiments, the sensor is configured to be held on an inner surface
(e.g., the lumen) or outer surface of the catheter, while in other
embodiments, the sensor is configured to "free float" within the lumen of
the catheter.
[0233]In some embodiments, the sensor 14 is configured to measure the
concentration of an analyte (e.g., glucose, O.sub.2, CO.sub.2, PCO.sub.2,
PO.sub.2, potassium, sodium, pH, lactate, urea, bilirubin, creatinine,
hematocrit, various minerals, various metabolites, and the like) within
the host's blood stream. Preferably, the sensor includes at least one
electrode (see, e.g., FIG. 3B), for example a working electrode; however
any combination of working electrode(s), reference electrode(s), and/or
counter electrode(s) can be implemented as is appreciated by one skilled
in the art. Preferably, the sensor 14 includes at least one exposed
electroactive area (e.g., working electrode), a membrane system (e.g.,
including an enzyme), a reference electrode (proximal to or remote from
the working electrode), and an insulator material. Various systems and
methods for design and manufacture of continuous analyte sensors are
described in more detail elsewhere herein. In some embodiments, the
sensor is a needle-type continuous analyte sensor, configured as
disclosed in U.S. Patent Publication No. US-2006-0020192-A1 and U.S.
Patent Publication No. US-2006-0036143, both of which are incorporated
herein by reference in their entirety. In some embodiments, the sensor is
configured to measure glucose concentration. Exemplary sensor
configurations are discussed in more detail, elsewhere herein.
[0234]Referring to FIGS. 1A to 1E, the sensor has a proximal end 14a and a
distal end 14b. At its distal end 14b, the sensor 14 is associated with
(e.g., connected to, held by, extends through, and the like) a fluid
coupler 20 having first and second sides (20a and 20b, respectively). The
fluid coupler is configured to mate (via its first side 20a) to the
catheter connector 18. In one embodiment, a skirt 20c is located at the
fluid coupler's first side and includes an interior surface 20d with
threads 20e (see FIGS. 1D and 1E). In this embodiment, the fluid coupler
is configured to mate with the connector flange 18a, which is screwed
into the fluid coupler via the screw threads. However, in other
embodiments, the fluid coupler is configured to mate with the connector
using any known mating configuration, for example, a snap-fit, a
press-fit, an interference-fit, and the like, and can include a locking
mechanism to prevent separation of the connector and fluid coupler. The
fluid coupler 20 includes a lumen 20f extending from a first orifice 20h
on its first side 20a to a second orifice 20i located on the fluid
coupler's second side 20b (FIGS. 1C1 to 1E). When the catheter connector
is mated with the fluid coupler, the catheter's lumen 12a is in fluid
communication with the fluid coupler's lumen 20f via orifices 18c and
20h.
[0235]FIGS. 1A to 1D show one embodiment of a fluid coupler 20, namely, a
Y-coupler; however, any known coupler configuration can be used,
including but not limited to a straight coupler, a T-coupler, a
cross-coupler, a custom configured coupler, and the like. In some
embodiments, the fluid coupler includes at least one valve (e.g., a
septum, a 3-way valve, a stop-cock valve), which can be used for a
variety of purposes (e.g., injection of drugs). The fluid coupler can be
made of any convenient material, such as but not limited to plastic,
glass, metal or combinations thereof and can be configured to withstand
known sterilization techniques.
[0236]In the exemplary embodiment, the second side 20b of the fluid
coupler 20 is configured to be operably connected to IV equipment,
another medical device or to be capped, and can use any known mating
configuration, for example, a snap-fit, a press-fit, an interference-fit,
and the like. In one exemplary embodiment, the second side 20b is
configured to mate with a saline drip, for delivery of saline to the
host. For example, the saline flows from an elevated bag of sterile
saline via tubing, through the fluid coupler, through the catheter and
into the host's blood system (e.g., vein or artery). In another
embodiment, a syringe can be mated to the fluid coupler, for example, to
withdraw blood from the host, via the catheter. Additional connection
devices (e.g., a three-way valve) can be operably connected to the fluid
coupler, to support additional functionality and connection of various
devices, such as but not limited to a blood pressure transducer.
[0237]Referring to the exemplary embodiment of FIGS. 1A and 1E, at least a
portion of the sensor 14 passes through the fluid coupler 20 (e.g., the
fluid coupler lumen 20f) and is operatively connected to sensor
electronics (not shown) via a hardwire 24. In alternative embodiments
however, the sensor electronics can be disposed in part or in whole with
the fluid coupler (e.g., integrally with or proximal to) or can be
disposed in part or in whole remotely from the fluid coupler (e.g., on a
stand or at the bed side). Connections between the sensor and sensor
electronics (in part or in whole) can be accomplished using known wired
or wireless technology. In one exemplary embodiment, the sensor is
hardwired to the electronics located substantially wholly remote from the
fluid coupler (e.g., disposed on a stand or near the bedside); one
advantage of remote electronics includes enabling a smaller sized fluid
coupler design. In another exemplary embodiment, a portion of the sensor
electronics, such as a potentiostat, is disposed on the fluid coupler and
the remaining electronics (e.g., electronics for receiving, data
processing, printing, connection to a nurses' station, etc.) are disposed
remotely from the fluid coupler (e.g., on a stand or near the bedside).
One advantage of this design can include more reliable electrical
connection with the sensor in some circumstances. In this embodiment, the
potentiostat can be hardwired directly to the remaining electronics or a
transmitter can be disposed on or proximal to the fluid coupler, for
remotely connecting the potentiostat to the remaining electronics (e.g.,
by radio frequency (RF)). In another exemplary embodiment, all of the
sensor electronics can be disposed on the fluid coupler. In still another
embodiment, the sensor electronics disposed on the fluid coupler include
a potentiostat.
[0238]Referring again to FIGS. 1A to 1E, a protective sheath 26 is
configured to cover at least a portion of the sensor 14 during insertion,
and includes hub 28 and slot 30. In general, the protective sheath
protects and supports the sensor prior to and during insertion into the
catheter 12 via the connector 18. The protective sheath can be made of
biocompatible polymers known in the art, such as but not limited to
polyethylene (PE), polyurethane (PE), polyvinyl chloride (PVC),
polycarbonate (PC), nylon, polyamides, polyimide, polytetrafluoroethylene
(PTFE), Teflon, nylon and the like. The protective sheath includes a hub
28, for grasping the sheath (e.g., while maintaining sterilization of the
sheath). In this embodiment, the hub additionally provides for mating
with the second side 20b of the fluid coupler 20, prior to and during
sensor insertion into the catheter. In this exemplary embodiment, the
slot of the protective sheath is configured to facilitate release of the
sensor therefrom. In this embodiment, after the sensor has been inserted
into the catheter, the hub is grasped and pulled from the second side of
the fluid coupler. This action peels the protective sheath from the
sensor (e.g., the sensor slides through the slot as the sheath is
removed), leaving the sensor within the catheter. The second side of the
fluid coupler can be connected to other medical devices (e.g., a blood
pressure monitor) or an IV drip (e.g., a saline drip), or capped. In
alternative embodiments, the sheath can fold (e.g., fold back or
concertinas) or retract (e.g., telescope) during insertion, to expose the
sensor. In other embodiments, the sheath can be configured to tear away
from the sensor before, during, or after insertion of the sensor. In
still other embodiments, the sheath can include an outlet hole 30a, to
allow protrusion of the sensor from the back end of the sheath (e.g.,
near the hub 28). One skilled in the art will recognize that additional
configurations can be used, to separate the sensor 14 from the sheath 26.
[0239]In some embodiments, the sheath 26 can be optional, depending upon
the sensor design. For example, the sensor can be inserted into a
catheter or other vascular access device with or without the use of a
protective sheath). In some embodiments, the sensor can be disposed on
the outer surface of a catheter (as described elsewhere herein) or on the
inner surface of a catheter; and no sheath is provided. In other
embodiments, a multi-lumen catheter can be provided with a sensor already
disposed within one of the lumens; wherein the catheter is inserted into
the host's vein or artery with the sensor already disposed in one of the
lumens.
[0240]In some alternative embodiments, an analyte sensor is integrally
formed on a catheter. In various embodiments, the catheter can be placed
into a host's vein or artery in the usual way a catheter is inserted, as
is known by one skilled in the art, and the host's analyte concentration
measured substantially continuously. In some embodiments, the sensor
system can be coupled to one or more additional devices, such as a saline
bag, an automated blood pressure monitor, a blood chemistry monitor
device, and the like. In one exemplary embodiment, the integrally formed
analyte sensor is a glucose sensor.
[0241]FIGS. 2A to 2B illustrate one exemplary embodiment of an analyte
sensor integrally formed on a catheter. The system 210 is configured to
measure an analyte (e.g., glucose, O.sub.2, CO.sub.2, PCO.sub.2,
PO.sub.2, potassium, sodium, pH, lactate, urea, bilirubin, creatinine,
hematocrit, various minerals, various metabolites, and the like) and
generally includes a catheter 212 configured for insertion into a host's
blood stream (e.g., via a vein or artery) and a sensor at least partially
integrally formed on the catheter's exterior surface 232. Preferably, the
sensor 214 includes at least one exposed electroactive area 240 (e.g., a
working electrode), a membrane system (e.g., including an enzyme), a
reference electrode (proximal to or remote from the working electrode),
and an insulator. Various systems and methods for design and manufacture
of continuous analyte sensors are described in more detail elsewhere
herein.
[0242]In this embodiment, the catheter includes a lumen 212a and an
orifice 212b at its proximal end, for providing fluid connection from the
catheter's lumen to the host's blood stream (see FIG. 2A).
[0243]In some embodiments, the catheter is inserted into a vein, as
described elsewhere herein. In other embodiments, the catheter is
inserted into an artery, as described elsewhere herein. The catheter can
be any type of venous or arterial catheter commonly used in the art
(e.g., peripheral catheter, central catheter, Swan-Gantz catheter, etc.).
The catheter can be made of any useful medical grade material (e.g.,
polymers and/or glass) and can be of any size, such as but not limited to
from about 1 French (0.33 mm) or less to about 30 French (10 mm) or more;
for example, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18,
19, or 20 French (3 French is equivalent to about 1 mm). In certain
embodiments, the catheter can be a single lumen catheter or a multi-lumen
catheter. In some embodiments, the catheter can include one or more
perforations, to allow the passage of host fluid through the lumen of the
catheter.
[0244]At its distal end 212c, the catheter 212 includes (e.g., in fluid
communication) a connector 218. The connector can be of any known type,
such as a leur lock, a T-connector, a Y-connector, a cross-connector or a
custom configuration, for example. In some embodiments, the connector
includes at least one valve. At a second side 218e (e.g., back end), the
connector 218 can be operatively connected to a saline system (e.g.,
saline bag and tubing), other medical devices (e.g., automatic blood
chemistry machine, dialysis machine, a blood bag for collecting donated
blood, etc.), or capped.
[0245]In some embodiments, the system 210 includes sensor electronics (not
shown) operatively connected to the analyte sensor, wherein the sensor
electronics are generally configured to measure and/or process the sensor
data as described in more detail elsewhere herein. In some embodiments,
the sensor electronics can be partially or wholly disposed with (e.g.,
integral with, disposed on, or proximal to) the connector 218 at the
distal end of the catheter or partially or wholly remote from the
catheter (e.g., on a stand or on the bedside). In one embodiment, the
sensor electronics disposed with the connector include a potentiostat. In
some embodiments, the sensor electronics are configured to measure the
host's analyte concentration substantially continuously. For example, the
sensor can measure the analyte concentration continuously or at time
intervals ranging from fractions of a second up to, for example, 1, 2, or
5 minutes or longer.
[0246]FIGS. 2C to 2F illustrate additional embodiments of the sensor shown
in FIGS. 2A to 2B. The catheter 212 is shown with an integral sensor 214
having at least one electrode 240 formed on its exterior surface 232
(e.g., FIG. 2F). In general, the sensor can be designed with 1, 2, 3, 4
or more electrodes and can be connected by traces (or the like) to
electrical contacts 218d (or the like) at the second end of the connector
218 (e.g., FIGS. 2A to 2F). In some embodiments, the sensor is hard-wired
to the sensor electronics; alternatively, any operable connection can be
used. Preferably, the sensor includes at least one working electrode and
at least one reference or counter electrode. In some embodiments, the
reference electrode is located proximal to the at least one working
electrode (e.g., adjacent to or near to the working electrode). In some
alternative embodiments, the reference electrode is located remotely from
the working electrode (e.g., away from the working electrode, such as but
not limited to within the lumen of the catheter 212 (or connector 218),
on the exterior of the sensor system, in contact with the patient (e.g.,
on the skin), or the like). In some embodiments, the reference electrode
is located proximal to or within the fluid connector, such as but not
limited to, coiled about the catheter adjacent to the fluid connector or
coiled within the fluid connector and in contact with fluid flowing
through the fluid coupler, such as saline or blood. In some embodiments,
the sensor can also include one or more additional working electrodes
(e.g., for measuring baseline, for measuring a second analyte, or for
measuring a substantially non-analyte related signal, and the like, such
as described in more detail in U.S. Patent Publication No.
US-2005-0143635-A1 and U.S. Patent Publication No. US-2007-0027385-A1
which are incorporated herein by reference in their entirety. In some
embodiments one or more counter electrodes can be provided on a surface
of the catheter or within or on the fluid connector.
[0247]In some of the preferred embodiments, the catheter is designed to
indwell within a host's blood flow (e.g., a peripheral vein or artery)
and remain in the blood flow for a period of time (e.g., the catheter is
not immediately removed). In some embodiments, the indwelling catheter
can be inserted into the blood flow for example, for a few minutes or
more, or from about 1 to 24 hours, or from about 1 to 10 days, or even
longer. For example, the catheter can indwell in the host's blood stream
during an entire perioperative period (e.g., from host admittance,
through an operation, and to release from the hospital).
[0248]In some embodiments, the catheter is configured as an intravenous
catheter (e.g., configured to be inserted into a vein). The catheter can
be inserted into any commonly used vein, such as in a peripheral vein
(e.g., one of the metacarpal veins of the arm); in some embodiments
(e.g., such as described with reference to FIGS. 1A to 1E) the analyte
sensor inserted into a catheter. In alternative embodiments, the sensor
is integrally formed on a catheter such as described in more detail with
reference to FIGS. 2A to 2F, for example. Other veins, such as leg or
foot veins, hand veins, or even scalp or umbilical veins, can also be
used.
[0249]In addition to sensing analyte levels via a sensor system as
described herein, the intravenous catheter can be used for delivery of
fluids and/or drugs to the host's circulatory system. The catheter can be
configured to be coupled to other medical devices or functions, for
example, saline, blood products, total parenteral feeding or medications
can be given to the host via the indwelling intravenous catheter. In some
embodiments, the catheter can be operatively connected to a pump, such as
an infusion pump, to facilitate flow of the fluids into the host and a
desired rate. For example, an infusion pump can pump saline into the host
at a rate of Icc per minute, or at higher or lower rates. The rate of
infusion can be changed (increased or decreased). For example, an
infusion can be temporarily stopped, to permit injection of pain
medication into the IV system, followed by increasing the infusion rate
(e.g., for 5 minutes) to rapidly deliver the pain medication to the
host's circulatory system.
[0250]In some embodiments, the catheter is configured as an arterial
catheter (e.g., configured to be inserted into an arterial line or as
part of an arterial line). Typically, an arterial catheter is inserted in
the wrist (radial artery), armpit (axillary artery), groin (femoral
artery), or foot (pedal artery). Generally, arterial catheters provide
access to the host's blood stream (arterial side) for removal of blood
samples and/or application of test devices, such as but not limited to a
pressure transducer (for measuring blood pressure automatically),
however, arterial catheters can also be used for delivery of fluids or
medications. In one embodiment, a catheter is inserted into an arterial
line and the sensor inserted into the catheter (e.g., functionally
coupled) as described elsewhere herein. Saline filled non-compressible
tubing is then coupled to the sensor, followed by a pressure transducer.
An automatic flushing system (e.g., saline) is coupled to the tubing as
well as a pressure bag to provide the necessary pressure. Electronics are
generally operatively coupled to the pressure transducer for calculating
and displaying a variety of parameters including blood pressure. Other
medical devices can also be connected to the arterial catheter, to
measure various blood components, such as but not limited to O.sub.2,
CO.sub.2, PCO.sub.2, PO.sub.2, potassium, sodium, pH, lactate, urea,
bilirubin, creatinine, hematocrit, various minerals, various metabolites,
and the like.
[0251]In another embodiment, a blood pressure measurement system is
inserted into the host and can be used as is known in the art. The
analyte sensor (e.g., glucose sensor), such as the embodiment shown in
FIGS. 1A-1E, is inserted into the pre-inserted (e.g., already
in-dwelling) catheter using the following general methodology. First, the
pressure transducer is temporarily disabled by disconnecting from the
pre-inserted catheter. A cap (optionally) covers the protective slotted
sheath and can be removed so as to enable the sensor to be grasped at the
fluid coupler. The sheath, which is generally more rigid than the sensor
but less flexible than a needle, is then threaded through the
pre-inserted catheter so as to extend beyond the catheter into the blood
stream (e.g., by about 0.001 inches to about 1 inches). The sheath is
then removed by sliding the sensor through a small outlet hole and/or
slot in the sheath. Thus, the sensor remains within the pre-inserted
catheter and the fluid coupler, which supports the distal portion of the
sensor, is coupled to the catheter itself. Saline filled non-compressible
tubing is then coupled to the second side (e.g., back end) of the fluid
coupler. The sensor electronics (whether adjacent to the fluid coupler or
otherwise wired to the fluid coupler) are then operatively connected
(e.g., wired or wirelessly) to the sensor to initiate sensor function.
[0252]In some embodiments, a portion of the sensor system (e.g., sensor,
catheter, or other component) can be configured to allow removal of blood
samples from the host's blood stream (e.g., artery or vein). Sample
removal can be done using any systems and methods known in the art, for
example, as is practiced for removing a blood sample from an arterial
catheter (e.g., and arterial line). In one such exemplary embodiment, any
tubing or equipment coupled to the second side of the fluid coupler is
disconnected. A syringe is then be coupled to the second side and blood
removed via the catheter by pulling back on the syringe plunger. In a
further embodiment, saline can be flushed through the fluid coupler and
catheter. In another embodiment, the fluid coupler can be configured with
a side valve, to allow coupling of a syringe, for removal of blood
samples or delivery of fluids, such as medications, without disconnecting
attached tubing of equipment, and the like. In still another embodiment,
a valve or diaphragm, for access to the system by a syringe, can be
coupled into the tubing at a short distance from the fluid coupler. In
yet another embodiment, the sensor is integrally formed on the arterial
catheter, such as the embodiment shown in FIGS. 2A-2B, and tubing can be
disconnected from the connector, a syringe operably associated with the
connector, and blood removed with the syringe. After blood collection,
the syringe is removed and the tubing reconnected to the connector.
[0253]In still another embodiment, the analyte sensor can be functionally
coupled to an extracorporeal blood flow device. A variety of devices
exist for testing various blood properties/analytes at the bedside, such
as but not limited to the blood gas and chemistry devices manufactured by
Via Medical, Austin, Tex., USA. These devices generally withdraw a blood
sample from the host, test the blood sample, and then return it to the
host. Such a device can be connected in series to the arterial catheter,
with the sensor in-between, and using systems and methods known in the
art. In one embodiment, a sensor, such as the embodiment shown in FIGS.
1A-1E, is functionally connected to an in-dwelling arterial catheter, as
described herein, and the extracorporeal blood flow device is connected
to the second side of the fluid coupler. In an alternative embodiment,
the sensor is integrally formed on the arterial catheter, such as the
embodiment shown in FIGS. 2A-2F, and the extracorporeal blood flow device
is functionally connected to the connector 218. Other devices, such as
but not limited to dialysis machines, heart-lung bypass machines or blood
collection bags, or other vascular access devices, can be functionally
coupled to the analyte sensor.
[0254]The analyte sensor system of the preferred embodiments can be
designed with a variety of alternative configurations. In some
embodiments, the sensor is connected to a fluid connection device. The
fluid connection device in these embodiments can be any standard fluid
connection device known in the art, such as a fluid coupler, or a fluid
coupler custom manufactured to preferred specifications. On its first
side, the fluid coupler is configured to couple to an existing catheter
or cannula (as described with reference to FIGS. 1A-1E). The catheter (or
cannula) is typically inserted into a vascular access device and/or into
a hospital host during a hospital stay. For example, the catheter can be
inserted into an arterial line (e.g., for removing blood samples or for
measuring blood pressure using a pressure transducer) or a venous line
(e.g., for intravenous delivery of drugs and other fluids). In general
practice, the catheter is inserted into the host's blood vessel, for
example, and maintained there for a period of time during the host's
hospital stay, such as part of the stay or during the entire stay (e.g.,
perioperatively). In one alternative embodiment, another vascular access
device (e.g., other than a catheter) can be used to receive the sensor.
In yet another alternative embodiment, the sensor system of the preferred
embodiments can be inserted into a vascular access device (e.g., rather
than the vascular system directly). Some examples of vascular access
devices include but are not limited to, catheters, shunts, automated
blood withdrawal devices and the like.
[0255]In some embodiments, such as the embodiment illustrated in FIGS. 1A
to 1E, the system 10 is configured such that the sensor is inserted into
a vascular access device, such as but not limited to a catheter 12 (e.g.,
a catheter that has been inserted into the host's blood stream prior to
sensor insertion). In general, catheters are small, flexible tubes (e.g.,
soft catheter) but they can also be larger, rigid tubes. Catheters are
inserted into a host's body cavity, vessel, or duct to provide access for
fluid removal or insertion, or for access to medical equipment. Catheters
can also be inserted into extracorporeal devices, such as but not limed
to an arterio-venous shunt for the transfer of blood from an artery to a
vein. Some catheters are used to direct access to the circulatory system
(e.g., venous or arterial catheters, Swan Gantz catheters) to allow
removal of blood samples, the infusion of fluids (e.g., saline,
medications, blood or total parenteral feeding) or access by medical
devices (e.g., stents, extracorporeal blood chemistry analysis devices,
invasive blood pressure monitors, etc.).
[0256]Preferably, the sensor is designed to include a protective cap, as
illustrated in FIGS. 1A-1E. Namely, FIGS. 1A and 1B illustrates the
catheter (the catheter cap having been removed prior to insertion), well
known to those skilled in the art, which can be inserted into the host's
blood vessel using standard methods. The sensor 14 is configured for
measurement of an analyte (e.g., glucose) in the host's body, and is in
fluid connection within the catheter lumen, which is in fluid connection
with the fluid coupler 20 of the sensor. The first side 20a of the fluid
coupler 20 of the sensor is designed to couple to the catheter, e.g., by
screwing or snapping thereon, and can also couple (on its second side
20b) with other medical devices. One advantage of the fluid coupler is
that it provides for a small amount of bleed back, to prevent air bubbles
in the host's blood stream.
[0257]The exemplary sensor system 10 of FIGS. 1A and 1B further includes a
slotted protective sheath 26 that supports and protects the sensor during
sensor insertion, for example, the sheath increases the sensor visibility
(e.g., the sensor is so thin that it can be difficult for some people to
see without the protective sheath) and provides for ease of sliding the
sensor into the catheter. The slotted protective sheath is configured to
fit within the fluid coupler and houses the sensor during insertion of
the sensor into the catheter (e.g., an indwelling catheter within the
host's blood flow). Preferably, the protective sheath is substantially
more rigid than the sensor and at the same time substantially more
flexible that a standard syringe needle, however other designs are
possible. To facilitate removal of the protective sheath, a slot 30 is
provided with an optional outlet hole 30a, which is described in more
detail with reference to FIG. 1C, and a hub 28. By grasping and pulling
the hub, the user (e.g., health care professional) can withdraw the
protective sheath after coupling the fluid coupler to the catheter. Prior
to insertion of the sensor, a cap is provided, to cover the protective
sheath, for example, to keep the sheath and sensor sterile, and to
prevent damage to the components during shipping and/or handling.
[0258]In general, the sensor system is configured with a potentiostat
and/or sensor electronics that are operatively coupled to the sensor. In
some embodiments, a portion of the sensor electronics, such as the
potentiostat, can be disposed directly on the fluid coupler. However,
some or all of the sensor electronics (including the potentiostat) can be
disposed remotely from the fluid coupler (e.g., on the bedside or on a
stand) and can be functionally coupled (e.g., wired or wireless), as is
generally known to those skilled in the art.
[0259]FIGS. 1C1 and 1C2 are cross-sectional views (not to scale) of the
fluid coupler, including a protective sheath 26, a sensor 14, and a cap
32 (cap to be removed prior to insertion) in one embodiment. The
protective sheath 26 extends through the fluid coupler and houses the
sensor, for sensor insertion into a catheter. The protective sheath
includes an optional outlet hole 30a, through which the sensor extends
and a slot 30 along a length of the protective sheath that communicates
with the outlet hole and enables the protective sheath to be removed
after the sensor has been inserted into the host's body. The protective
sheath includes a hub 28 for ease of handling.
[0260]In some embodiments, the glucose sensor is utilized in combination
with another medical device (e.g., a medical device or access port that
is already coupled to, applied to, or connected to the host) in a
hospital or similar clinical setting. For example, a catheter can be
inserted into the host's vein or artery, wherein the catheter can is
connected to additional medical equipment. In an alternative example, the
catheter is placed in the host to provide quick access to the host's
circulatory system (in the event of a need arising) and is simply capped.
In another example, a dialysis machine can be connected to the host's
circulatory system. In another example, a central line can be connected
to the host, for insertion of medical equipment at the heart (e.g., the
medical equipment reaches the heart through the vascular system, from a
peripheral location such as a leg or arm pit).
[0261]In practice of coupling to a catheter, before insertion of the
sensor, the access port is opened. In one exemplary embodiment of a
pre-inserted catheter that is capped, the cap is removed and the sensor
inserted into the catheter. The back end of the sensor system can be
capped or attached to additional medical equipment (e.g., saline drip,
blood pressure transducer, dialysis machine, blood chemistry analysis
device, etc.). In another exemplary embodiment, medical equipment (e.g.,
saline drip, blood pressure transducer, dialysis machine, blood chemistry
analysis device, etc.) is already connected to the catheter. The medical
equipment is disconnected from the catheter, the sensor inserted into
(and coupled to) the catheter and then the medical equipment reconnected
(e.g., coupled to the back end of the sensor system).
[0262]In some embodiments, the sensor is inserted directly into the host's
circulatory system without a catheter or other medical device. In one
such exemplary embodiment, the sheath covering the sensor is relatively
rigid and supports the sensor during insertion. After the sensor has been
inserted into the host's vein or artery, the supportive sheath is
removed, leaving the exposed sensor in the host's vein or artery. In an
alternative example, the sensor is inserted into a vascular access device
(e.g., with or without a catheter) and the sheath removed, to leave the
sensor in the host's vein or artery (e.g., through the vascular access
device).
[0263]In various embodiments, in practice, prior to insertion, the cap 32
over the protective sheath is removed as the health care professional
holds the glucose sensor by the fluid coupler 20. The protective sheath
26, which is generally more rigid than the sensor but more flexible than
a needle, is then threaded through the catheter so as to extend beyond
the catheter into the blood flow (e.g., by about 0.010 inches to about 1
inches). The protective sheath is then removed by sliding the sensor
through the (optional) outlet hole 30a and slotted portion 30 of the
sheath (e.g., by withdrawing the protective sheath by pulling the hub
28). Thus the sensor remains within the catheter; and the fluid coupler
20, which holds the sensor 14, is coupled to the catheter itself (via its
connector 18). Other medical devices can be coupled to the second side of
the fluid coupler as desired. The sensor electronics (e.g., adjacent to
the fluid coupler or otherwise coupled to the fluid coupler) are then
operatively connected (e.g., wired or wirelessly) to the sensor for
proper sensor function as is known in the art.
[0264]In another embodiment, the catheter 12 includes a plurality of
perforations (e.g., holes) that allow the host's fluid (e.g., blood) to
flow through the lumen 12a of the catheter. The fluid flowing through the
catheter can make contact with a sensor 14 inserted therein. In a further
embodiment, the sensor does not protrude out of the catheter's tip 12b
and the host's blood flowing through the perforated catheter's lumen
contacts the sensor's electroactive surfaces.
[0265]In still another embodiment, the catheter 12 includes at least a
first lumen and a second lumen. The sensor 14 is configured for insertion
into the catheter's first lumen. The second lumen can be used for
infusions into the host's circulatory system or sample removal without
disturbing the sensor within the first lumen.
[0266]FIGS. 2A-2F are schematic views of a sensor integrally formed
(integrally incorporated) onto a surface of a catheter, in some exemplary
embodiments. In some embodiments, the sensor can be integrally formed on
an exterior surface of the catheter. In other embodiments, the sensor can
be integrally formed on an interior surface of the catheter (e.g., on a
lumenal surface). In still other embodiments, the sensor can be
integrally formed on the sensor's tip (e.g., as indicated by 214a). In
yet other embodiments, the sensor can be integrally incorporated with the
catheter, for example by bonding a sensor of the type described in FIGS.
3A to 3C into an inner or outer surface of the catheter.
[0267]Generally, the sensor system is provided with a cap that covers the
catheter and in vivo portion of the integral sensor. A needle or trochar
that runs the length of the catheter supports the device during insertion
into the host's blood stream. Prior to use, medical caregiver holds the
device by the fluid connector 218 and removes the cap to expose the in
vivo portion of the device (e.g., the catheter). The caregiver inserts
the in vivo portion of the device into one of the host's veins or
arteries (depending upon whether the catheter is an intravenous catheter
or an arterial catheter). After insertion, the needle is withdrawn from
the device. The device is then capped or connected to other medical
equipment (e.g., saline bag, pressure transducer, blood collection bag,
total parenteral feeding, dialysis equipment, automated blood chemistry
equipment, etc.). In some alternative embodiments, the sensor-integrated
catheter can be in communication (e.g., fluid communication) with the
host's vascular system through a vascular access device.
[0268]In some embodiments, a glucose sensor system includes a sensing
mechanism substantially similar to that described in U.S. Patent
Publication No. US-2006-0020187-A1, which is incorporated herein by
reference in its entirety; for example, with platinum working electrode
and silver reference electrode coiled there around. Alternatively, the
reference electrode can be located remote from the working electrode so
as not to be inserted into the host, and can be located, for example,
within the fluid coupler, thereby allowing a smaller footprint in the
portion of the sensor adapted for insertion into the body (e.g., blood
stream); for example, without a coiled or otherwise configured reference
electrode proximal to the working electrode. Although a platinum working
electrode is discussed, a variety of known working electrode materials
can be utilized (e.g., Platinum-Iridium or Iridium). When located
remotely, the reference electrode can be located away from the working
electrode (e.g., the electroactive portion) at any location and with any
configuration so as to maintain bodily and/or in fluid communication
therewith as is appreciated by one skilled in the art.
[0269]In an alternative embodiment, the sensor tip 14a includes an
enlarged, atraumatic area, for example a dull or bulbous portion about
two times the diameter of the sensor or larger. In one exemplary
embodiment, the enlarged portion is created by heating, welding, crushing
or bonding a substantially rounded structure onto the tip of the sensor
(e.g., polymer or metal). In another exemplary embodiment, the tip of the
sensor is heated (e.g., arc welded or flash-butt resistance welded) to
cause the tip to enlarge (e.g., by melting). The enlarged portion can be
of any atraumatic shape, such as but not limited to oval, round,
cone-shaped, cylindrical, teardrop, etc. While not wishing to be bound by
theory, it is believed that an atraumatic or enlarged area enables
enhanced stability of a small diameter sensor in the blood flow and
ensures that the sensor remains within the blood flow (e.g., to avoid
piercing a vessel wall and/or becoming inserted subluminally.)
[0270]In some embodiments, a second working electrode can be provided on
the sensor for measuring baseline, and thereby subtracting the baseline
from the first working electrode to obtain a glucose-only signal, as
disclosed in copending U.S. Patent Publication No. US-2005-0143635-A1 and
U.S. Patent Publication No. US-2007-0027385-A1, herein incorporated by
reference in their entirety.
[0271]Referring now to FIGS. 2A-2E in more detail, some embodiments of the
analyte sensor system include a catheter 212 adapted for inserting into a
host in a hospital or clinical setting, wherein the analyte sensor 214 is
built integrally with the catheter 212. For example, a glucose sensor can
be integrally formed on the catheter itself. FIGS. 2A-2B illustrate one
embodiment, wherein the catheter 212 is configured both for insertion
into a host, and can be configured to couple to other medical devices on
its ex vivo end. However, coupling to other medical devices is not
necessary. In some embodiments, the catheter includes a connector 218
configured for connection to tubing or other medical devices, as
described herein. The embodiment shown in FIGS. 2A-2B includes two or
three electrodes 240 on the outer surface of the in vivo portion of the
catheter 212. In some embodiments, the catheter is perforated (as
described elsewhere herein) and at least one electrode is disposed within
the lumen (not shown) of the perforated catheter. In some embodiments,
the catheter includes a single lumen. In other embodiment, the catheter
includes two or more lumens.
[0272]With reference to FIGS. 2C-2E, in some embodiments, at least one
working electrode 240 is disposed on the exterior surface of the in vivo
portion of the catheter. Alternatively, the at least one working
electrode can be disposed on an interior surface of the catheter, the tip
of the catheter, extend from the catheter, and the like. In general, the
preferred embodiments can be designed with any number of electrodes,
including one or more counter electrodes, one or more reference
electrodes, and/or one or more auxiliary working electrodes. In further
embodiments, the electrodes can be of relatively larger or smaller
surface area, depending upon their uses. In one example, a sensor
includes a working electrode and a reference electrode that has a larger
surface area (relative to the surface area of the working electrode) on
the surface of the catheter. In another example, a sensor includes a
working electrode, a counter electrode, and a reference electrode sized
to have an increased surface area as compared to the working and/or
counter electrode. In some embodiments, the reference electrode is
disposed at a location remote from the working electrode, such as within
the connector (e.g., coiled within the connector). In some embodiments,
the reference electrode is located on the host's body (e.g., in body
contact).
[0273]The electrodes 240 can be deposited on the catheter using any
suitable techniques known in the art, for example, thick or thin film
deposition techniques. The electrodes can be formed of any advantageous
electrode materials known in the art (e.g., platinum, platinum-iridium,
palladium, graphite, gold, carbon, silver, silver-silver chloride,
conductive polymer, alloys, combinations thereof, and the like). In other
embodiments, one or more of the electrodes is formed from an electrically
conductive material (e.g., wire or foil comprising platinum,
platinum-iridium, palladium, graphite, gold, carbon, silver,
silver-silver chloride, conductive polymer, alloys, combinations thereof,
and the like) applied to the exterior surface of the catheter, such as
but not limited twisting, coiling, rolling or adhering.
[0274]In some embodiments, the catheter is (wired or wirelessly) connected
to sensor electronics (not shown, disposed on the catheter's connector
and/or remote from the catheter) so as to electrically connect the
electrodes on the catheter with the sensor electronics. The inserted
catheter (including the sensor integrally formed thereon) can be utilized
by other medical devices for a variety of functions (e.g., blood pressure
monitor, drug delivery, etc).
[0275]While not wishing to be bound by theory, a number of the systems and
methods disclosed in the preferred embodiments (e.g., an analyte sensor
to be disposed in communication with the host's blood), can be employed
in transcutaneous (e.g., transdermal) or wholly implantable analyte
sensor devices. For example, the sensor could be integrally formed on the
in vivo portion of a subcutaneous device or a wholly implantable device.
As another example, an enlarged surface area (e.g.,
bulbous end) can
useful in the design of a transcutaneous analyte sensor.
Exemplary Sensor Configurations
[0276]Referring to FIGS. 3A to 3C, in some embodiments, the sensor can be
configured similarly to the continuous analyte sensors disclosed in
co-pending U.S. patent application Ser. No. 11/360,250 filed Feb. 22,
2006 and entitled "ANALYTE SENSOR," herein incorporated by reference in
its entirety. The sensor includes a distal portion 342, also referred to
as the in vivo portion, adapted for insertion into the catheter as
described above, and a proximal portion 340, also referred to as an ex
vivo portion, adapted to operably connect to the sensor electronics.
Preferably, the sensor includes two or more electrodes: a working
electrode 344 and at least one additional electrode, which can function
as a counter electrode and/or reference electrode, hereinafter referred
to as the reference electrode 346. A membrane system is preferably
deposited over the electrodes, such as described in more detail with
reference to FIGS. 3A to 3C, below.
[0277]FIG. 3B is an expanded cutaway view of a distal portion of the
sensor in one embodiment, showing working and reference electrodes. In
preferred embodiments, the sensor is formed from a working electrode 344
(e.g., a wire) and a reference electrode 346 helically wound around the
working electrode 344. An insulator 345 is disposed between the working
and reference electrodes to provide electrical insulation therebetween.
Certain portions of the electrodes are exposed to enable electrochemical
reaction thereon, for example, a window 343 can be formed in the
insulator to expose a portion of the working electrode 344 for
electrochemical reaction.
[0278]In preferred embodiments, each electrode is formed from a fine wire
with a diameter of from about 0.001 inches or less to about 0.010 inches
or more, for example, and is formed from, e.g., a plated insulator, a
plated wire, or bulk electrically conductive material. Although the
illustrated electrode configuration and associated text describe one
preferred method of forming a sensor, a variety of known sensor
configurations can be employed with the analyte sensor system of the
preferred embodiments, such as U.S. Pat. No. 5,711,861 to Ward et al.,
U.S. Pat. No. 6,642,015 to Vachon et al., U.S. Pat. No. 6,654,625 to Say
et al., U.S. Pat. No. 6,565,509 to Say et al., U.S. Pat. No. 6,514,718 to
Heller, U.S. Pat. No. 6,465,066 to Essenpreis et al., U.S. Pat. No.
6,214,185 to Offenbacher et al., U.S. Pat. No. 5,310,469 to Cunningham et
al., and U.S. Pat. No. 5,683,562 to Shaffer et al., U.S. Pat. No.
6,579,690 to Bonnecaze et al., U.S. Pat. No. 6,484,046 to Say et al.,
U.S. Pat. No. 6,512,939 to Colvin et al., U.S. Pat. No. 6,424,847 to
Mastrototaro et al., U.S. Pat. No. 6,424,847 to Mastrototaro et al, for
example. All of the above patents are incorporated in their entirety
herein by reference and are not inclusive of all applicable analyte
sensors; in general, it should be understood that the disclosed
embodiments are applicable to a variety of analyte sensor configurations.
It is noted that much of the description of the preferred embodiments,
for example the membrane system described below, can be implemented not
only with in vivo sensors, but also with in vitro sensors, such as blood
glucose meters (SMBG).
[0279]In some embodiments, the working electrode comprises a wire formed
from a conductive material, such as platinum, platinum-iridium,
palladium, graphite, gold, carbon, conductive polymer, alloys, and the
like. Although the electrodes can by formed by a variety of manufacturing
techniques (bulk metal processing, deposition of metal onto a substrate,
and the like), it can be advantageous to form the electrodes from plated
wire (e.g., platinum on steel wire) or bulk metal (e.g., platinum wire).
It is believed that electrodes formed from bulk metal wire provide
superior performance (e.g., in contrast to deposited electrodes),
including increased stability of assay, simplified manufacturability,
resistance to contamination (e.g., which can be introduced in deposition
processes), and improved surface reaction (e.g., due to purity of
material) without peeling or delamination.
[0280]In some embodiments, the working electrode is formed of
platinum-iridium or iridium wire. In general, platinum-iridium and
iridium materials are generally stronger (e.g., more resilient and less
likely to fail due to stress or strain fracture or fatigue). It is
believed that platinum-iridium and/or iridium materials can facilitate a
wire with a smaller diameter to further decrease the maximum diameter
(size) of the sensor (e.g., in vivo portion). Advantageously, a smaller
sensor diameter both reduces the risk of clot or thrombus formation (or
other foreign body response) and allows the use of smaller catheters.
[0281]The electroactive window 343 of the working electrode 344 is
configured to measure the concentration of an analyte. In an enzymatic
electrochemical sensor for detecting glucose, for example, the working
electrode measures the hydrogen peroxide produced by an enzyme catalyzed
reaction of the analyte being detected and creates a measurable
electronic current For example, in the detection of glucose wherein
glucose oxidase produces hydrogen peroxide as a byproduct, hydrogen
peroxide reacts with the surface of the working electrode producing two
protons (2H.sup.+), two electrons (2e.sup.-) and one molecule of oxygen
(O.sub.2), which produces the electronic current being detected.
[0282]In preferred embodiments, the working electrode 344 is covered with
an insulating material 345, for example, a non-conductive polymer.
Dip-coating, spray-coating, vapor-deposition, or other coating or
deposition techniques can be used to deposit the insulating material on
the working electrode. In one embodiment, the insulating material
comprises parylene, which can be an advantageous polymer coating for its
strength, lubricity, and electrical insulation properties. Generally,
parylene is produced by vapor deposition and polymerization of
para-xylylene (or its substituted derivatives). While not wishing to be
bound by theory, it is believed that the lubricious (e.g., smooth)
coating (e.g., parylene) on the sensors of some embodiments contributes
to minimal trauma and extended sensor life. While parylene coatings are
generally preferred in some embodiments, any suitable insulating material
can be used, for example, fluorinated polymers,
polyethyleneterephthalate, polyurethane, polyimide, other nonconducting
polymers, and the like. Glass or ceramic materials can also be employed.
Other materials suitable for use include surface energy modified coating
systems such as are marketed under the trade names AMC18, AMC148, AMC141,
and AMC321 by Advanced Materials Components Express of Bellafonte, Pa. In
some alternative embodiments, however, the working electrode may not
require a coating of insulator.
[0283]The reference electrode 346, which can function as a reference
electrode alone, or as a dual reference and counter electrode, is formed
from silver, silver/silver chloride, and the like. In some embodiments,
the reference electrode 346 is juxtapositioned and/or twisted with or
around the working electrode 344; however other configurations are also
possible (e.g., coiled within the fluid connector, or an intradermal or
on-skin reference electrode). In the illustrated embodiments, the
reference electrode 346 is helically wound around the working electrode
344. The assembly of wires is then optionally coated or adhered together
with an insulating material, similar to that described above, so as to
provide an insulating attachment.
[0284]In some embodiments, a silver wire is formed onto the sensor as
described above, and subsequently chloridized to form silver/silver
chloride reference electrode. Advantageously, chloridizing the silver
wire as described herein enables the manufacture of a reference electrode
with optimal in vivo performance. Namely, by controlling the quantity and
amount of chloridization of the silver to form silver/silver chloride,
improved break-in time, stability of the reference electrode, and
extended life has been shown with some embodiments. Additionally, use of
silver chloride as described above allows for relatively inexpensive and
simple manufacture of the reference electrode.
[0285]In embodiments wherein an outer insulator is disposed, a portion of
the coated assembly structure can be stripped or otherwise removed, for
example, by hand, excimer lasing, chemical etching, laser ablation,
grit-blasting (e.g., with sodium bicarbonate or other suitable grit), and
the like, to expose the electroactive surfaces. Alternatively, a portion
of the electrode can be masked prior to depositing the insulator in order
to maintain an exposed electroactive surface area. In one exemplary
embodiment, grit blasting is implemented to expose the electroactive
surfaces, preferably utilizing a grit material that is sufficiently hard
to ablate the polymer material, while being sufficiently soft so as to
minimize or avoid damage to the underlying metal electrode (e.g., a
platinum electrode). Although a variety of "grit" materials can be used
(e.g., sand, talc, walnut shell, ground plastic, sea salt, and the like),
in some preferred embodiments, sodium bicarbonate is an advantageous
grit-material because it is sufficiently hard to ablate, e.g., a parylene
coating, without damaging, e.g., an underlying platinum conductor. One
additional advantage of sodium bicarbonate blasting includes its
polishing action on the metal as it strips the polymer layer, thereby
eliminating a cleaning step that might otherwise be necessary.
[0286]In the embodiment illustrated in FIG. 3B, a radial window 343 is
formed through the insulating material 345 to expose a circumferential
electroactive surface of the working electrode. Additionally, sections of
electroactive surface of the reference electrode are exposed. For
example, the sections of electroactive surface can be masked during
deposition of an outer insulating layer or etched after deposition of an
outer insulating layer.
[0287]In some applications, cellular attack or migration of cells to the
sensor can cause reduced sensitivity and/or function of the device,
particularly after the first day of implantation. However, when the
exposed electroactive surface is distributed circumferentially about the
sensor (e.g., as in a radial window), the available surface area for
reaction can be sufficiently distributed so as to minimize the effect of
local cellular invasion of the sensor on the sensor signal.
Alternatively, a tangential exposed electroactive window can be formed,
for example, by stripping only one side of the coated assembly structure.
In other alternative embodiments, the window can be provided at the tip
of the coated assembly structure such that the electroactive surfaces are
exposed at the tip of the sensor. Other methods and configurations for
exposing electroactive surfaces can also be employed.
[0288]In some embodiments, the working electrode has a diameter of from
about 0.001 inches or less to about 0.010 inches or more, preferably from
about 0.002 inches to about 0.008 inches, and more preferably from about
0.004 inches to about 0.005 inches. The length of the window can be from
about 0.1 mm (about 0.004 inches) or less to about 2 mm (about 0.078
inches) or more, and preferably from about 0.25 mm (about 0.01 inches) to
about 0.375 mm (about 0.015 inches). In such embodiments, the exposed
surface area of the working electrode is preferably from about 0.000013
in.sup.2 (0.0000839 cm.sup.2) or less to about 0.0025 in.sup.2 (0.016129
cm.sup.2) or more (assuming a diameter of from about 0.001 inches to
about 0.010 inches and a length of from about 0.004 inches to about 0.078
inches). The preferred exposed surface area of the working electrode is
selected to produce an analyte signal with a current in the picoAmp
range, such as is described in more detail elsewhere herein. However, a
current in the picoAmp range can be dependent upon a variety of factors,
for example the electronic circuitry design (e.g., sample rate, current
draw, A/D converter bit resolution, etc.), the membrane system (e.g.,
permeability of the analyte through the membrane system), and the exposed
surface area of the working electrode. Accordingly, the exposed
electroactive working electrode surface area can be selected to have a
value greater than or less than the above-described ranges taking into
consideration alterations in the membrane system and/or electronic
circuitry. In preferred embodiments of a glucose sensor, it can be
advantageous to minimize the surface area of the working electrode while
maximizing the diffusivity of glucose in order to optimize the
signal-to-noise ratio while maintaining sensor performance in both high
and low glucose concentration ranges.
[0289]In some alternative embodiments, the exposed surface area of the
working (and/or other) electrode can be increased by altering the
cross-section of the electrode itself. For example, in some embodiments
the cross-section of the working electrode can be defined by a cross,
star, cloverleaf, ribbed, dimpled, ridged, irregular, or other
non-circular configuration; thus, for any predetermined length of
electrode, a specific increased surface area can be achieved (as compared
to the area achieved by a circular cross-section). Increasing the surface
area of the working electrode can be advantageous in providing an
increased signal responsive to the analyte concentration, which in turn
can be helpful in improving the signal-to-noise ratio, for example.
[0290]In some alternative embodiments, additional electrodes can be
included within the assembly, for example, a three-electrode system
(working, reference, and counter electrodes) and/or an additional working
electrode (e.g., an electrode which can be used to generate oxygen, which
is configured as a baseline subtracting electrode, or which is configured
for measuring additional analytes). U.S. Patent Publication No.
US-2005-0161346-A1, U.S. Patent Publication No. US-2005-0143635-A1, and
U.S. Patent Publication No. US-2007-0027385-A1 describe some systems and
methods for implementing and using additional working, counter, and/or
reference electrodes. In one implementation wherein the sensor comprises
two working electrodes, the two working electrodes are juxtapositioned
(e.g., extend parallel to each other), around which the reference
electrode is disposed (e.g., helically wound). In some embodiments
wherein two or more working electrodes are provided, the working
electrodes can be formed in a double-, triple-, quad-, etc. helix
configuration along the length of the sensor (for example, surrounding a
reference electrode, insulated rod, or other support structure). The
resulting electrode system can be configured with an appropriate membrane
system, wherein the first working electrode is configured to measure a
first signal comprising glucose and baseline (e.g., background noise) and
the additional working electrode is configured to measure a baseline
signal consisting of baseline only (e.g., configured to be substantially
similar to the first working electrode without an enzyme disposed
thereon). In this way, the baseline signal can be subtracted from the
first signal to produce a glucose-only signal that is substantially not
subject to fluctuations in the baseline and/or interfering species on the
signal.
[0291]Although the embodiments of FIGS. 3A to 3C illustrate one electrode
configuration including one bulk metal wire helically wound around
another bulk metal wire, other electrode configurations are also
contemplated. In an alternative embodiment, the working electrode
comprises a tube with a reference electrode disposed or coiled inside,
including an insulator therebetween. Alternatively, the reference
electrode comprises a tube with a working electrode disposed or coiled
inside, including an insulator therebetween. In another alternative
embodiment, a polymer (e.g., insulating) rod is provided, wherein the
electrodes are deposited (e.g., electro-plated) thereon. In yet another
alternative embodiment, a metallic (e.g., steel) rod is provided, coated
with an insulating material, onto which the working and reference
electrodes are deposited. In yet another alternative embodiment, one or
more working electrodes are helically wound around a reference electrode.
[0292]Preferably, the electrodes and membrane systems of the preferred
embodiments are coaxially formed, namely, the electrodes and/or membrane
system all share the same central axle. While not wishing to be bound by
theory, it is believed that a coaxial design of the sensor enables a
symmetrical design without a preferred bend radius. Namely, in contrast
to prior art sensors comprising a substantially planar configuration that
can suffer from regular bending about the plane of the sensor, the
coaxial design of the preferred embodiments do not have a preferred bend
radius and therefore are not subject to regular bending about a
particular plane (which can cause fatigue failures and the like).
However, non-coaxial sensors can be implemented with the sensor system of
the preferred embodiments.
[0293]In addition to the above-described advantages, the coaxial sensor
design of the preferred embodiments enables the diameter of the
connecting end of the sensor (proximal portion) to be substantially the
same as that of the sensing end (distal portion) such that the protective
slotted sheath is able to insert the sensor into the catheter and
subsequently slide back over the sensor and release the sensor from the
protective slotted sheath, without complex multi-component designs.
[0294]In one such alternative embodiment, the two wires of the sensor are
held apart and configured for insertion into the catheter in proximal but
separate locations. The separation of the working and reference
electrodes in such an embodiment can provide additional electrochemical
stability with simplified manufacture and electrical connectivity. One
skilled in the art will appreciate that a variety of electrode
configurations can be implemented with the preferred embodiments.
[0295]In addition to the above-described configurations, the reference
electrode can be separated from the working electrode, and coiled within
a portion of the fluid connector, in some embodiments. In another
embodiment, the reference electrode is coiled within the fluid connector
and adjacent to its first side. In an alternative embodiment, the
reference electrode is coiled within the fluid connector and adjacent to
its second side. In such embodiments, the reference electrode is in
contact with fluid, such as saline from a saline drip that is flowing
into the host, or such as blood that is being withdrawn from the host.
While not wishing to be bound by theory, this configuration is believed
to be advantageous because the sensor is thinner, allowing the use of
smaller catheters and/or a reduced likelihood to thrombus production.
[0296]In another embodiment, the reference electrode 346 can be disposed
farther away from the electroactive portion of the working electrode 343
(e.g., closer to the fluid connector). In some embodiments, the reference
electrode is located proximal to or within the fluid coupler, such as but
not limited to, coiled about the catheter adjacent to the fluid coupler
or coiled within the fluid coupler and in contact with fluid flowing
through the fluid coupler, such as saline. These configurations can also
minimize at least a portion of the sensor diameter and thereby allow the
use of smaller catheters and reduce the risk of clots.
[0297]In addition to the embodiments described above, the sensor can be
configured with additional working electrodes as described in U.S. Patent
Publication No. US-2005-0143635-A1, U.S. Pat. No. 7,081,195, and U.S.
Patent Publication No. US-2007-0027385-A1, herein incorporated by
reference in their entirety. For example, in one embodiment have an
auxiliary working electrode, wherein the auxiliary working electrode
comprises a wire formed from a conductive material, such as described
with reference to the glucose-measuring working electrode above.
Preferably, the reference electrode, which can function as a reference
electrode alone, or as a dual reference and counter electrode, is formed
from silver, Silver/Silver chloride, and the like.
[0298]In some embodiments, the electrodes are juxtapositioned and/or
twisted with or around each other; however other configurations are also
possible. In one example, the auxiliary working electrode and reference
electrode can be helically wound around the glucose-measuring working
electrode. Alternatively, the auxiliary working electrode and reference
electrode can be formed as a double helix around a length of the
glucose-measuring working electrode. The assembly of wires can then be
optionally coated together with an insulating material, similar to that
described above, in order to provide an insulating attachment. Some
portion of the coated assembly structure is then stripped, for example
using an excimer laser, chemical etching, and the like, to expose the
necessary electroactive surfaces. In some alternative embodiments,
additional electrodes can be included within the assembly, for example, a
three-electrode system (including separate reference and counter
electrodes) as is appreciated by one skilled in the art.
[0299]In some alternative embodiments, the sensor is configured as a
dual-electrode system. In one such dual-electrode system, a first
electrode functions as a hydrogen peroxide sensor including a membrane
system containing glucose-oxidase disposed thereon, which operates as
described herein. A second electrode is a hydrogen peroxide sensor that
is configured similar to the first electrode, but with a modified
membrane system (without active enzyme, for example). This second
electrode provides a signal composed mostly of the baseline signal, b.
[0300]In some dual-electrode systems, the baseline signal is
(electronically or digitally) subtracted from the glucose signal to
obtain a glucose signal substantially without baseline. Accordingly,
calibration of the resultant difference signal can be performed by
solving the equation y=mx with a single paired measurement. Calibration
of the inserted sensor in this alternative embodiment can be made less
dependent on the values/range of the paired measurements, less sensitive
to error in manual blood glucose measurements, and can facilitate the
sensor's use as a primary source of glucose information for the user.
U.S. Patent Publication No. US-2005-0143635-A1 describes systems and
methods for subtracting the baseline from a sensor signal.
[0301]In some alternative dual-electrode system embodiments, the analyte
sensor is configured to transmit signals obtained from each electrode
separately (e.g., without subtraction of the baseline signal). In this
way, the receiver can process these signals to determine additional
information about the sensor and/or analyte concentration. For example,
by comparing the signals from the first and second electrodes, changes in
baseline and/or sensitivity can be detected and/or measured and used to
update calibration (e.g., without the use of a reference analyte value).
In one such example, by monitoring the corresponding first and second
signals over time, an amount of signal contributed by baseline can be
measured. In another such example, by comparing fluctuations in the
correlating signals over time, changes in sensitivity can be detected
and/or measured.
[0302]In some embodiments, the reference electrode can be disposed
remotely from the working electrode. In one embodiment, the reference
electrode remains within the fluid flow, but is disposed within the fluid
coupler. For example, the reference electrode can be coiled within the
fluid coupler such that it is contact with saline flowing into the host,
but it is not in physical contact with the host's blood (except when
blood is withdrawn from the catheter). In another embodiment, the
reference electrode is removed from fluid flow, but still maintains
bodily fluid contact. For example, the reference electrode can be wired
to an adhesive patch that is adhered to the host, such that the reference
electrode is in contact with the host's skin. In yet another embodiment,
the reference electrode can be external from the system, such as but not
limited to in contact with the exterior of the ex vivo portion of the
system, in fluid or electrical contact with a connected saline drip or
other medical device, or in bodily contact, such as is generally done
with EKG electrical contacts. While not wishing to be bound by theory, it
is believed to locating the reference electrode remotely from the working
electrode permits manufacture of a smaller sensor footprint (e.g.,
diameter) that will have relatively less affect on the host's blood flow,
such as less thrombosis, than a sensor having a relatively larger
footprint (e.g., wherein both the working electrode and the reference
electrode are adjacent to each other and within the blood path).
[0303]In some embodiments of the sensor system, in vivo portion of the
sensor (e.g., the tip 14a) has an enlarged area (e.g., a
bulbous, nail
head-shaped, football-shaped, cone-shaped, cylindrical, etc. portion) as
compared a substantial portion of the sensor (e.g., diameter of the in
vivo portion of the sensor). The sensor tip can be made bulbous by any
convenient systems and methods known in the art, such as but not limited
to arc welding, crimping, smashing, welding, molding, heating, and plasma
arc welding. While not wishing to be bound by theory, it is believed that
an enlarged sensor tip (e.g.,
bulbous) will prevent vessel piercing as
the sensor is pushed forward into the vessel.
[0304]The sensor of the preferred embodiments is designed with a minimally
invasive architecture so as to minimize reactions or effects on the blood
flow (or on the sensor in the blood flow). Accordingly, the sensor
designs described herein, consider minimization of dimensions and
arrangement of the electrodes and other components of the sensor system,
particularly the in vivo portion of the sensor (or any portion of the
sensor in fluid contact with the blood flow).
[0305]Accordingly, in some embodiments, a substantial portion of the in
vivo portion of the sensor is designed with at least one dimension less
than about 0.020, 0.015, 0.012, 0.010, 0.008, 0.006, 0.005, 0.004 inches.
In some embodiments, a substantial portion of the sensor that is in fluid
contact with the blood flow is designed with at least one dimension less
than about 0.015, 0.012, 0.010, 0.008, 0.006, 0.005, 0.004, 0.003, 0.002,
0.001 inches. As one exemplary embodiment, a sensor such as described in
more detail with reference to FIGS. 1A to 1C is formed from a 0.004 inch
conductive wire (e.g., platinum) for a diameter of about 0.004 inches
along a substantial portion of the sensor (e.g., in vivo portion or fluid
contact portion). As another exemplary embodiment, a sensor such as
described in more detail with reference to FIGS. 1A to 1C is formed from
a 0.004 inch conductive wire and vapor deposited with an insulator
material for a diameter of about 0.005 inches along a substantial portion
of the sensor (e.g., in vivo portion or fluid contact portion), after
which a desired electroactive surface area can be exposed. In the above
two exemplary embodiments, the reference electrode can be located remote
from the working electrode (e.g., formed from the conductive wire). While
the devices and methods described herein are directed to use within the
host's blood stream, one skilled in the art will recognize that the
systems, configurations, methods and principles of operation described
herein can be incorporated into other analyte sensing devices, such as
but not limited to subcutaneous devices or wholly implantable devices
such as described in U.S. Publication 2006-0016700, which is incorporated
herein by reference in its entirety.
[0306]FIG. 3C is a cross section of the sensor shown in FIG. 3B, taken at
line C-C. Preferably, a membrane system (see FIG. 3C) is deposited over
the electroactive surfaces of the sensor and includes a plurality of
domains or layers, such as described in more detail below, with reference
to FIGS. 3B and 3C. The membrane system can be deposited on the exposed
electroactive surfaces using known thin film techniques (for example,
spraying, electro-depositing, dipping, and the like). In one exemplary
embodiment, each domain is deposited by dipping the sensor into a
solution and drawing out the sensor at a speed that provides the
appropriate domain thickness. In general, the membrane system can be
disposed over (deposited on) the electroactive surfaces using methods
appreciated by one skilled in the art.
[0307]In general, the membrane system includes a plurality of domains, for
example, an electrode domain 347, an interference domain 348, an enzyme
domain 349 (for example, including glucose oxidase), and a resistance
domain 350, as shown in FIG. 3C, and can include a high oxygen solubility
domain, and/or a bioprotective domain (not shown), such as is described
in more detail in U.S. Patent Publication No. US-2005-0245799-A1, and
such as is described in more detail below. The membrane system can be
deposited on the exposed electroactive surfaces using known thin film
techniques (for example, vapor deposition, spraying, electro-depositing,
dipping, and the like). In alternative embodiments, however, other vapor
deposition processes (e.g., physical and/or chemical vapor deposition
processes) can be useful for providing one or more of the insulating
and/or membrane layers, including ultrasonic vapor deposition,
electrostatic deposition, evaporative deposition, deposition by
sputtering, pulsed laser deposition, high velocity oxygen fuel
deposition, thermal evaporator deposition, electron beam evaporator
deposition, deposition by reactive sputtering molecular beam epitaxy,
atmospheric pressure chemical vapor deposition (CVD), atomic layer CVD,
hot wire CVD, low-pressure CVD, microwave plasma-assisted CVD,
plasma-enhanced CVD, rapid thermal CVD, remote plasma-enhanced CVD, and
ultra-high vacuum CVD, for example. However, the membrane system can be
disposed over (or deposited on) the electroactive surfaces using any
known method, as will be appreciated by one skilled in the art.
[0308]In some embodiments, one or more domains of the membrane systems are
formed from materials such as described above in connection with the
porous layer, such as silicone, polytetrafluoroethylene,
polyethylene-co-tetrafluoroethylene, polyolefin, polyester,
polycarbonate, biostable polytetrafluoroethylene, homopolymers,
copolymers, terpolymers of polyurethanes, polypropylene (PP),
polyvinylchloride (PVC), polyvinylidene fluoride (PVDF), polybutylene
terephthalate (PBT), polymethylmethacrylate (PMMA), polyether ether
ketone (PEEK), polyurethanes, cellulosic polymers, polysulfones and block
copolymers thereof including, for example, di-block, tri-block,
alternating, random and graft copolymers. U.S. Patent Publication No.
US-2005-0245799-A1 describes biointerface and membrane system
configurations and materials that may be applied to the preferred
embodiments.
Electrode Domain
[0309]In selected embodiments, the membrane system comprises an electrode
domain. The electrode domain 347 is provided to ensure that an
electrochemical reaction occurs between the electroactive surfaces of the
working electrode and the reference electrode, and thus the electrode
domain 347 is preferably situated more proximal to the electroactive
surfaces than the interference and/or enzyme domain. Preferably, the
electrode domain includes a coating that maintains a layer of water at
the electrochemically reactive surfaces of the sensor. In other words,
the electrode domain is present to provide an environment between the
surfaces of the working electrode and the reference electrode, which
facilitates an electrochemical reaction between the electrodes. For
example, a humectant in a binder material can be employed as an electrode
domain; this allows for the full transport of ions in the aqueous
environment. The electrode domain can also assist in stabilizing the
operation of the sensor by accelerating electrode start-up and drifting
problems caused by inadequate electrolyte. The material that forms the
electrode domain can also provide an environment that protects against
pH-mediated damage that can result from the formation of a large pH
gradient due to the electrochemical activity of the electrodes.
[0310]In one embodiment, the electrode domain 347 includes a flexible,
water-swellable, hydrogel film having a "dry film" thickness of from
about 0.05 microns or less to about 20 microns or more, more preferably
from about 0.05, 0.1, 0.15, 0.2, 0.25, 0.3, 0.35, 0.4, 0.45, 0.5, 1, 1.5,
2, 2.5, 3, or 3.5 microns to about 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14,
15, 16, 17, 18, 19, or 19.5 microns, and more preferably still from about
3, 2.5, 2, or 1 microns, or less, to about 3.5, 4, 4.5, or 5 microns or
more. "Dry film" thickness refers to the thickness of a cured film cast
from a coating formulation by standard coating techniques.
[0311]In certain embodiments, the electrode domain 347 is formed of a
curable mixture of a urethane polymer and a hydrophilic polymer.
Particularly preferred coatings are formed of a polyurethane polymer
having carboxylate or hydroxyl functional groups and non-ionic
hydrophilic polyether segments, wherein the polyurethane polymer is
crosslinked with a water-soluble carbodiimide (e.g.,
1-ethyl-3-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)carbodiimide (EDC)) in the presence of
polyvinylpyrrolidone and cured at a moderate temperature of about
50.degree. C.
[0312]In some preferred embodiments, the electrode domain 347 is formed
from a hydrophilic polymer (e.g., a polyamide, a polylactone, a
polyimide, a polylactam, a functionalized polyamide, a functionalized
polylactone, a functionalized polyimide, a functionalized polylactam or a
combination thereof) that renders the electrode domain substantially more
hydrophilic than an overlying domain, (e.g., interference domain, enzyme
domain). In some embodiments, the electrode domain is formed
substantially entirely and/or primarily from a hydrophilic polymer. In
some embodiments, the electrode domain is formed substantially entirely
from PVP. In some embodiments, the electrode domain is formed entirely
from a hydrophilic polymer. Useful hydrophilic polymers include but are
not limited to poly-N-vinylpyrrolidone (PVP), poly-N-vinyl-2-piperidone,
poly-N-vinyl-2-caprolactam, poly-N-vinyl-3-methyl-2-caprolactam,
poly-N-vinyl-3-methyl-2-piperidone, poly-N-vinyl-4-methyl-2-piperidone,
poly-N-vinyl-4-methyl-2-caprolactam, poly-N-vinyl-3-ethyl-2-pyrrolidone,
poly-N-vinyl-4,5-dimethyl-2-pyrrolidone, polyvinylimidazole,
poly-N,N-dimethylacrylamide, polyvinyl alcohol, polyacrylic acid,
polyethylene oxide, poly-2-ethyl-oxazoline, copolymers thereof and
mixtures thereof. A blend of two or more hydrophilic polymers is
preferred in some embodiments. In some preferred embodiments, the
hydrophilic polymer(s) is not crosslinked. In alternative embodiments,
crosslinking is preferred, such as by adding a crosslinking agent, such
as but not limited to EDC, or by irradiation at a wavelength sufficient
to promote crosslinking between the hydrophilic polymer molecules, which
is believed to create a more tortuous diffusion path through the domain.
[0313]An electrode domain formed from a hydrophilic polymer (e.g., PVP)
has been shown to substantially reduce break-in time of analyte sensors;
for example, a glucose sensor utilizing a cellulosic-based interference
domain such as described in more detail elsewhere herein. In some
embodiments, a uni-component electrode domain formed from a single
hydrophilic polymer (e.g., PVP) has been shown to substantially reduce
break-in time of a glucose sensor to less than about 2 hours, less than
about 1 hour, less than about 20 minutes and/or substantially
immediately, such as exemplified in Examples 9 through 11 and 13.
Generally, sensor break-in is the amount of time required (after
implantation) for the sensor signal to become substantially
representative of the analyte concentration. Sensor break-in includes
both membrane break-in and electrochemical break-in, which are described
in more detail elsewhere herein. In some embodiments, break-in time is
less than about 2 hours. In other embodiments, break-in time is less than
about 1 hour. In still other embodiments, break-in time is less than
about 30 minutes, less than about 20 minutes, less than about 15 minutes,
less than about 10 minutes, or less. In a preferred embodiment, sensor
break-in occurs substantially immediately. Advantageously, in embodiments
wherein the break-in time is about 0 minutes (substantially immediately),
the sensor can be inserted and begin providing substantially accurate
analyte (e.g., glucose) concentrations almost immediately post-insertion,
for example, wherein membrane break-in does not limit start-up time.
[0314]While not wishing to be bound by theory, it is believed that
providing an electrode domain that is substantially more hydrophilic than
the next more distal membrane layer or domain (e.g., the overlaying
domain; the layer more distal to the electroactive surface than the
electrode domain, such as an interference domain or an enzyme domain)
reduces the break-in time of an implanted sensor, by increasing the rate
at which the membrane system is hydrated by the surrounding host tissue
(see Examples 8, 9, 10 and 12). While not wishing to be bound by theory,
it is believed that, in general, increasing the amount of hydrophilicity
of the electrode domain relative to the overlaying layer (e.g., the
distal layer in contact with electrode domain, such as the interference
domain, enzyme domain, etc.), increases the rate of water absorption,
resulting in reduced sensor break-in time. The hydrophilicity of the
electrode domain can be substantially increased by the proper selection
of hydrophilic polymers, based on their hydrophilicity relative to each
other and relative to the overlaying layer (e.g., cellulosic-based
interference domain), with preferred polymers being substantially more
hydrophilic than the overlaying layer. In one exemplary embodiment, PVP
forms the electrode domain, the interference domain is formed from a
blend of cellulosic derivatives, such as but not limited to cellulose
acetate butyrate and cellulose acetate; it is believed that since PVP is
substantially more hydrophilic than the cellulosic-based interference
domain, the PVP rapidly draws water into the membrane to the electrode
domain, and enables the sensor to function with a desired sensitivity and
accuracy and starting within a substantially reduced time period after
implantation. Reductions in sensor break-in time reduce the amount of
time a host must wait to obtain sensor readings, which is particularly
advantageous not only in ambulatory applications, but particularly in
hospital settings where time is critical.
[0315]While not wishing to be bound by theory, it is believed that when
the water absorption of the overlying domain (e.g., the domain overlying
the electrode domain) is less than the water absorption of the electrode
domain (e.g., during membrane equilibration), then the difference in
water absorption between the two domains will drive membrane
equilibration and thus membrane break-in. Namely, increasing the
difference in hydrophilicity (e.g., between the two domains) results in
an increase in the rate of water absorption, which, in turn, results in a
decrease in membrane break-in time and/or sensor break-in time. As
discussed elsewhere herein, the relative hydrophilicity of the electrode
domain as compared to the overlying domain can be modulated by a
selection of more hydrophilic materials for formation of the electrode
domain (and/or more hydrophobic materials for the overlying domain(s)).
For example, an electrode domain with hydrophilic polymer capable of
absorbing larger amounts of water can be selected instead of a second
hydrophilic polymer that is capable of absorbing less water than the
first hydrophilic polymer. In some embodiments, the water content
difference between the electrode domain and the overlying domain (e.g.,
during or after membrane equilibration) is from about 1% or less to about
90% or more. In other embodiments, the water content difference between
the electrode domain and the overlying domain is from about 10% or less
to about 80% or more. In still other embodiments, the water content
difference between the electrode domain and the overlying domain is from
about 30% or less to about 60% or more. In preferred embodiments, the
electrode domain absorbs 5 wt. % or less to 95 wt. % or more water,
preferably 5, 10, 15, 20, 25, 30, 35, 40, 45, or 50 wt. % to about 55,
60, 65, 70, 75, 80, 85, 90 or 95 wt. % water than the adjacent
(overlying) domain (e.g., the domain that is more distal to the
electroactive surface than the electrode domain).
[0316]In another example, the rate of water absorption by a polymer can be
affected by other factors, such as but not limited to the polymer's
molecular weight. For example, the rate of water absorption by PVP is
dependent upon its molecular weight, which is typically from about 40 kDa
or less to about 360 kDa or more; with a lower molecular weight PVP
(e.g., 40 kDa) absorbing water faster than a higher molecular weight PVP.
Accordingly, modulating factors, such as molecular weight, that affect
the rate of water absorption by a polymer, can promote the proper
selection of materials for electrode domain fabrication. In one
embodiment, a lower molecular weight PVP is selected, to reduce break-in
time.
[0317]Preferably, the electrode domain is deposited by known thin film
deposition techniques (e.g., spray coating or dip-coating the
electroactive surfaces of the sensor). In some embodiments, the electrode
domain is formed by dip-coating the electroactive surfaces in an
electrode domain solution (e.g., 5, 10, 15, 20, 25 or 30% or more PVP in
deionized water) and curing the domain for a time of from about 15
minutes to about 30 minutes at a temperature of from about 40.degree. C.
to about 55.degree. C. (and can be accomplished under vacuum (e.g., 20 to
30 mmHg)). In embodiments wherein dip-coating is used to deposit the
electrode domain, a preferred insertion rate of from about 1 to about 3
inches per minute into the electrode domain solution, with a preferred
dwell time of from about 0.5 to about 2 minutes in the electrode domain
solution, and a preferred withdrawal rate of from about 0.25 to about 2
inches per minute from the electrode domain solution provide a functional
coating. However, values outside of those set forth above can be
acceptable or even desirable in certain embodiments, for example,
depending upon solution viscosity and solution surface tension, as is
appreciated by one skilled in the art. In one embodiment, the
electroactive surfaces of the electrode system are dip-coated one time
(one layer) and cured at 50.degree. C. under vacuum for 20 minutes. In
another embodiment, the electroactive surfaces of the electrode system is
dip-coated and cured at 50.degree. C. under vacuum for 20 minutes a first
time, followed by dip coating and curing at 50.degree. C. under vacuum
for 20 minutes a second time (two layers). In still other embodiments,
the electroactive surfaces can be dip-coated three or more times (three
or more layers). In other embodiments, the 1, 2, 3 or more layers of PVP
are applied to the electroactive surfaces by spray coating or vapor
deposition. In some embodiments, a crosslinking agent (e.g., EDC) can be
added to the electrode domain casting solution to promote crosslinking
within the domain (e.g., between electrode domain polymer components,
latex, etc.). In some alternative embodiments however, no crosslinking
agent is used and the electrode domain is not substantially crosslinked.
[0318]In some embodiments, the deposited PVP electrode domain 347 has a
"dry film" thickness of from about 0.05 microns or less to about 20
microns or more, more preferably from about 0.05, 0.1, 0.15, 0.2, 0.25,
0.3, 0.35, 0.4, 0.45, 0.5, 1, 1.5, 2, 2.5, 3, or 3.5 microns to about 4,
5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, or 19.5 microns,
and more preferably still from about 2, 2.5 or 3 microns to about 3.5, 4,
4.5, or 5 microns.
[0319]Although an independent electrode domain 347 is described herein, in
some embodiments sufficient hydrophilicity can be provided in the
interference domain and/or enzyme domain (the domain adjacent to the
electroactive surfaces) so as to provide for the full transport of ions
in the aqueous environment (e.g., without a distinct electrode domain).
In these embodiments, an electrode domain is not necessary.
Interference Domain
[0320]Interferents are molecules or other species that are reduced or
oxidized at the electrochemically reactive surfaces of the sensor, either
directly or via an electron transfer agent, to produce a false positive
analyte signal (e.g., a non-analyte-related signal). This false positive
signal causes the host's analyte concentration (e.g., glucose
concentration) to appear higher than the true analyte concentration.
False-positive signal is a clinically significant problem in some
conventional sensors. For example in a case of a dangerously hypoglycemic
situation, wherein the host has ingested an interferent (e.g.,
acetaminophen), the artificially high glucose signal can lead the host to
believe that he is euglycemic (or, in some cases, hyperglycemic). As a
result, the host can make inappropriate treatment decisions, such as
taking no action, when the proper course of action is to begin eating. In
another example, in the case of a euglycemic or hyperglycemic situation,
wherein a host has consumed acetaminophen, an artificially high glucose
signal caused by the acetaminophen can lead the host to believe that his
glucose concentration is much higher than it truly is. Again, as a result
of the artificially high glucose signal, the host can make inappropriate
treatment decisions, such as giving himself too much insulin, which in
turn can lead to a dangerous hypoglycemic episode.
[0321]In preferred embodiments, an interference domain 348 is provided
that substantially restricts or blocks the flow of one or more
interfering species therethrough; thereby substantially preventing
artificial signal increases. Some known interfering species for a glucose
sensor, as described in more detail herein, include acetaminophen,
ascorbic acid, bilirubin, cholesterol, creatinine, dopamine, ephedrine,
ibuprofen, L-dopa, methyl dopa, salicylate, tetracycline, tolazamide,
tolbutamide, triglycerides, and uric acid. In general, the interference
domain of the preferred embodiments is less permeable to one or more of
the interfering species than to the measured species, e.g., the product
of an enzymatic reaction that is measured at the electroactive
surface(s), such as but not limited to H.sub.2O.sub.2.
[0322]In one embodiment, the interference domain 348 is formed from one or
more cellulosic derivatives. Cellulosic derivatives can include, but are
not limited to, cellulose esters and cellulose ethers. In general,
cellulosic derivatives include polymers such as cellulose acetate,
cellulose acetate butyrate, 2-hydroxyethyl cellulose, cellulose acetate
phthalate, cellulose acetate propionate, cellulose acetate trimellitate,
and the like, as well as their copolymers and terpolymers with other
cellulosic or non-cellulosic monomers. Cellulose is a polysaccharide
polymer of .beta.-D-glucose. While cellulosic derivatives are generally
preferred, other polymeric polysaccharides having similar properties to
cellulosic derivatives can also be employed in the preferred embodiments.
[0323]In one preferred embodiment, the interference domain 348 is formed
from cellulose acetate butyrate. Cellulose acetate butyrate with a
molecular weight of about 10,000 daltons to about 75,000 daltons,
preferably from about 15,000, 20,000, or 25,000 daltons to about 50,000,
55,000, 60,000, 65,000, or 70,000 daltons, and more preferably about
20,000 daltons is employed. In certain embodiments, however, higher or
lower molecular weights can be preferred. In some embodiments, a blend of
two or more cellulose acetate butyrates having different molecular
weights is preferred. While a "blend" as defined herein (a composition of
two or more substances that are not substantially chemically combined
with each other and are capable of being separated) is generally
preferred, in certain embodiments a single polymer incorporating
different constituents (e.g., separate constituents as monomeric units
and/or substituents on a single polymer chain) can be employed instead.
Additionally, a casting solution or dispersion of cellulose acetate
butyrate at a wt. % of from about 5% to about 25%, preferably from about
5%, 6%, 7%, 8%, 9%, 10%, 11%, 12%, 13%, 14% or 15% to about 16%, 17%,
18%, 19%, 20%, 21%, 22%, 23%, 24% or 25%, and more preferably from about
5% to about 15% is preferred. Preferably, the casting solution includes a
solvent or solvent system, for example an acetone:ethanol solvent system.
Higher or lower concentrations can be preferred in certain embodiments.
In alternative embodiments, a single solvent (e.g., acetone) is used to
form a symmetrical membrane domain. A single solvent is used in casting
solutions for forming symmetric membrane layer(s). A plurality of layers
of cellulose acetate butyrate can be advantageously combined to form the
interference domain in some embodiments, for example, three layers can be
employed. It can be desirable to employ a mixture of cellulose acetate
butyrate components with different molecular weights in a single
solution, or to deposit multiple layers of cellulose acetate butyrate
from different solutions comprising cellulose acetate butyrate of
different molecular weights, different concentrations, and/or different
chemistries (e.g. functional groups). It can also be desirable to include
additional substances in the casting solutions or dispersions, e.g.,
functionalizing agents, crosslinking agents, other polymeric substances,
substances capable of modifying the hydrophilicity/hydrophobicity of the
resulting layer, and the like.
[0324]In one alternative embodiment, the interference domain 348 is formed
from cellulose acetate. Cellulose acetate with a molecular weight of
about 30,000 daltons or less to about 100,000 daltons or more, preferably
from about 35,000, 40,000, or 45,000 daltons to about 55,000, 60,000,
65,000, 70,000, 75,000, 80,000, 85,000, 90,000, or 95,000 daltons, and
more preferably about 50,000 daltons is preferred. In some embodiments, a
blend of two or more cellulose acetates having different molecular
weights is preferred. Additionally, a casting solution or dispersion of
cellulose acetate at a weight percent of about 3% to about 10%,
preferably from about 3.5%, 4.0%, 4.5%, 5.0%, 5.5%, 6.0%, or 6.5% to
about 7.5%, 8.0%, 8.5%, 9.0%, or 9.5%, and more preferably about 8% is
preferred. In certain embodiments, however, higher or lower molecular
weights and/or cellulose acetate weight percentages can be preferred. It
can be desirable to employ a mixture of cellulose acetates with molecular
weights in a single solution, or to deposit multiple layers of cellulose
acetate from different solutions comprising cellulose acetates of
different molecular weights, different concentrations, or different
chemistries (e.g. functional groups). It can also be desirable to include
additional substances in the casting solutions or dispersions such as
described in more detail above.
[0325]In addition to forming an interference domain from only cellulose
acetate(s) or only cellulose acetate butyrate(s), the interference domain
348 can be formed from combinations or blends of cellulosic derivatives,
such as but not limited to cellulose acetate and cellulose acetate
butyrate, or combinations of layer(s) of cellulose acetate and layer(s)
of cellulose acetate butyrate. In some embodiments, a blend of cellulosic
derivatives (for formation of an interference domain) includes up to
about 10 wt. % or more of cellulose acetate. For example, about 1, 2, 3,
4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 wt. % or more cellulose acetate is preferred, in some
embodiments. In some embodiments, the cellulosic derivatives blend
includes from about 90 wt. % or less to about 100 wt. % cellulose acetate
butyrate. For example, in some embodiments, the blend includes about 91,
92, 93, 94, 95, 96, 97, 98 or 99 wt. % cellulose acetate butyrate. In
some embodiments, the cellulosic derivative blend includes from about
1.5, 2.0, 2.5, 3.0 or 3.5 wt. % cellulose acetate to about 98.5, 98.0,
97.5, 97.0 or 96.5 wt. % cellulose acetate butyrate. In other
embodiments, the blend includes from about 4, 4.5, 5, 5.5, 6, 6.5, 7, 7.5
or 8 wt. % cellulose acetate to about 96, 95.5, 95, 94.5, 94, 93.3, 93,
92.5 or 92 wt. % cellulose acetate butyrate. In still other embodiments,
the blend includes from about 8.5, 9.0, 9.5, 10.0, 10.5 or 11.0 wt. %
cellulose acetate to about 91.5, 91.0, 90.5, 90, 89.5 or 89 wt. %
cellulose acetate butyrate.
[0326]In some embodiments, preferred blends of cellulose acetate and
cellulose acetate butyrate contain from about 1.5 parts or less to about
60 parts or more cellulose acetate butyrate to one part of cellulose
acetate. In some embodiments, a blend contains from about 2 parts to
about 40 parts cellulose acetate butyrate to one part cellulose acetate.
In other embodiments, about 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 18 or 20 parts
cellulose acetate butyrate to one part cellulose acetate is preferred for
formation of the interference domain 348. In still other embodiments, a
blend having from 22, 24, 26, 28, 30, 32, 34, 36 or 38 parts cellulose
acetate butyrate to one part cellulose acetate is preferred. As is
discussed elsewhere herein, cellulose acetate butyrate is relatively more
hydrophobic than cellulose acetate. Accordingly, the cellulose
acetate/cellulose acetate butyrate blend contains substantially more
hydrophobic than hydrophilic components.
[0327]Cellulose acetate butyrate is a cellulosic polymer having both
acetyl and butyl groups, in addition to hydroxyl groups. Acetyl groups
are more hydrophilic than butyl groups, and hydroxyl groups are more
hydrophilic than both acetyl and butyl groups. Accordingly, the relative
amounts of acetyl, butyl and hydroxyl groups can be used to modulate the
hydrophilicity/hydrophobicity of the cellulose acetate butyrate of the
cellulose acetate/cellulose acetate butyrate blend. A cellulose acetate
butyrate can be selected based on the compound's relative amounts of
acetate, butyrate and hydroxyl groups; and a cellulose acetate can be
selected based on the compounds relative amounts of acetate and hydroxyl
groups. For example, in some embodiments, a cellulose acetate butyrate
having about 35% or less acetyl groups, about 10% to about 25% butyl
groups, and hydroxyl groups making up the remainder is preferred for
formation of the interference domain 348. In other embodiments a
cellulose acetate butyrate having from about 25% to about 34% acetyl
groups and from about 15 to about 20% butyl groups is preferred. In still
other embodiments, the preferred cellulose acetate butyrate contains from
about 28% to about 30% acetyl groups and from about 16 to about 18% butyl
groups. In yet another embodiment, the cellulose acetate butyrate can
have no acetate groups and from about 20% to about 60% butyrate groups.
In yet another embodiment, the cellulose acetate butyrate has about 55%
butyrate groups and no acetate groups.
[0328]While an asymmetric interference domain can be used in some
alternative embodiments, a symmetrical interference domain 348 (e.g., of
cellulosic-derivative blends, such as but not limited to blends of
cellulose acetate components and cellulose acetate butyrate components)
is preferred in some embodiments. Symmetrical membranes are uniform
throughout their entire structure, without gradients of pore densities or
sizes, or a skin on one side but not the other, for example. In various
embodiments, a symmetrical interference domain 348 can be formed by the
appropriate selection of a solvent (e.g., no anti-solvent is used), for
making the casting solution. Appropriate solvents include solvents
belonging to the ketone family that are able to solvate the cellulose
acetate and cellulose acetate butyrate. The solvents include but are not
limited to acetone, methyl ethyl ketone, methyl n-propyl ketone,
cyclohexanone, and diacetone alcohol. Other solvents, such as furans
(e.g., tetra-hydro-furan and 1,4-dioxane), may be preferred in some
embodiments. In one exemplary embodiment, from about 7 wt. % to about 9
wt. % solids (e.g., a blend of cellulosic derivatives, such as cellulose
acetate and cellulose acetate butyrate) are blended with a single solvent
(e.g., acetone), to form the casting solution for a symmetrical
interference domain. In another embodiment, from about 10 to about 15%
solids are blended with acetone to form the casting solution. In yet
another embodiment, from about 16 to about 18% solids are blended with
acetone to form the casting solution. A relatively lower or greater
weight percent of solids is preferred to form the casting solution, in
some embodiments.
[0329]The casting solution can be applied either directly to the
electroactive surface(s) of the sensor or on top of an electrode domain
layer (if included in the membrane system). The casting solution can be
applied using any known thin film technique, as discussed elsewhere
herein. Additionally, in various embodiments, a symmetrical interference
domain 348 includes at least one layer; and in some embodiments, two,
three or more layers are formed by the sequential application and curing
of the casting solution.
[0330]The concentration of solids in the casting solution can be adjusted
to deposit a sufficient amount of solids on the electrode in one layer
(e.g., in one dip or spray) to form a membrane layer with sufficient
blocking ability, such that the equivalent glucose signal of an
interferent (e.g., compounds with an oxidation or reduction potential
that overlaps with that of the measured species (e.g., H.sub.2O.sub.2)),
measured by the sensor, is about 60 mg/dL or less. For example, in some
embodiments, the casting solution's percentage of solids is adjusted such
that only a single layer (e.g., dip one time) is required to deposit a
sufficient amount of the cellulose acetate/cellulose acetate butyrate
blend to form a functional symmetric interference domain that
substantially blocks passage therethrough of at least one interferent,
such as but not limited to acetaminophen, ascorbic acid, dopamine,
ibuprofen, salicylic acid, tolbutamide, tetracycline, creatinine, uric
acid, ephedrine, L-dopa, methyl dopa and tolazamide. In some embodiments,
the amount of interference domain material deposited by as single dip is
sufficient to reduce the equivalent glucose signal of the interferant
(e.g., measured by the sensor) to about 60 mg/dl or less. In preferred
embodiments, the interferent's equivalent glucose signal response
(measured by the sensor) is 50 mg/dl or less. In more preferred
embodiments, the interferent produces an equivalent glucose signal
response of 40 mg/dl or less. In still more preferred embodiments, the
interferent produces an equivalent glucose signal response of less than
about 30, 20 or 10 mg/dl. In one exemplary embodiment, the interference
domain is configured to substantially block acetaminophen passage
therethrough, wherein the equivalent glucose signal response of the
acetaminophen is less than about 30 mg/dl.
[0331]In alternative embodiments, the interference domain 348 is
configured to substantially block a therapeutic dose of acetaminophen.
The term "therapeutic dose" as used herein is a broad term, and is to be
given its ordinary and customary meaning to a person of ordinary skill in
the art (and is not to be limited to a special or customized meaning),
and refers without limitation to the quantity of any substance required
to effect the cure of a disease, to relieve pain, or that will correct
the manifestations of a deficiency of a particular factor in the diet,
such as the effective dose used with therapeutically applied compounds,
such as drugs. For example, a therapeutic dose of acetaminophen can be an
amount of acetaminophen required to relieve headache pain or reduce a
fever. As a further example, 1,000 mg of acetaminophen taken orally, such
as by swallowing two 500 mg tablets of acetaminophen, is the therapeutic
dose frequently taken for headaches. In some embodiments, the
interference membrane is configured to block a therapeutic dose of
acetaminophen, wherein the equivalent glucose signal response of the
acetaminophen is less than about 60 mg/dl. In a preferred embodiment, the
interference membrane is configured to block a therapeutic dose of
acetaminophen, wherein the equivalent glucose signal response of the
acetaminophen is less than about 40 mg/dl. In a more preferred
embodiment, the interference membrane is configured to block a
therapeutic dose of acetaminophen, wherein the equivalent glucose signal
response of the acetaminophen is less than about 30 mg/dl.
[0332]While not wishing to be bound by theory, it is believed that, with
respect to symmetrical cellulosic-based membranes, there is an inversely
proportional balance between interferent blocking and analyte
sensitivity. Namely, changes to the interference domain configuration
that increase interferent blocking can result in a corresponding decrease
in sensor sensitivity. Sensor sensitivity is discussed in more detail
elsewhere herein. It is believed that the balance between interferent
blocking and sensor sensitivity is dependent upon the relative
proportions of hydrophobic and hydrophilic components of the membrane
layer (e.g., the interference domain), with sensors having more
hydrophobic interference domains having increased interferent blocking
but reduces sensitivity; and sensors having more hydrophilic interference
domains having reduced interferent blocking but increased sensitivity. It
is believed that the hydrophobic and hydrophilic components of the
interference domain can be balanced, to promote a desired level of
interferent blocking while at the same time maintaining a desired level
of analyte sensitivity. The interference domain hydrophobe-hydrophile
balance can be manipulated and/or maintained by the proper selection and
blending of the hydrophilic and hydrophobic interference domain
components (e.g., cellulosic derivatives having acetyl, butyryl,
propionyl, methoxy, ethoxy, propoxy, hydroxyl, carboxymethyl, and/or
carboxyethyl groups). For example, cellulose acetate is relatively more
hydrophilic than cellulose acetate butyrate. In some embodiments,
increasing the percentage of cellulose acetate (or reducing the
percentage of cellulose acetate butyrate) can increase the hydrophilicity
of the cellulose acetate/cellulose acetate butyrate blend, which promotes
increased permeability to hydrophilic species, such as but not limited to
glucose, H.sub.2O.sub.2 and some interferents (e.g., acetaminophen). In
another embodiment, the percentage of cellulose acetate butyrate is
increased to increase blocking of interferants, but less permeability to
some desired molecules, such as H.sub.2O.sub.2 and glucose, is also
reduced.
[0333]One method, of manipulating the hydrophobe-hydrophile balance of the
interference domain, is to select the appropriate percentages of acetyl
groups (relatively more hydrophilic than butyl groups), butyl groups
(relatively more hydrophobic than acetyl groups) and hydroxyl groups of
the cellulose acetate butyrate used to form the interference domain 348.
For example, increasing the percentage of acetate groups on the cellulose
acetate butyrate will make the cellulose acetate butyrate more
hydrophilic. In another example, increasing the percentage of butyl
groups on the cellulose acetate butyrate will make the cellulose acetate
butyrate more hydrophobic. In yet another example, increasing the
percentage of hydroxyl groups will increase the hydrophilicity of the
cellulose acetate butyrate. Accordingly, the selection of a cellulose
acetate butyrate that is more or less hydrophilic (or more or less
hydrophobic) can modulate the over-all hydrophilicity of the cellulose
acetate/cellulose acetate butyrate blend. In one exemplary embodiment, an
interference domain can be configured to be relatively more hydrophobic
(and therefore block interferants more strongly) by reducing the
percentage of acetyl or hydroxyl groups or by increasing the percentage
of butyl groups on the cellulose acetate butyrate used in the casting
solution (while maintaining the relative ratio of cellulose acetate to
cellulose acetate butyrate).
[0334]In some alternative embodiments, the interference domain 348 is
formed of a blend of cellulosic derivatives, wherein the hydrophilic and
hydrophobic components of the interference domain are balanced, such that
the glucose sensitivity is from about 1 pA/mg/dL to about 100 pA/mg/dL,
and at least one interferent is sufficiently blocked from passage through
the interference domain such that the equivalent glucose signal response
of the at least one interferent is less than about 60 mg/dL. In a
preferred embodiment, the glucose sensitivity is from about 5 pA/mg/dL to
about 25 pA/mg/dL. In a more preferred embodiments, the glucose
sensitivity is from about 5 pA/mg/dL to about 25 pA/mg/dL and the
equivalent glucose signal response of the at least one interferent is
less than about 40 mg/dL. In a still more preferred embodiments, the
glucose sensitivity is from about 5 pA/mg/dL to about 25 pA/mg/dL and the
equivalent glucose signal response of the at least one interferent is
less than about 30 mg/dL. In some embodiments, the balance between
hydrophilic and hydrophobic components of the interference domain can be
achieved by adjusting the amounts of hydrophilic and hydrophobic
components, relative to each other, as well as adjusting the hydrophilic
and hydrophobic groups (e.g., acetyl, butyryl, propionyl, methoxy,
ethoxy, propoxy, hydroxyl, carboxymethyl, and/or carboxyethyl groups) of
the components themselves (e.g., cellulosic derivatives, such as but not
limited to cellulose acetate and cellulose acetate butyrate).
[0335]In some alternative embodiments, additional polymers, such as
Nafion.RTM., can be used in combination with cellulosic derivatives to
provide equivalent and/or enhanced function of the interference domain
348. As one example, a layer of a 5 wt. % Nafion.RTM. casting solution
was applied over a previously applied (e.g., and cured) layer of 8 wt. %
cellulose acetate, e.g., by dip coating at least one layer of cellulose
acetate and subsequently dip coating at least one layer Nafion.RTM. onto
a needle-type sensor such as described with reference to the preferred
embodiments. Any number of coatings or layers formed in any order may be
suitable for forming the interference domain of the preferred
embodiments.
[0336]In some alternative embodiments, more than one cellulosic derivative
can be used to form the interference domain 348 of the preferred
embodiments. In general, the formation of the interference domain on a
surface utilizes a solvent or solvent system, in order to solvate the
cellulosic derivative(s) (or other polymer) prior to film formation
thereon. In preferred embodiments, acetone and ethanol are used as
solvents for cellulose acetate; however one skilled in the art
appreciates the numerous solvents that are suitable for use with
cellulosic derivatives (and other polymers). Additionally, one skilled in
the art appreciates that the preferred relative amounts of solvent can be
dependent upon the cellulosic derivative (or other polymer) used, its
molecular weight, its method of deposition, its desired thickness, and
the like. However, a percent solute of from about 1 wt. % to about 25 wt.
% is preferably used to form the interference domain solution so as to
yield an interference domain having the desired properties. The
cellulosic derivative (or other polymer) used, its molecular weight,
method of deposition, and desired thickness can be adjusted, depending
upon one or more other of the parameters, and can be varied accordingly
as is appreciated by one skilled in the art.
[0337]In some alternative embodiments, other polymer types that can be
utilized as a base material for the interference domain 348 including
polyurethanes, polymers having pendant ionic groups, and polymers having
controlled pore size, for example. In one such alternative embodiment,
the interference domain includes a thin, hydrophobic membrane that is
non-swellable and restricts diffusion of high molecular weight species.
The interference domain 48 is permeable to relatively low molecular
weight substances, such as hydrogen peroxide, but restricts the passage
of higher molecular weight substances, including glucose and ascorbic
acid. Other systems and methods for reducing or eliminating interference
species that can be applied to the membrane system of the preferred
embodiments are described in U.S. Pat. No. 7,074,307, U.S. Patent
Publication No. US-2005-0176136-A1, U.S. Pat. No. 7,081,195, and U.S.
Patent Publication No. US-2005-0143635-A1. In some alternative
embodiments, a distinct interference domain is not included.
[0338]In some embodiments, the interference domain 348 is deposited either
directly onto the electroactive surfaces of the sensor or onto the distal
surface of the electrode domain, for a domain thickness of from about
0.05 micron or less to about 20 microns or more, more preferably from
about 0.05, 0.1, 0.15, 0.2, 0.25, 0.3, 0.35, 0.4, 0.45, 0.5, 1, 1.5, 2,
2.5, 3, or 3.5 microns to about 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15,
16, 17, 18, 19, or 19.5 microns, and more preferably still from about 1,
1.5 or 2 microns to about 2.5 or 3 microns. Thicker membranes can also be
desirable in certain embodiments, but thinner membranes are generally
preferred because they have a lower impact on the rate of diffusion of
hydrogen peroxide from the enzyme membrane to the electrodes
[0339]In general, the membrane systems of the preferred embodiments can be
formed and/or deposited on the exposed electroactive surfaces (e.g., one
or more of the working and reference electrodes) using known thin film
techniques (for example, casting, spray coating, drawing down,
electro-depositing, dip coating, and the like), however casting or other
known application techniques can also be utilized. Preferably, the
interference domain 348 is deposited by spray or dip coating. In one
exemplary embodiment of a needle-type (transcutaneous) sensor such as
described herein, the interference domain is formed by dip coating the
sensor into an interference domain solution using an insertion rate of
from about 0.5 inch/min to about 60 inches/min, preferably 1 inch/min, a
dwell time of from about 0 minute to about 2 minutes, preferably about 1
minute, and a withdrawal rate of from about 0.5 inch/minute to about 60
inches/minute, preferably about 1 inch/minute, and curing (drying) the
domain from about 1 minute to about 30 minutes, preferably from about 3
minutes to about 15 minutes (and can be accomplished at room temperature
or under vacuum (e.g., 20 to 30 mmHg)). In one exemplary embodiment
including cellulose acetate butyrate interference domain, a 3-minute cure
(i.e., dry) time is preferred between each layer applied. In another
exemplary embodiment employing a cellulose acetate interference domain, a
15 minute cure (i.e., dry) time is preferred between each layer applied.
[0340]In some embodiments, the dip process can be repeated at least one
time and up to 10 times or more. In other embodiments, only one dip is
preferred. The preferred number of repeated dip processes depends upon
the cellulosic derivative(s) used, their concentration, conditions during
deposition (e.g., dipping) and the desired thickness (e.g., sufficient
thickness to provide functional blocking of certain interferents), and
the like. In some embodiments, 1 to 3 microns may be preferred for the
interference domain thickness, however, values outside of these can be
acceptable or even desirable in certain embodiments, for example,
depending upon viscosity and surface tension, as is appreciated by one
skilled in the art. In one exemplary embodiment, an interference domain
is formed from three layers of cellulose acetate butyrate. In another
exemplary embodiment, an interference domain is formed from 10 layers of
cellulose acetate. In another embodiment, an interference domain is
formed from 1 layer of a blend of cellulose acetate and cellulose acetate
butyrate. In alternative embodiments, the interference domain can be
formed using any known method and combination of cellulose acetate and
cellulose acetate butyrate, as will be appreciated by one skilled in the
art.
[0341]In some embodiments, the electroactive surface can be cleaned prior
to application of the interference domain 348. In some embodiments, the
interference domain 348 of the preferred embodiments can be useful as a
bioprotective or biocompatible domain, namely, a domain that interfaces
with host tissue when implanted in an animal (e.g., a human) due to its
stability and biocompatibility.
Enzyme Domain
[0342]In preferred embodiments, the membrane system further includes an
enzyme domain 349 disposed more distally from the electroactive surfaces
than the interference domain 348; however other configurations can be
desirable. In the preferred embodiments, the enzyme domain provides an
enzyme to catalyze the reaction of the analyte and its co-reactant, as
described in more detail below. In the preferred embodiments of a glucose
sensor, the enzyme domain includes glucose oxidase; however other
oxidases, for example, galactose oxidase or uricase oxidase, can also be
used.
[0343]For an enzyme-based electrochemical glucose sensor to perform well,
the sensor's response is preferably limited by neither enzyme activity
nor co-reactant concentration. Because enzymes, including glucose
oxidase, are subject to deactivation as a function of time even in
ambient conditions, this behavior is compensated for in forming the
enzyme domain. Preferably, the enzyme domain is constructed of aqueous
dispersions of colloidal polyurethane polymers including the enzyme.
However, in alternative embodiments the enzyme domain is constructed from
an oxygen enhancing material, for example, silicone, or fluorocarbon, in
order to provide a supply of excess oxygen during transient ischemia.
Preferably, the enzyme is immobilized within the domain. See, e.g., U.S.
Patent Publication No. US-2005-0054909-A1.
[0344]In preferred embodiments, the enzyme domain is deposited onto the
interference domain for a domain thickness of from about 0.05 micron or
less to about 20 microns or more, more preferably from about 0.05, 0.1,
0.15, 0.2, 0.25, 0.3, 0.35, 0.4, 0.45, 0.5, 1, 1.5, 2, 2.5, 3, or 3.5
microns to about 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18,
19, or 19.5 microns, and more preferably still from about 2, 2.5 or 3
microns to about 3.5, 4, 4.5, or 5 microns. However in some embodiments,
the enzyme domain can be deposited directly onto the electroactive
surfaces. Preferably, the enzyme domain is deposited by spray or dip
coating. In one embodiment of needle-type (transcutaneous) sensor such as
described herein, the enzyme domain is formed by dip coating the
interference domain coated sensor into an enzyme domain solution and
curing the domain for from about 15 to about 30 minutes at a temperature
of from about 40.degree. C. to about 55.degree. C. (and can be
accomplished under vacuum (e.g., 20 to 30 mmHg)). In embodiments wherein
dip coating is used to deposit the enzyme domain at room temperature, a
preferred insertion rate of from about 0.25 inch per minute to about 3
inches per minute, with a preferred dwell time of from about 0.5 minutes
to about 2 minutes, and a preferred withdrawal rate of from about 0.25
inch per minute to about 2 inches per minute provides a functional
coating. However, values outside of those set forth above can be
acceptable or even desirable in certain embodiments, for example,
depending upon viscosity and surface tension, as is appreciated by one
skilled in the art. In one embodiment, the enzyme domain is formed by dip
coating two times (namely, forming two layers) in an enzyme domain
solution and curing at 50.degree. C. under vacuum for 20 minutes.
However, in some embodiments, the enzyme domain can be formed by dip
coating and/or spray coating one or more layers at a predetermined
concentration of the coating solution, insertion rate, dwell time,
withdrawal rate, and/or desired thickness.
Resistance Domain
[0345]In preferred embodiments, the membrane system includes a resistance
domain 350 disposed more distal from the electroactive surfaces than the
enzyme domain. Although the following description is directed to a
resistance domain for a glucose sensor, the resistance domain can be
modified for other analytes and co-reactants as well.
[0346]There exists a molar excess of glucose relative to the amount of
oxygen in blood; that is, for every free oxygen molecule in extracellular
fluid, there are typically more than 100 glucose molecules present (see
Updike et al., Diabetes Care 5:207-21 (1982)). However, an immobilized
enzyme-based glucose sensor employing oxygen as co-reactant is preferably
supplied with oxygen in non-rate-limiting excess in order for the sensor
to respond linearly to changes in glucose concentration, while not
responding to changes in oxygen concentration. Specifically, when a
glucose-monitoring reaction is oxygen limited, linearity is not achieved
above minimal concentrations of glucose. Without a semipermeable membrane
situated over the enzyme domain to control the flux of glucose and
oxygen, a linear response to glucose levels can be obtained only for
glucose concentrations of up to about 40 mg/dL. However, in a clinical
setting, a linear response to glucose levels is desirable up to at least
about 400 mg/dL.
[0347]The resistance domain includes a semipermeable membrane that
controls the flux of oxygen and glucose to the underlying enzyme domain,
preferably rendering oxygen in a non-rate-limiting excess. As a result,
the upper limit of linearity of glucose measurement is extended to a much
higher value than that which is achieved without the resistance domain.
In one embodiment, the resistance domain exhibits an oxygen to glucose
permeability ratio of from about 50:1 or less to about 400:1 or more,
preferably about 200:1. As a result, one-dimensional reactant diffusion
is adequate to provide excess oxygen at all reasonable glucose and oxygen
concentrations found in the subcutaneous matrix (See Rhodes et al., Anal.
Chem., 66:1520-1529 (1994)).
[0348]In alternative embodiments, a lower ratio of oxygen-to-glucose can
be sufficient to provide excess oxygen by using a high oxygen solubility
domain (for example, a silicone or fluorocarbon-based material or domain)
to enhance the supply/transport of oxygen to the enzyme domain. If more
oxygen is supplied to the enzyme, then more glucose can also be supplied
to the enzyme without creating an oxygen rate-limiting excess. In
alternative embodiments, the resistance domain is formed from a silicone
composition, such as is described in U.S. Patent Publication No.
US-2005-0090607-A1.
[0349]In a preferred embodiment, the resistance domain includes a
polyurethane membrane with both hydrophilic and hydrophobic regions to
control the diffusion of glucose and oxygen to an analyte sensor, the
membrane being fabricated easily and reproducibly from commercially
available materials. A suitable hydrophobic polymer component is a
polyurethane, or polyetherurethaneurea. Polyurethane is a polymer
produced by the condensation reaction of a diisocyanate and a
difunctional hydroxyl-containing material. A polyurethaneurea is a
polymer produced by the condensation reaction of a diisocyanate and a
difunctional amine-containing material. Preferred diisocyanates include
aliphatic diisocyanates containing from about 4 to about 8 methylene
units. Diisocyanates containing cycloaliphatic moieties can also be
useful in the preparation of the polymer and copolymer components of the
membranes of preferred embodiments. The material that forms the basis of
the hydrophobic matrix of the resistance domain can be any of those known
in the art as appropriate for use as membranes in sensor devices and as
having sufficient permeability to allow relevant compounds to pass
through it, for example, to allow an oxygen molecule to pass through the
membrane from the sample under examination in order to reach the active
enzyme or electrochemical electrodes. Examples of materials which can be
used to make non-polyurethane type membranes include vinyl polymers,
polyethers, polyesters, polyamides, inorganic polymers such as
polysiloxanes and polycarbosiloxanes, natural polymers such as cellulosic
and protein based materials, and mixtures or combinations thereof.
[0350]In a preferred embodiment, the hydrophilic polymer component is
polyethylene oxide. For example, one useful hydrophobic-hydrophilic
copolymer component is a polyurethane polymer that includes about 20%
hydrophilic polyethylene oxide. The polyethylene oxide portions of the
copolymer are thermodynamically driven to separate from the hydrophobic
portions of the copolymer and the hydrophobic polymer component. The 20%
polyethylene oxide-based soft segment portion of the copolymer used to
form the final blend affects the water pick-up and subsequent glucose
permeability of the membrane.
[0351]In some embodiments, the resistance domain is formed from a silicone
polymer modified to allow analyte (e.g., glucose) transport.
[0352]In some embodiments, the resistance domain is formed from a silicone
polymer/hydrophobic-hydrophilic polymer blend. In one embodiment, The
hydrophobic-hydrophilic polymer for use in the blend may be any suitable
hydrophobic-hydrophilic polymer, including but not limited to components
such as polyvinylpyrrolidone (PVP), polyhydroxyethyl methacrylate,
polyvinylalcohol, polyacrylic acid, polyethers such as polyethylene
glycol or polypropylene oxide, and copolymers thereof, including, for
example, di-block, tri-block, alternating, random, comb, star, dendritic,
and graft copolymers (block copolymers are discussed in U.S. Pat. Nos.
4,803,243 and 4,686,044, which are incorporated herein by reference). In
one embodiment, the hydrophobic-hydrophilic polymer is a copolymer of
poly(ethylene oxide) (PEO) and poly(propylene oxide) (PPO). Suitable such
polymers include, but are not limited to, PEO-PPO diblock copolymers,
PPO-PEO-PPO triblock copolymers, PEO-PPO-PEO triblock copolymers,
alternating block copolymers of PEO-PPO, random copolymers of ethylene
oxide and propylene oxide, and blends thereof. In some embodiments, the
copolymers may be optionally substituted with hydroxy substituents.
Commercially available examples of PEO and PPO copolymers include the
PLURONIC.RTM. brand of polymers available from BASF.RTM.. In one
embodiment, PLURONIC.RTM. F-127 is used. Other PLURONIC.RTM. polymers
include PPO-PEO-PPO triblock copolymers (e.g., PLURONIC.RTM. R products).
Other suitable commercial polymers include, but are not limited to,
SYNPERONICS.RTM. products available from UNIQEMA.RTM.. Co-pending U.S.
patent application Ser. No. 11/404,417 and entitled, "SILICONE BASED
MEMBRANES FOR USE IN IMPLANTABLE GLUCOSE SENSORS," which is incorporated
herein by reference in its entirety, describes systems and methods
suitable for the resistance and/or other domains of the membrane system
of the preferred embodiments.
[0353]In preferred embodiments, the resistance domain is deposited onto
the enzyme domain to yield a domain thickness of from about 0.05 microns
or less to about 20 microns or more, more preferably from about 0.05,
0.1, 0.15, 0.2, 0.25, 0.3, 0.35, 0.4, 0.45, 0.5, 1, 1.5, 2, 2.5, 3, or
3.5 microns to about 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17,
18, 19, or 19.5 microns, and more preferably still from about 2, 2.5 or 3
microns to about 3.5, 4, 4.5, or 5 microns. Preferably, the resistance
domain is deposited onto the enzyme domain by vapor deposition, spray
coating, or dip coating. In one preferred embodiment, spray coating is
the preferred deposition technique. The spraying process atomizes and
mists the solution, and therefore most or all of the solvent is
evaporated prior to the coating material settling on the underlying
domain, thereby minimizing contact of the solvent with the enzyme.
[0354]In another preferred embodiment, physical vapor deposition (e.g.,
ultrasonic vapor deposition) is used for coating one or more of the
membrane domain(s) onto the electrodes, wherein the vapor deposition
apparatus and process include an ultrasonic nozzle that produces a mist
of micro-droplets in a vacuum chamber. In these embodiments, the
micro-droplets move turbulently within the vacuum chamber, isotropically
impacting and adhering to the surface of the substrate. Advantageously,
vapor deposition as described above can be implemented to provide high
production throughput of membrane deposition processes (e.g., at least
about 20 to about 200 or more electrodes per chamber), greater
consistency of the membrane on each sensor, and increased uniformity of
sensor performance, for example, as described below.
[0355]In some embodiments, depositing the resistance domain (for example,
as described in the preferred embodiments above) includes formation of a
membrane system that substantially blocks or resists ascorbate (a known
electrochemical interferant in hydrogen peroxide-measuring glucose
sensors). While not wishing to be bound by theory, it is believed that
during the process of depositing the resistance domain as described in
the preferred embodiments, a structural morphology is formed that is
characterized in that ascorbate does not substantially permeate
therethrough.
[0356]In a preferred embodiment, the resistance domain is deposited on the
enzyme domain by spray coating a solution of from about 1 wt. % to about
5 wt. % polymer and from about 95 wt. % to about 99 wt. % solvent. In
spraying a solution of resistance domain material, including a solvent,
onto the enzyme domain, it is desirable to mitigate or substantially
reduce any contact with enzyme of any solvent in the spray solution that
can deactivate the underlying enzyme of the enzyme domain.
Tetrahydrofuran (THF) is one solvent that minimally or negligibly affects
the enzyme of the enzyme domain upon spraying. Other solvents can also be
suitable for use, as is appreciated by one skilled in the art.
[0357]Although a variety of spraying or deposition techniques can be used,
spraying the resistance domain material and rotating the sensor at least
one time by 180.degree. C. can typically provide adequate coverage by the
resistance domain. Spraying the resistance domain material and rotating
the sensor at least two times by 120.degree. provides even greater
coverage (one layer of 360.degree. coverage), thereby ensuring
resistivity to glucose, such as is described in more detail above.
[0358]In preferred embodiments, the resistance domain is spray coated and
subsequently cured for a time of from about 15 minutes to about 90
minutes at a temperature of from about 40.degree. C. to about 60.degree.
C. (and can be accomplished under vacuum (e.g., from 20 to 30 mmHg)). A
cure time of up to about 90 minutes or more can be advantageous to ensure
complete drying of the resistance domain.
[0359]In one embodiment, the resistance domain is formed by spray coating
at least six layers (namely, rotating the sensor seventeen times by
120.degree. for at least six layers of 360.degree. coverage) and curing
at 50.degree. C. under vacuum for 60 minutes. However, the resistance
domain can be formed by dip coating or spray coating any layer or
plurality of layers, depending upon the concentration of the solution,
insertion rate, dwell time, withdrawal rate, and/or the desired thickness
of the resulting film. Additionally, curing in a convention oven can also
be employed.
[0360]In certain embodiments, a variable frequency microwave oven can be
used to cure the membrane domains/layers. In general, microwave ovens
directly excite the rotational mode of solvents. Consequently, microwave
ovens cure coatings from the inside out rather than from the outside in
as with conventional convection ovens. This direct rotational mode
excitation is responsible for the typically observed "fast" curing within
a microwave oven. In contrast to conventional microwave ovens, which rely
upon a fixed frequency of emission that can cause arcing of dielectric
(metallic) substrates if placed within a conventional microwave oven,
Variable Frequency Microwave (VFM) ovens emit thousands of frequencies
within 100 milliseconds, which substantially eliminates arcing of
dielectric substrates. Consequently, the membrane domains/layers can be
cured even after deposition on metallic electrodes as described herein.
While not wishing to be bound by theory, it is believe that VFM curing
can increase the rate and completeness of solvent evaporation from a
liquid membrane solution applied to a sensor, as compared to the rate and
completeness of solvent evaporation observed for curing in conventional
convection ovens.
[0361]In certain embodiments, VFM is can be used together with convection
oven curing to further accelerate cure time. In some sensor applications
wherein the membrane is cured prior to application on the electrode (see,
for example, U.S. Patent Publication No. US-2005-0245799-A1, which is
incorporated herein by reference in its entirety), conventional microwave
ovens (e.g., fixed frequency microwave ovens) can be used to cure the
membrane layer.
Treatment of Interference Domain/Membrane System
[0362]Although the above-described methods generally include a curing step
in formation of the membrane system, including the interference domain,
the preferred embodiments further include an additional treatment step,
which can be performed directly after the formation of the interference
domain and/or some time after the formation of the entire membrane system
(or anytime in between). In some embodiments, the additional treatment
step is performed during (or in combination with) sterilization of the
sensor.
[0363]In some embodiments, the membrane system (or interference domain) is
treated by exposure to ionizing radiation, for example, electron beam
radiation, UV radiation, X-ray radiation, gamma radiation, and the like.
Alternatively, the membrane can be exposed to visible light when suitable
photoinitiators are incorporated into the interference domain. While not
wishing to be bound by theory, it is believed that exposing the
interference domain to ionizing radiation substantially crosslinks the
interference domain and thereby creates a tighter, less permeable network
than an interference domain that has not been exposed to ionizing
radiation.
[0364]In some embodiments, the membrane system (or interference domain) is
crosslinked by forming free radicals, which may include the use of
ionizing radiation, thermal initiators, chemical initiators,
photoinitiators (e.g., UV and visible light), and the like. Any suitable
initiator or any suitable initiator system can be employed, for example,
.alpha.-hydroxyketone, .alpha.-aminoketone, ammonium persulfate (APS),
redox systems such as APS/bisulfite, or potassium permanganate. Suitable
thermal initiators include but are not limited to potassium persulfate,
ammonium persulfate, sodium persulfate, and mixtures thereof.
[0365]In embodiments wherein electron beam radiation is used to treat the
membrane system (or interference domain), a preferred exposure time is
from about 6 k or 12 kGy to about 25 or 50 kGy, more preferably about 25
kGy. However, one skilled in the art appreciates that choice of molecular
weight, composition of cellulosic derivative (or other polymer), and/or
the thickness of the layer can affect the preferred exposure time of
membrane to radiation. Preferably, the exposure is sufficient for
substantially crosslinking the interference domain to form free radicals,
but does not destroy or significantly break down the membrane or does not
significantly damage the underlying electroactive surfaces.
[0366]In embodiments wherein UV radiation is employed to treat the
membrane, UV rays from about 200 nm to about 400 nm are preferred;
however values outside of this range can be employed in certain
embodiments, dependent upon the cellulosic derivative and/or other
polymer used.
[0367]In some embodiments, for example, wherein photoinitiators are
employed to crosslink the interference domain, one or more additional
domains can be provided adjacent to the interference domain for
preventing delamination that may be caused by the crosslinking treatment.
These additional domains can be "tie layers" (i.e., film layers that
enhance adhesion of the interference domain to other domains of the
membrane system). In one exemplary embodiment, a membrane system is
formed that includes the following domains: resistance domain, enzyme
domain, electrode domain, and cellulosic-based interference domain,
wherein the electrode domain is configured to ensure adhesion between the
enzyme domain and the interference domain. In embodiments wherein
photoinitiators are employed to crosslink the interference domain, UV
radiation of greater than about 290 nm is preferred. Additionally, from
about 0.01 to about 1 wt % p
hotoinitiator is preferred weight-to-weight
with a preselected cellulosic polymer (e.g., cellulose acetate); however
values outside of this range can be desirable dependent upon the
cellulosic polymer selected.
[0368]In general, sterilization of the transcutaneous sensor can be
completed after final assembly, utilizing methods such as electron beam
radiation, gamma radiation, glutaraldehyde treatment, and the like. The
sensor can be sterilized prior to or after packaging. In an alternative
embodiment, one or more sensors can be sterilized using variable
frequency microwave chamber(s), which can increase the speed and reduce
the cost of the sterilization process. In another alternative embodiment,
one or more sensors can be sterilized using ethylene oxide (EtO) gas
sterilization, for example, by treating with 100% ethylene oxide, which
can be used when the sensor electronics are not detachably connected to
the sensor and/or when the sensor electronics must undergo a
sterilization process. In one embodiment, one or more packaged sets of
transcutaneous sensors (e.g., 1, 2, 3, 4, or 5 sensors or more) are
sterilized simultaneously.
Therapeutic Agents
[0369]A variety of therapeutic (bioactive) agents can be used with the
analyte sensor system of the preferred embodiments, such as the analyte
sensor system of the embodiments shown in FIGS. 1A-3C. In some
embodiments, the therapeutic agent is an anticoagulant. The term
"anticoagulant" as used herein is a broad term, and is to be given its
ordinary and customary meaning to a person of ordinary skill in the art
(and is not to be limited to a special or customized meaning), and refers
without limitation to a substance the prevents coagulation (e.g.,
minimizes, reduces, or stops clotting of blood). In some embodiments, an
anticoagulant is included in the analyte sensor system to prevent
coagulation within or on the sensor (e.g., within or on the catheter or
within or on the sensor). Suitable anticoagulants for incorporation into
the sensor system include, but are not limited to, vitamin K antagonists
(e.g., Acenocoumarol, Clorindione, Dicumarol (Dicoumarol), Diphenadione,
Ethyl biscoumacetate, Phenprocoumon, Phenindione, Tioclomarol, or
Warfarin), heparin group anticoagulants (e.g., Platelet aggregation
inhibitors: Antithrombin III, Bemiparin, Dalteparin, Danaparoid,
Enoxaparin, Heparin, Nadroparin, Parnaparin, Reviparin, Sulodexide,
Tinzaparin), other platelet aggregation inhibitors (e.g., Abciximab,
Acetylsalicylic acid (Aspirin), Aloxiprin, Beraprost, Ditazole,
Carbasalate calcium, Cloricromen, Clopidogrel, Dipyridamole,
Epoprostenol, Eptifibatide, Indobufen, Iloprost, Picotamide, Ticlopidine,
Tirofiban, Treprostinil, Triflusal), enzymes (e.g., Alteplase, Ancrod,
Anistreplase, Brinase, Drotrecogin alfa, Fibrinolysin, Protein C,
Reteplase, Saruplase, Streptokinase, Tenecteplase, Urokinase), direct
thrombin inhibitors (e.g., Argatroban, Bivalirudin, Desirudin, Lepirudin,
Melagatran, Ximelagatran, other antithrombotics (e.g., Dabigatran,
Defibrotide, Dermatan sulfate, Fondaparinux, Rivaroxaban) and the like.
[0370]In one embodiment, heparin is incorporated into the analyte sensor
system. In a further embodiment, heparin is coated on the catheter (inner
and/or outer diameter) and/or sensor, for example, by dipping or
spraying. While not wishing to be bound by theory, it is believed that
heparin coated on the catheter and/or sensor prevents aggregation and
clotting of blood on the analyte sensor system, thereby preventing
thromboembolization (e.g., prevention of blood flow by the thrombus or
clot) and/or subsequent complications. In another embodiment, an
antimicrobial is coated on the catheter (inner and/or outer diameter)
and/or sensor.
[0371]In some embodiments, the therapeutic agent is an antimicrobial. The
term "antimicrobial agent" as used in the preferred embodiments means
antibiotics, antiseptics, disinfectants and synthetic moieties, and
combinations thereof, that are soluble in organic solvents such as
alcohols, ketones, ethers, aldehydes, acetonitrile, acetic acid,
methylene chloride and chloroform.
[0372]Classes of antibiotics that can be used include tetracyclines (i.e.
minocycline), rifamycins (i.e. rifampin), macrolides (i.e. erythromycin),
penicillins (i.e. nafeillin), cephalosporins (i.e. cefazolin), other
beta-lactam antibiotics (i.e. imipenem, aztreonam), aminoglycosides (i.e.
gentamicin), chloramphenicol, sulfonamides (i.e. sulfamethoxazole),
glycopeptides (i.e. vancomycin), quinolones (i.e. ciprofloxacin), fusidic
acid, trimethoprim, metronidazole, clindamycin, mupirocin, polyenes (i.e.
amp
hotericin B), azoles (i.e. fluconazole) and beta-lactam inhibitors
(i.e. sulbactam).
[0373]Examples of specific antibiotics that can be used include
minocycline, rifampin, erythromycin, nafcillin, cefazolin, imipenem,
aztreonam, gentamicin, sulfamethoxazole, vancomycin, ciprofloxacin,
trimethoprim, metronidazole, clindamycin, teicoplanin, mupirocin,
azithromycin, clarithromycin, ofloxacin, lomefloxacin, norfloxacin,
nalidixic acid, sparfloxacin, pefloxacin, amifloxacin, enoxacin,
fleroxacin, temafloxacin, tosufloxacin, clinafloxacin, sulbactam,
clavulanic acid, amphotericin B. fluconazole, itraconazole, ketoconazole,
and nystatin.
[0374]Examples of antiseptics and disinfectants are hexachlorophene,
cationic bisiguanides (i.e. chlorhexidine, cyclohexidine) iodine and
iodophores (i.e. povidoneiodine), para-chloro-meta-xylenol, triclosan,
furan medical preparations (i.e. nitrofurantoin, nitrofurazone),
methenamine, aldehydes (glutaraldehyde, formaldehyde) and alcohols. Other
examples of antiseptics and disinfectants will readily suggest themselves
to those of ordinary skill in the art.
[0375]These antimicrobial agents can be used alone or in combination of
two or more of them. The antimicrobial agents can be dispersed throughout
the material of the sensor and/or catheter. The amount of each
antimicrobial agent used to impregnate the medical device varies to some
extent, but is at least of an effective concentration to inhibit the
growth of bacterial and fungal organisms, such as staphylococci,
gram-positive bacteria, gram-negative bacilli and Candida.
[0376]In some embodiments, the membrane system of the preferred
embodiments preferably include a bioactive agent, which is incorporated
into at least a portion of the membrane system, or which is incorporated
into the device and adapted to diffuse through the membrane.
[0377]There are a variety of systems and methods by which the bioactive
agent is incorporated into the membrane of the preferred embodiments. In
some embodiments, the bioactive agent is incorporated at the time of
manufacture of the membrane system. For example, the bioactive agent can
be blended prior to curing the membrane system, or subsequent to membrane
system manufacture, for example, by coating, imbibing, solvent-casting,
or sorption of the bioactive agent into the membrane system. Although the
bioactive agent is preferably incorporated into the membrane system, in
some embodiments the bioactive agent can be administered concurrently
with, prior to, or after insertion of the device intravascularly, for
example, by oral administration, or locally, for example, by subcutaneous
injection near the implantation site. A combination of bioactive agent
incorporated in the membrane system and bioactive agent administration
locally and/or systemically can be preferred in certain embodiments.
[0378]In general, a bioactive agent can be incorporated into the membrane
system, and/or incorporated into the device and adapted to diffuse
therefrom, in order to modify the tissue response of the host to the
membrane. In some embodiments, the bioactive agent is incorporated only
into a portion of the membrane system adjacent to the sensing region of
the device, over the entire surface of the device except over the sensing
region, or any combination thereof, which can be helpful in controlling
different mechanisms and/or stages of thrombus formation. In some
alternative embodiments however, the bioactive agent is incorporated into
the device proximal to the membrane system, such that the bioactive agent
diffuses through the membrane system to the host circulatory system.
[0379]The bioactive agent can include a carrier matrix, wherein the matrix
includes one or more of collagen, a particulate matrix, a resorbable or
non-resorbable matrix, a controlled-release matrix, and/or a gel. In some
embodiments, the carrier matrix includes a reservoir, wherein a bioactive
agent is encapsulated within a microcapsule. The carrier matrix can
include a system in which a bioactive agent is physically entrapped
within a polymer network. In some embodiments, the bioactive agent is
cross-linked with the membrane system, while in others the bioactive
agent is sorbed into the membrane system, for example, by adsorption,
absorption, or imbibing. The bioactive agent can be deposited in or on
the membrane system, for example, by coating, filling, or solvent
casting. In certain embodiments, ionic and nonionic surfactants,
detergents, micelles, emulsifiers, demulsifiers, stabilizers, aqueous and
oleaginous carriers, solvents, preservatives, antioxidants, or buffering
agents are used to incorporate the bioactive agent into the membrane
system. The bioactive agent can be incorporated into a polymer using
techniques such as described above, and the polymer can be used to form
the membrane system, coatings on the membrane system, portions of the
membrane system, and/or any portion of the sensor system.
[0380]The membrane system can be manufactured using techniques known in
the art. The bioactive agent can be sorbed into the membrane system, for
example, by soaking the membrane system for a length of time (for
example, from about an hour or less to about a week or more, preferably
from about 4, 8, 12, 16, or 20 hours to about 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, or 7 days).
[0381]The bioactive agent can be blended into uncured polymer prior to
forming the membrane system. The membrane system is then cured and the
bioactive agent thereby cross-linked and/or encapsulated within the
polymer that forms the membrane system.
[0382]In yet another embodiment, microspheres are used to encapsulate the
bioactive agent. The microspheres can be formed of biodegradable
polymers, most preferably synthetic polymers or natural polymers such as
proteins and polysaccharides. As used herein, the term polymer is used to
refer to both to synthetic polymers and proteins. U.S. Pat. No.
6,281,015, which is incorporated herein by reference in its entirety,
discloses some systems and methods that can be used in conjunction with
the preferred embodiments. In general, bioactive agents can be
incorporated in (1) the polymer matrix forming the microspheres, (2)
microparticle(s) surrounded by the polymer which forms the microspheres,
(3) a polymer core within a protein microsphere, (4) a polymer coating
around a polymer microsphere, (5) mixed in with microspheres aggregated
into a larger form, or (6) a combination thereof. Bioactive agents can be
incorporated as particulates or by co-dissolving the factors with the
polymer. Stabilizers can be incorporated by addition of the stabilizers
to the factor solution prior to formation of the microspheres.
[0383]The bioactive agent can be incorporated into a hydrogel and coated
or otherwise deposited in or on the membrane system. Some hydrogels
suitable for use in the preferred embodiments include cross-linked,
hydrophilic, three-dimensional polymer networks that are highly permeable
to the bioactive agent and are triggered to release the bioactive agent
based on a stimulus.
[0384]The bioactive agent can be incorporated into the membrane system by
solvent casting, wherein a solution including dissolved bioactive agent
is disposed on the surface of the membrane system, after which the
solvent is removed to form a coating on the membrane surface.
[0385]The bioactive agent can be compounded into a plug of material, which
is placed within the device, such as is described in U.S. Pat. Nos.
4,506,680 and 5,282,844, which are incorporated herein by reference in
their entirety. In some embodiments, it is preferred to dispose the plug
beneath a membrane system; in this way, the bioactive agent is controlled
by diffusion through the membrane, which provides a mechanism for
sustained-release of the bioactive agent in the host.
Release of Bioactive Agents
[0386]Numerous variables can affect the pharmacokinetics of bioactive
agent release. The bioactive agents of the preferred embodiments can be
optimized for short- and/or long-term release. In some embodiments, the
bioactive agents of the preferred embodiments are designed to aid or
overcome factors associated with short-term effects (e.g., acute
inflammation and/or thrombosis) of sensor insertion. In some embodiments,
the bioactive agents of the preferred embodiments are designed to aid or
overcome factors associated with long-term effects, for example, chronic
inflammation or build-up of fibrotic tissue and/or plaque material. In
some embodiments, the bioactive agents of the preferred embodiments
combine short- and long-term release to exploit the benefits of both.
[0387]As used herein, "controlled," "sustained," or "extended" release of
the factors can be continuous or discontinuous, linear or non-linear.
This can be accomplished using one or more types of polymer compositions,
drug loadings, selections of excipients or degradation enhancers, or
other modifications, administered alone, in combination or sequentially
to produce the desired effect.
[0388]Short-term release of the bioactive agent in the preferred
embodiments generally refers to release over a period of from about a few
minutes or hours to about 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, or 7 days or more.
Loading of Bioactive Agents
[0389]The amount of loading of the bioactive agent into the membrane
system can depend upon several factors. For example, the bioactive agent
dosage and duration can vary with the intended use of the membrane
system, for example, the intended length of use of the device and the
like; differences among patients in the effective dose of bioactive
agent; location and methods of loading the bioactive agent; and release
rates associated with bioactive agents and optionally their carrier
matrix. Therefore, one skilled in the art will appreciate the variability
in the levels of loading the bioactive agent, for the reasons described
above.
[0390]In some embodiments, wherein the bioactive agent is incorporated
into the membrane system without a carrier matrix, the preferred level of
loading of the bioactive agent into the membrane system can vary
depending upon the nature of the bioactive agent. The level of loading of
the bioactive agent is preferably sufficiently high such that a
biological effect (e.g., thrombosis prevention) is observed. Above this
threshold, bioactive agent can be loaded into the membrane system so as
to imbibe up to 100% of the solid portions, cover all accessible surfaces
of the membrane, and/or fill up to 100% of the accessible cavity space.
Typically, the level of loading (based on the weight of bioactive
agent(s), membrane system, and other substances present) is from about 1
ppm or less to about 1000 ppm or more, preferably from about 2, 3, 4, or
5 ppm up to about 10, 25, 50, 75, 100, 200, 300, 400, 500, 600, 700, 800,
or 900 ppm. In certain embodiments, the level of loading can be 1 wt. %
or less up to about 50 wt. % or more, preferably from about 2, 3, 4, 5,
6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 15, or 20 wt. % up to about 25, 30, 35, 40, or 45 wt. %.
[0391]When the bioactive agent is incorporated into the membrane system
with a carrier matrix, such as a gel, the gel concentration can be
optimized, for example, loaded with one or more test loadings of the
bioactive agent. It is generally preferred that the gel contain from
about 0.1 or less to about 50 wt. % or more of the bioactive agent(s),
preferably from about 0.2, 0.3, 0.4, 0.5, 0.6, 0.7, 0.8, or 0.9 wt. % to
about 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 15, 20, 25, 30, 35, 40, or 45 wt. % or more
bioactive agent(s), more preferably from about 1, 2, or 3 wt. % to about
4 or 5 wt. % of the bioactive agent(s). Substances that are not bioactive
can also be incorporated into the matrix.
[0392]Referring now to microencapsulated bioactive agents, the release of
the agents from these polymeric systems generally occurs by two different
mechanisms. The bioactive agent can be released by diffusion through
aqueous filled channels generated in the dosage form by the dissolution
of the agent or by voids created by the removal of the polymer solvent or
a pore forming agent during the original micro-encapsulation.
Alternatively, release can be enhanced due to the degradation of the
encapsulating polymer. With time, the polymer erodes and generates
increased porosity and microstructure within the device. This creates
additional pathways for release of the bioactive agent.
[0393]In some embodiments, the sensor is designed to be bioinert, e.g., by
the use of bioinert materials. Bioinert materials do not substantially
cause any response from the host. As a result, cells can live adjacent to
the material but do not form a bond with it. Bioinert materials include
but are not limited to alumina, zirconia, titanium oxide or other
bioinert materials generally used in the "catheter/catheterization" art.
While not wishing to be bound by theory, it is believed that inclusion of
a bioinert material in or on the sensor can reduce attachment of blood
cells or proteins to the sensor, thrombosis or other host reactions to
the sensor.
Sensor Electronics
[0394]The analyte sensor system has electronics, also referred to as a
"computer system" that can include hardware, firmware, and/or software
that enable measurement and processing of data associated with analyte
levels in the host. In one exemplary embodiment, the electronics include
a potentiostat, a power source for providing power to the sensor, and
other components useful for signal processing. In another exemplary
embodiment, the electronics include an RF module for transmitting data
from sensor electronics to a receiver remote from the sensor. In another
exemplary embodiment, the sensor electronics are wired to a receiver,
which records the data and optionally transmits the data to a remote
location, such as but not limited to a nurse's station, for tracking the
host's progress and to alarm the staff is a hypoglycemic episode occurs.
[0395]Various components of the electronics of the sensor system can be
disposed on or proximal to the analyte sensor, such as but not limited to
disposed on the fluid coupler 20 of the system, such as the embodiment
shown in FIG. 1A. In another embodiment, wherein the sensor is integrally
formed on the catheter (e.g., see FIG. 2A) and the electronics are
disposed on or proximal to the connector 218. In some embodiments, only a
portion of the electronics (e.g., the potentiostat) is disposed on the
device (e.g., proximal to the sensor), while the remaining electronics
are disposed remotely from the device, such as on a stand or by the
bedside. In a further embodiment, a portion of the electronics can be
disposed in a central location, such as a nurse's station.
[0396]In additional embodiments, some or all of the electronics can be in
wired or wireless communication with the sensor and/or other portions of
the electronics. For example, a potentiostat disposed on the device can
be wired to the remaining electronics (e.g., a processor, a recorder, a
transmitter, a receiver, etc.), which reside on the bedside. In another
example, some portion of the electronics is wirelessly connected to
another portion of the electronics, such as by infrared (IR) or RF. In
one embodiment, a potentiostat resides on the fluid coupler and is
connected to a receiver by RF; accordingly, a battery, RF transmitter,
and/or other minimally necessary electronics are provided with the fluid
coupler and the receiver includes an RF receiver.
[0397]Preferably, the potentiostat is operably connected to the
electrode(s) (such as described above), which biases the sensor to enable
measurement of a current signal indicative of the analyte concentration
in the host (also referred to as the analog portion). In some
embodiments, the potentiostat includes a resistor that translates the
current into voltage. In some alternative embodiments, a current to
frequency converter is provided that is configured to continuously
integrate the measured current, for example, using a charge counting
device.
[0398]In some embodiments, the electronics include an A/D converter that
digitizes the analog signal into a digital signal, also referred to as
"counts" for processing. Accordingly, the resulting raw data stream in
counts, also referred to as raw sensor data, is directly related to the
current measured by the potentiostat.
[0399]Typically, the electronics include a processor module that includes
the central control unit that controls the processing of the sensor
system. In some embodiments, the processor module includes a
microprocessor, however a computer system other than a microprocessor can
be used to process data as described herein, for example an ASIC can be
used for some or all of the sensor's central processing. The processor
typically provides semi-permanent storage of data, for example, storing
data such as sensor identifier (ID) and programming to process data
streams (for example, programming for data smoothing and/or replacement
of signal artifacts such as is described in U.S. Patent Publication No.
US-2005-0043598-A1). The processor additionally can be used for the
system's cache memory, for example for temporarily storing recent sensor
data. In some embodiments, the processor module comprises memory storage
components such as ROM, RAM, dynamic-RAM, static-RAM, non-static RAM,
EEPROM, rewritable ROMs, flash memory, and the like.
[0400]In some embodiments, the processor module comprises a digital
filter, for example, an infinite impulse response (IIR) or finite impulse
response (FIR) filter, configured to smooth the raw data stream from the
A/D converter. Generally, digital filters are programmed to filter data
sampled at a predetermined time interval (also referred to as a sample
rate). In some embodiments, wherein the potentiostat is configured to
measure the analyte at discrete time intervals, these time intervals
determine the sample rate of the digital filter. In some alternative
embodiments, wherein the potentiostat is configured to continuously
measure the analyte, for example, using a current-to-frequency converter
as described above, the processor module can be programmed to request a
digital value from the A/D converter at a predetermined time interval,
also referred to as the acquisition time. In these alternative
embodiments, the values obtained by the processor are advantageously
averaged over the acquisition time due the continuity of the current
measurement. Accordingly, the acquisition time determines the sample rate
of the digital filter. In preferred embodiments, the processor module is
configured with a programmable acquisition time, namely, the
predetermined time interval for requesting the digital value from the A/D
converter is programmable by a user within the digital circuitry of the
processor module. An acquisition time of from about 2 seconds to about
512 seconds is preferred; however any acquisition time can be programmed
into the processor module. A programmable acquisition time is
advantageous in optimizing noise filtration, time lag, and
processing/battery power.
[0401]In some embodiments, the processor module is configured to build the
data packet for transmission to an outside source, for example, an RF
transmission to a receiver. Generally, the data packet comprises a
plurality of bits that can include a preamble, a unique identifier
identifying the electronics unit, the receiver, or both, (e.g., sensor ID
code), data (e.g., raw data, filtered data, and/or an integrated value)
and/or error detection or correction. Preferably, the data (transmission)
packet has a length of from about 8 bits to about 128 bits, preferably
about 48 bits; however, larger or smaller packets can be desirable in
certain embodiments. The processor module can be configured to transmit
any combination of raw and/or filtered data. In one exemplary embodiment,
the transmission packet contains a fixed preamble, a unique ID of the
electronics unit, a single five-minute average (e.g., integrated) sensor
data value, and a cyclic redundancy code (CRC).
[0402]In some embodiments, the processor module further comprises a
transmitter portion that determines the transmission interval of the
sensor data to a receiver, and the like. In some embodiments, the
transmitter portion, which determines the interval of transmission, is
configured to be programmable. In one such embodiment, a coefficient can
be chosen (e.g., a number of from about 1 to about 100, or more), wherein
the coefficient is multiplied by the acquisition time (or sampling rate),
such as described above, to define the transmission interval of the data
packet. Thus, in some embodiments, the transmission interval is
programmable from about 2 seconds to about 850 minutes, more preferably
from about 30 second to about 5 minutes; however, any transmission
interval can be programmable or programmed into the processor module.
However, a variety of alternative systems and methods for providing a
programmable transmission interval can also be employed. By providing a
programmable transmission interval, data transmission can be customized
to meet a variety of design criteria (e.g., reduced battery consumption,
timeliness of reporting sensor values, etc.)
[0403]In some embodiments, the processor further performs the processing,
such as storing data, analyzing data streams, calibrating analyte sensor
data, estimating analyte values, comparing estimated analyte values with
time corresponding measured analyte values, analyzing a variation of
estimated analyte values, downloading data, and controlling the user
interface by providing analyte values, prompts, messages, warnings,
alarms, and the like. In such cases, the processor includes hardware and
software that performs the processing described herein, for example flash
memory provides permanent or semi-permanent storage of data, storing data
such as sensor ID, receiver ID, and programming to process data streams
(for example, programming for performing estimation and other algorithms
described elsewhere herein) and random access memory (RAM) stores the
system's cache memory and is helpful in data processing. Alternatively,
some portion of the data processing (such as described with reference to
the processor elsewhere herein) can be accomplished at another (e.g.,
remote) processor and can be configured to be in wired or wireless
connection therewith.
[0404]In some embodiments, an output module, which is integral with and/or
operatively connected with the processor, includes programming for
generating output based on the data stream received from the sensor
system and it's processing incurred in the processor. In some
embodiments, output is generated via a user interface.
[0405]In some embodiments, a user interface is provided integral with
(e.g., on the patient inserted medical device), proximal to (e.g., a
receiver near the medical device including bedside or on a stand), or
remote from the sensor electronics (e.g., at a central station such as a
nurse's station), wherein the user interface comprises a keyboard,
speaker, vibrator, backlight, liquid crystal display (LCD) screen, and
one or more buttons. The components that comprise the user interface
include controls to allow interaction of the user with the sensor system.
The keyboard can allow, for example, input of user information, such as
mealtime, exercise, insulin administration, customized therapy
recommendations, and reference analyte values. The speaker can produce,
for example, audible signals or alerts for conditions such as present
and/or estimated hyperglycemic or hypoglycemic conditions. The vibrator
can provide, for example, tactile signals or alerts for reasons such as
described with reference to the speaker, above. The backlight can be
provided, for example, to aid a user in reading the LCD in low light
conditions. The LCD can be provided, for example, to provide the user
with visual data output, such as is described in U.S. Patent Publication
No. US-2005-0203360-A1. In some embodiments, the LCD is a touch-activated
screen, enabling each selection by a user, for example, from a menu on
the screen. The buttons can provide for toggle, menu selection, option
selection, mode selection, and reset, for example. In some alternative
embodiments, a microphone can be provided to allow for voice-activated
control.
[0406]In some embodiments, prompts or messages can be displayed on the
user interface to convey information to the user, such as reference
outlier values, requests for reference analyte values, therapy
recommendations, deviation of the measured analyte values from the
estimated analyte values, and the like. Additionally, prompts can be
displayed to guide the user through calibration or trouble-shooting of
the calibration.
[0407]Additionally, data output from the output module can provide wired
or wireless, one- or two-way communication between the user interface and
an external device. The external device can be any device that wherein
interfaces or communicates with the user interface. In some embodiments,
the external device is a computer, and the system is able to download
historical data for retrospective analysis by the patient or physician,
for example. In some embodiments, the external device is a modem or other
telecommunications station, and the system is able to send alerts,
warnings, emergency messages, and the like, via telecommunication lines
to another party, such as a doctor or family member. In some embodiments,
the external device is an insulin pen, and the system is able to
communicate therapy recommendations, such as insulin amount and time to
the insulin pen. In some embodiments, the external device is an insulin
pump, and the system is able to communicate therapy recommendations, such
as insulin amount and time to the insulin pump. The external device can
include other technology or medical devices, for example pacemakers,
implanted analyte sensor patches, other infusion devices, telemetry
devices, and the like.
[0408]The user interface, including keyboard, buttons, a microphone (not
shown), and optionally the external device, can be configured to allow
input of data. Data input can be helpful in obtaining information about
the patient (for example, meal time, insulin administration, and the
like), receiving instructions from a physician (for example, customized
therapy recommendations, targets, and the like), and downloading software
updates, for example. Keyboard, buttons, touch-screen, and microphone are
all examples of mechanisms by which a user can input data directly into
the receiver. A server, personal computer, personal digital assistant,
insulin pump, and insulin pen are examples of external devices that can
provide useful information to the receiver. Other devices internal or
external to the sensor that measure other aspects of a patient's body
(for example, temperature sensor, accelerometer, heart rate monitor,
oxygen monitor, and the like) can be used to provide input helpful in
data processing. In one embodiment, the user interface can prompt the
patient to select an activity most closely related to their present
activity, such as medication taken, surgical procedures, and the like,
which can be helpful in linking to an individual's physiological
patterns, or other data processing. In another embodiment, a temperature
sensor and/or heart rate monitor can provide information helpful in
linking activity, metabolism, and glucose excursions of an individual.
While a few examples of data input have been provided here, a variety of
information can be input, which can be helpful in data processing.
Algorithms
[0409]In some embodiments, calibration of an analyte sensor can be
required, which includes data processing that converts sensor data signal
into an estimated analyte measurement that is meaningful to a user. In
general, the sensor system has a computer system (e.g., within the
electronics) that receives sensor data (e.g., a data stream), including
one or more time-spaced sensor data points, measured by the sensor. The
sensor data point(s) can be smoothed (filtered) in certain embodiments
using a filter, for example, a finite impulse response (FIR) or infinite
impulse response (IIR) filter. During the initialization of the sensor,
prior to initial calibration, the system can receive and store
uncalibrated sensor data, however it can be configured to not display any
data to the user until initial calibration and, optionally, stabilization
of the sensor has been established. In some embodiments, the data stream
can be evaluated to determine sensor break-in (equilibration of the
sensor in vitro or in vivo).
[0410]In some embodiments, the system is configured to receive reference
data from a reference analyte monitor, including one or more reference
data points, also referred to as calibration information in some
embodiments. The monitor can be of any suitable configuration. For
example, in one embodiment, the reference analyte points can comprise
results from a self-monitored blood analyte test (e.g., from a finger
stick test, YSI, Beckman Glucose Analyzer, and the like), such as those
described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 6,045,567; 6,156,051; 6,197,040; 6,284,125;
6,413,410; and 6,733,655. In one such embodiment, the user can administer
a self-monitored blood analyte test to obtain an analyte value (e.g.,
point) using any suitable analyte sensor, and then enter the numeric
analyte value into the computer system. In another such embodiment, a
self-monitored blood analyte test comprises a wired or wireless
connection to the computer system so that the user simply initiates a
connection between the two devices, and the reference analyte data is
passed or downloaded between the self-monitored blood analyte test and
the system. In yet another such embodiment, the self-monitored analyte
test is integral with the receiver so that the user simply provides a
blood sample to the receiver, and the receiver runs the analyte test to
determine a reference analyte value.
[0411]In some alternative embodiments, the reference data is based on
sensor data from another substantially continuous analyte sensor such as
described herein, or another type of suitable continuous analyte sensor.
In an embodiment employing a series of two or more continuous sensors,
the sensors can be employed so that they provide sensor data in discrete
or overlapping periods. In such embodiments, the sensor data from one
continuous sensor can be used to calibrate another continuous sensor, or
be used to confirm the validity of a subsequently employed continuous
sensor.
[0412]In some embodiments, the sensor system is coupled to a blood
analysis device that periodically or intermittently collects a sample of
the host's blood (e.g., through the sensor system) and measures the
host's glucose concentration. In some embodiments, the blood analysis
device collects a blood sample from the host about every 30 minutes,
every hour, or every few hours (e.g., 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 8, 9 or 10 hours or
longer). In other embodiments, the blood analysis device can be activated
manually (e.g., by a healthcare worker) to collect and analyze a blood
sample from the host. The glucose concentration data generated by the
blood analysis device can be used by the sensor system for calibration
data. In some embodiments, the sensor system can electronically receive
(either wired or wirelessly) these calibration data (from the blood
analysis device). In other embodiments, these calibration data can be
entered into the sensor system (e.g., sensor system electronics) by hand
(e.g., manually entered by a healthcare worker).
[0413]In some embodiments, the sensor system is provided with one or more
calibration solutions (e.g., glucose solutions). In some embodiments, the
sensor is shipped in a calibration solution (e.g., soaked). The sensor is
activated to calibrate itself (using the calibration solution in which it
was shipped) before insertion into the host. In some embodiments, the
sensor is shipped (e.g., soaked or dry) with one or more vials of
calibration solution. The sensor can be soaked (e.g., sequentially) in
the vial(s) of calibration solution; calibration data points collected
and the sensor calibrated using those calibration points, before
inserting the sensor into the host.
[0414]In one exemplary embodiment, the sensor is a glucose sensor, and it
is shipped soaking in a sterile 50 mg/dl glucose solution with two
accompanying calibration solutions (e.g., 100 mg/dl and 200 mg/dl sterile
glucose solutions). Prior to insertion into the host, calibration data
points are collected with the sensor in the 50 mg/dl, 100 mg/dl and 200
mg/dl glucose solutions respectively. The sensor system can be calibrated
using the collected calibration data points (e.g., using regression as
described in more detail elsewhere herein). In an alternative exemplary
embodiment, the sensor is shipped dry (e.g., not soaking in a solution or
buffer) with at least one calibration solution, for calibrating the
sensor prior to insertion into the host. In some embodiments, a hand held
glucose monitor (e.g., SMBG device described herein) can test the
calibration solutions to generate calibration data points, which are
transferred electronically or manually to the sensor system for
calibration.
[0415]In some embodiments, a data matching module, also referred to as the
processor module, matches reference data (e.g., one or more reference
analyte data points) with substantially time corresponding sensor data
(e.g., one or more sensor data points) to provide one or more matched
data pairs. One reference data point can be matched to one time
corresponding sensor data point to form a matched data pair.
Alternatively, a plurality of reference data points can be averaged
(e.g., equally or non-equally weighted average, mean-value, median, and
the like) and matched to one time corresponding sensor data point to form
a matched data pair, one reference data point can be matched to a
plurality of time corresponding sensor data points averaged to form a
matched data pair, or a plurality of reference data points can be
averaged and matched to a plurality of time corresponding sensor data
points averaged to form a matched data pair.
[0416]In some embodiments, a calibration set module, also referred to as
the calibration module or processor module, forms an initial calibration
set from a set of one or more matched data pairs, which are used to
determine the relationship between the reference analyte data and the
sensor analyte data. The matched data pairs, which make up the initial
calibration set, can be selected according to predetermined criteria. The
criteria for the initial calibration set can be the same as, or different
from, the criteria for the updated calibration sets. In certain
embodiments, the number (n) of data pair(s) selected for the initial
calibration set is one. In other embodiments, n data pairs are selected
for the initial calibration set wherein n is a function of the frequency
of the received reference data points. In various embodiments, two data
pairs make up the initial calibration set or six data pairs make up the
initial calibration set. In an embodiment wherein a substantially
continuous analyte sensor provides reference data, numerous data points
are used to provide reference data from more than 6 data pairs (e.g.,
dozens or even hundreds of data pairs). In one exemplary embodiment, a
substantially continuous analyte sensor provides 288 reference data
points per day (every five minutes for twenty-four hours), thereby
providing an opportunity for a matched data pair 288 times per day, for
example. While specific numbers of matched data pairs are referred to in
the preferred embodiments, any suitable number of matched data pairs per
a given time period can be employed.
[0417]In some embodiments, a conversion function module, also referred to
as the conversion module or processor module, uses the calibration set to
create a conversion function. The conversion function substantially
defines the relationship between the reference analyte data and the
analyte sensor data.
[0418]A variety of known methods can be used with the preferred
embodiments to create the conversion function from the calibration set.
In one embodiment, wherein a plurality of matched data points form the
calibration set, a linear least squares regression is used to calculate
the conversion function; for example, this regression calculates a slope
and an offset using the equation y=m.times.+b. A variety of regression or
other conversion schemes can be implemented herein.
[0419]In some alternative embodiments, the sensor is a dual-electrode
system. In one such dual-electrode system, a first electrode functions as
a hydrogen peroxide sensor including a membrane system containing
glucose-oxidase disposed thereon, which operates as described herein. A
second electrode is a hydrogen peroxide sensor that is configured similar
to the first electrode, but with a modified membrane system (with the
enzyme domain removed, for example). This second electrode provides a
signal composed mostly of the baseline signal, b.
[0420]In some dual-electrode systems, the baseline signal is
(electronically or digitally) subtracted from the glucose signal to
obtain a glucose signal substantially without baseline. Accordingly,
calibration of the resultant difference signal can be performed by
solving the equation y=mx with a single paired measurement. Calibration
of the implanted sensor in this alternative embodiment can be made less
dependent on the values/range of the paired measurements, less sensitive
to error in manual blood glucose measurements, and can facilitate the
sensor's use as a primary source of glucose information for the user.
U.S. Patent Publication No. US-2005-0143635-A1 describes systems and
methods for subtracting the baseline from a sensor signal.
[0421]In some alternative dual-electrode system embodiments, the analyte
sensor is configured to transmit signals obtained from each electrode
separately (e.g., without subtraction of the baseline signal). In this
way, the receiver can process these signals to determine additional
information about the sensor and/or analyte concentration. For example,
by comparing the signals from the first and second electrodes, changes in
baseline and/or sensitivity can be detected and/or measured and used to
update calibration (e.g., without the use of a reference analyte value).
In one such example, by monitoring the corresponding first and second
signals over time, an amount of signal contributed by baseline can be
measured. In another such example, by comparing fluctuations in the
correlating signals over time, changes in sensitivity can be detected
and/or measured.
[0422]In some alternative embodiments, a regression equation y=m.times.+b
is used to calculate the conversion function; however, prior information
can be provided for m and/or b, thereby enabling calibration to occur
with fewer paired measurements. In one calibration technique, prior
information (e.g., obtained from in vivo or in vitro tests) determines a
sensitivity of the sensor and/or the baseline signal of the sensor by
analyzing sensor data from measurements taken by the sensor (e.g., prior
to inserting the sensor). For example, if there exists a predictive
relationship between in vitro sensor parameters and in vivo parameters,
then this information can be used by the calibration procedure. For
example, if a predictive relationship exists between in vitro sensitivity
and in vivo sensitivity, m.apprxeq.f(m.sub.in vitro) then the predicted m
can be used, along with a single matched pair, to solve for b (b=y-mx).
If, in addition, b can be assumed=0, for example with a dual-electrode
configuration that enables subtraction of the baseline from the signal
such as described above, then both m and b are known a priori, matched
pairs are not needed for calibration, and the sensor can be completely
calibrated e.g. without the need for reference analyte values (e.g.
values obtained after implantation in vivo.)
[0423]In another alternative embodiment, prior information can be provided
to guide or validate the baseline (b) and/or sensitivity (m) determined
from the regression analysis. In this embodiment, boundaries can be set
for the regression line that defines the conversion function such that
working sensors are calibrated accurately and easily (with two points),
and non-working sensors are prevented from being calibrated. If the
boundaries are drawn too tightly, a working sensor may not enter into
calibration. Likewise, if the boundaries are drawn too loosely, the
scheme can result in inaccurate calibration or can permit non-working
sensors to enter into calibration. For example, subsequent to performing
regression, the resulting slope and/or baseline are tested to determine
whether they fall within a predetermined acceptable threshold
(boundaries). These predetermined acceptable boundaries can be obtained
from in vivo or in vitro tests (e.g., by a retrospective analysis of
sensor sensitivities and/or baselines collected from a set of
sensors/patients, assuming that the set is representative of future
data).
[0424]In some alternative embodiments, the sensor system does not require
initial and/or update calibration by the host; in these alternative
embodiments, also referred to as "zero-point calibration" embodiments,
use of the sensor system without requiring a reference analyte
measurement for initial and/or update calibration is enabled. In general,
the systems and methods of the preferred embodiments provide for stable
and repeatable sensor manufacture, particularly when tightly controlled
manufacturing processes are utilized. Namely, a batch of sensors of the
preferred embodiments can be designed with substantially the same
baseline (b) and/or sensitivity (m) (+/-10%) when tested in vitro.
Additionally, the sensor of the preferred embodiments can be designed for
repeatable m and b in vivo. Thus, an initial calibration factor
(conversion function) can be programmed into the sensor (sensor
electronics and/or receiver electronics) that enables conversion of raw
sensor data into calibrated sensor data solely using information obtained
prior to implantation (namely, initial calibration does not require a
reference analyte value). Additionally, to obviate the need for
recalibration (update calibration) during the life of the sensor, the
sensor is designed to minimize drift of the sensitivity and/or baseline
over time in vivo. Accordingly, the preferred embodiments can be
manufactured for zero point calibration.
[0425]In some embodiments, a sensor data transformation module, also
referred to as the calibration module, conversion module, or processor
module, uses the conversion function to transform sensor data into
substantially real-time analyte value estimates, also referred to as
calibrated data, or converted sensor data, as sensor data is continuously
(or intermittently) received from the sensor. For example, the sensor
data, which can be provided to the receiver in "counts," is translated in
to estimate analyte value(s) in mg/dL. In other words, the offset value
at any given point in time can be subtracted from the raw value (e.g., in
counts) and divided by the slope to obtain the estimate analyte value:
mg / dL = ( rawvalue - offset ) slope ##EQU00001##
[0426]In some embodiments, an output module provides output to the user
via the user interface. The output is representative of the estimated
analyte value, which is determined by converting the sensor data into a
meaningful analyte value. User output can be in the form of a numeric
estimated analyte value, an indication of directional trend of analyte
concentration, and/or a graphical representation of the estimated analyte
data over a period of time, for example. Other representations of the
estimated analyte values are also possible, for example audio and
tactile.
[0427]In some embodiments, annotations are provided on the graph; for
example, bitmap images are displayed thereon, which represent events
experienced by the host. For example, information about meals,
medications, insulin, exercise, sensor insertion, sleep, and the like,
can be obtained by the receiver (by user input or receipt of a
transmission from another device) and displayed on the graphical
representation of the host's glucose over time. It is believed that
illustrating a host's life events matched with a host's glucose
concentration over time can be helpful in educating the host to his or
her metabolic response to the various events.
[0428]In yet another alternative embodiment, the sensor utilizes one or
more additional electrodes to measure an additional analyte. Such
measurements can provide a baseline or sensitivity measurement for use in
calibrating the sensor. Furthermore, baseline and/or sensitivity
measurements can be used to trigger events such as digital filtering of
data or suspending display of data, all of which are described in more
detail in U.S. Patent Publication No. US-2005-0143635-A1.
[0429]In one exemplary embodiment, the sensor can be calibrated by a
calibration solution. For example, after the sensor system has been
inserted into the host, a calibration solution can be injected so as to
pass across the electroactive surface of the analyte-measuring electrode
and the sensor calibrated thereby. For example, the saline drip can be
changed to a known IV glucose or dextrose solution (e.g., D50--a 50%
dextrose solution, or D5W--a 5% dextrose solution). In one embodiment, a
known volume of D5W is infused into the host at a known rate over a
predetermined period of time (e.g., 5, 10, 15 or 20 minutes, or for
shorter or longer periods). During and/or after the period of infusion,
the sensor measures the signal at the analyte-measuring working
electrode. The system, knowing the specifications of the infused
calibration solution (also referred to as a calibration information in
some embodiments), can calibrate the signal to obtain host's glucose
concentration as is appreciated by one skilled in the art. In a further
embodiment, two or more glucose or dextrose solutions can be infused,
with a corresponding signal being measured during each infusion, to
provide additional data for sensor calibration. Calibration can be
performed after the sensor has first been inserted into the host, after a
break-in time, at two or more different levels (high/low), regularly,
intermittently, in response to sensor drift/shift, automatically or any
other time when calibration is required. In some alternative embodiments,
calibration can be determined during sensor break-in, such as described
in more detail elsewhere herein.
[0430]In some circumstances, catheters are flushed with saline. For
example, the analyte sensor system of the preferred embodiments can be
flushed with saline prior to application of control solutions, after
which a predetermined amount of glucose solution is flushed by the
sensor, as described above, and the sensor is calibrated there from.
[0431]In still another embodiment, a blood sample can be withdrawn from an
artery or vein, and used to calibrate the sensor, for example, by using a
hand-held glucose meter, by an automatic extracorporeal glucose sensor
such as but not limited to in conjunction with an automated bedside
clinical chemistry device, or by sending the blood sample to the clinical
laboratory for glucose analysis, after which the data is input (e.g.,
into the electronics associated with the sensor system).
[0432]In some embodiments, the sensor can be calibrated (and/or
re-calibrated) during use (after initial calibration), for example, by
withdrawing one or more blood samples (also referred to as calibration
information in some embodiments), through the catheter (see FIGS. 1 and
2) and used for calibration of the sensor, such as by measuring the
glucose concentration of the blood sample with an additional system, such
as but not limited to a hand-held glucose meter, optical methods or
additional electrochemical methods. Blood samples can be withdrawn
manually or automatically; additionally or alternatively, blood samples
are withdrawn at regular intervals or at selected times, for example,
using an extracorporeal blood analysis device as described herein.
[0433]In another embodiment of sensor calibration (and/or re-calibration)
during use, a calibration solution (e.g., 40 mg/dL equivalent glucose,
D540 or D5W) can be flushed through or by the sensor to enable
calibration of the sensor (e.g., at one time, intermittently, or
continuously), such as described in more detail above. In these
embodiments, calibration solution can be flushed manually or
automatically through the system; additionally or alternatively,
calibration solution can be flushed at regular intervals or at selected
times. In one exemplary embodiment, the system can be provided with a
dual lumen, one for saline and another for the control solution.
Additionally, the system is configured to automatically switch from the
saline to control solution and perform the real-time system calibration,
and then switch back to the saline solution.
Integrated Sensor System
System Overview
[0434]As described above, tight control of glucose levels is critical to
patient outcome in a critical care medical setting, especially for
diabetic hosts. Maintaining tight glucose control with current technology
poses an undue burden to medical personnel, due to time constraints and
the extensive patient contact required. Reducing medical staff workload
is a key component of improving patient care in this setting. The
preferred embodiments disclose systems and methods to maintaining tight
glucose control in the host while reducing and/or minimizing
staff-patient interactions. Additionally, the preferred embodiments
decrease testing intervals and improve sensor accuracy and reliability.
[0435]FIGS. 6 and 7 illustrate one preferred embodiment of the integrated
sensor system 600 (e.g., for use at the bedside), which couples to the
analyte sensor 14 (e.g., a glucose sensor) and vascular access device 12
(e.g., a catheter placed in a peripheral vein or artery) described above
(see FIGS. 1A-1E), and which includes at least one fluid reservoir 602
(e.g., a bag of calibration or IV hydration solution), a flow control
device 604 (e.g., to control delivery of an infusion fluid 602a from the
reservoir to the host via the catheter), a local analyzer 608 and a
remote analyzer 610. In some embodiments, the analyte sensor is
configured to reside within the catheter lumen 12a (see FIGS. 1A-1E). In
some embodiments, the sensor is disposed within the catheter such the
sensor does not protrude from the catheter orifice 12b. In other
embodiments, the sensor is disposed within the catheter such that at
least a portion of the sensor protrudes from the catheter orifice. In
still other embodiments, the sensor is configured to move between
protruding and non-protruding dispositions. The analyte sensor and
vascular access device used in the integrated sensor system 600 can be
any types known in the art, such as but not limited to analyte sensors
and vascular access devices described above, in the sections entitled
"Applications/Uses" and "Exemplary Sensor Configurations." For
convenience, the vascular access device 12 will be referred to as a
catheter herein. However, one skilled in the art appreciates that other
vascular access devices can be used in place of a catheter.
[0436]In some embodiments, at least one electronics module (not shown) is
included in the local and/or remote analyzers 608, 610 respectively, for
controlling execution of various system functions, such as but not
limited to system initiation, sensor calibration, movement of the flow
control device 604 from one position to another, collecting and/or
analyzing data, and the like. In preferred embodiments, the components
and functions of the electronics module can be divided into two or more
parts, such as between the local analyzer and remote analyzer, as is
discussed in greater detail in the sections entitled "Local Analyzer" and
"Remote Analyzer."
[0437]In some embodiments, the flow control device 604 includes one or
more valves and is configured to control fluid delivery to the host and
sample take-up (e.g., drawing blood back into the catheter until at least
the sensor's electroactive surfaces are contacted by the blood). In some
embodiments, the sensor 14 dwells within the lumen 12a of the catheter
12, as described elsewhere herein. In some embodiments, wherein an
internal calibration is performed, an infusion fluid (e.g., calibration
solution 602a) flows over the indwelling sensor 14 and is infused into
the host. Generally, analyte in the solution 602a can be measured when
the sensor electroactive surfaces are in contact with the solution 602a.
In some embodiments, the measurements of the solution 602a can be used to
calibrate the sensor 14. After calibration, the system is configured such
that a sample (e.g., blood or other bodily fluid) contacts the sensor's
electroactive surfaces (e.g., by drawing blood back into the catheter).
When the sample contacts the electroactive surfaces, the sample's analyte
concentration can be detected by the sensor 14. When a sample is drawn
back, the sample can then be returned to the host. In some embodiments,
the integrated sensor system 600 cycles between calibration (e.g.,
measurement of a reference calibration solution) and measurement (e.g.,
of a sample, such as blood, glucose concentration). In some embodiments,
the system 600 continues operation in this cyclical manner, until the
system 600 is either disconnected from the host or turned off for a
period of time (e.g., during movement of the host from one location to
another). For example, in one embodiment, the system 600 cycles between
the calibration and measurement steps from about every 30 seconds or less
to about every 2 hours or more. In another embodiment, the system 600
cycles between the calibration and measurement steps of from about every
2 minutes to about every 45 minutes. In still another embodiment, the
system 600 cycles between the calibration and measurement steps from
about every 1 minute to about every 10 minutes. In some embodiments, the
user can adjust the time between steps. In some embodiments, the user can
adjust the time between each step. In some embodiments, the system 600
can perform additional steps, such as but not limited to a flushing step,
a keep vein open step (KVO), an extended infusion step, and the like. In
some embodiments, the time is dependent upon sensors that detect a
reference solution (e.g., calibration solution) and/or sample (e.g.,
blood) at the electroactive surfaces.
[0438]The integrated sensor system 600 of the preferred embodiments
provides several advantages over prior art technology. Namely, in
preferred embodiments, continuous analyte monitoring is enabled. When the
analyte is glucose, continuous glucose monitoring enables tight glucose
control, which can lead to reduced morbidity and mortality among diabetic
hosts. Additionally, the medial staff is not unduly burdened by
additional patient interaction requirements. Advantageously, there is no
net sample (e.g., blood) loss for the host, which is a critical feature
in some clinical settings. For example, in a neonatal intensive care
unit, the host is extremely small and loss of even a few milliliters of
blood can be life threatening. Furthermore, returning the body fluid
sample to the host, instead of delivering to a waste container greatly
reduces the accumulation of biohazardous waste that requires special
disposal procedures. The integrated sensor system components, as well as
their use in conjunction with an indwelling analyte sensor, are discussed
in greater detail below.
Fluids
[0439]Referring to FIGS. 6 and 7, in preferred embodiments, the integrated
sensor system 600 includes at least one reservoir 602 that contains an
infusion fluid 602a, such as but not limited to reference (e.g.,
calibration), hydration and/or flushing solutions. For simplicity, the
infusion fluid 602a will be referred to herein as a solution 602a.
However, one skilled in the art recognizes that a wide variety of
infusible fluids can be used in the embodiments discussed herein.
[0440]In some embodiments, the reservoir 602 includes a container such as
but not limited to an IV bag. In other embodiments, the reservoir 602 can
include two or more IV bags, or any other sterile infusion fluid
container. In some embodiments, the reservoir 602 is a multi-compartment
container, such as but not limited to a multi-compartment IV bag. If two
or more solutions 602a (e.g., calibration solutions, flush solutions,
medication delivery solutions, etc.) are used, the solutions 602a can be
contained in two or more IV bags or in a multi-compartment IV bag, for
example. In some embodiments, it is preferred to use a single solution
602a. Use of a single solution 602a for calibration, catheter flushing
and the like simplifies the system 600 by reducing the complexity and/or
number of system 600 components required for system 600 function. In some
embodiments, two or more solutions 602a are preferred, and can be
provided by a multi-compartment IV bag or two or more separate reservoirs
602 (e.g., two or more bags, each containing a different solution 602a).
Advantageously, use of multiple solutions 602a can increase system
functionality 600 and can improve sensor accuracy.
[0441]Any infusion fluid (e.g., solution 602a) known in the art can be
used in conjunction with the present system 600. In some embodiments, the
solution 602a is an analyte-containing solution that can be used as a
reference or standard for sensor 14 calibration (generally referred to as
a calibration solution in the art). In some embodiments, a solution 602a
can be used as a flushing solution, to wash a sample off the sensor 14
and out of the catheter 12. In some embodiments, two or more solutions
602a (e.g., having different analyte concentrations) can used to provide
two or more calibration measurements. In one exemplary embodiment, the
analyte sensor 14 is a glucose sensor, and the solution 602a contains
dextrose or glucose at a concentration of from about 0 mg/dl to about 400
mg/dl. In preferred embodiments, the solution 602a contains from about 75
mg/dl to about 200 mg/dl glucose. In more preferred embodiments, the
solution 602a contains from about 100 mg/dl to about 150 mg/dl glucose.
In some embodiments, the solution 602a is an isotonic saline solution. In
some embodiments, the solution 602a contains a sufficient concentration
of an anticoagulant to substantially prevent blood clotting in and/or
near the catheter 14. In some embodiments, the solution 602a contains a
sufficient concentration of or antimicrobial to substantially prevent
infection in and/or near the catheter. In one exemplary embodiment, the
reservoir 602 is a 500 ml bag containing a sterile solution 602a
including 0.9% sodium chloride in water (e.g., normal saline), 2 IU/ml
heparin and 100 mg/dl dextrose. In another exemplary embodiment, the
reservoir 602 is a 500 ml bag containing heparinized saline.
[0442]In some embodiments, one, two or more solutions 602a can be used in
conjunction with the integrated sensor system 600. For example, in some
embodiments, two or more calibration solutions 602a (e.g., solutions with
different analyte concentrations) can be used. In one preferred
embodiment, the analyte sensor 14 is a glucose sensor and the calibration
solution 602a includes a glucose concentration of from 0 mg/dl to about
300 mg/dl or more. In one exemplary embodiment, a single calibration
solution 602a (e.g., having a 100 mg/dl glucose concentration) can be
used. In another exemplary embodiment, two calibration solutions 602a
(e.g., having 100 mg/dl and 0 mg/dl glucose concentrations) can be used.
In other exemplary embodiments, three calibration (e.g., 0 mg/dl glucose,
75 mg/dl glucose and 300 mg/dl glucose) solutions 602a can be used. In
still other embodiments, more than three calibration solutions 602a can
be used. In addition to calibration solutions 602a, non-calibration
solutions 602a can be used in conjunction with the integrated sensor
system 600, such as but not limited to intravenously administered drugs,
insulin, enzymes, nutritional fluids, and the like.
[0443]The solution 602a can be provided to the user in a variety of ways,
depending upon local hospital protocol and/or physician preference. In
some embodiments, the solution 602a is supplied pre-mixed (e.g., an IV
bag containing sodium chloride, dextrose and heparin), such that fluid
reservoir 602 can be connected to an infusion set and infused into the
host with minimal effort. In other embodiments, one or more of the
solution components 602a can be provided separately, such that the final
solution 602a is prepared at the host's bedside, at the nurse's station
or in the hospital pharmacy, for example. In one exemplary embodiment,
the solution 602a can be provided to the medical staff as a kit including
a bag of sterile solution (e.g., water) and injectable sodium chloride,
dextrose and heparin aliquots of sufficient quantity to prepare the final
solution 602a. The solution 602a can be mixed at the bedside or at a
location remote from the host, and then applied to the host and to the
integrated sensor system 600. In some embodiments, the reservoir 602 is a
500 ml or 1000 ml bag containing a sterile solution of heparinized saline
and 100 mg/dl, 150 mg/dl or 200 mg/dl glucose.
[0444]In various preferred embodiments, the solutions 602a are
administered with standard IV administration lines, such as those
commonly used today, such as a sterile, single-use IV set, referred to
herein as tubing 606. In some embodiments, the tubing 606 can be provided
with the solution(s) 602a. While in other embodiments, the tubing 606 can
be provided separately from the solution(s) 602a or other system
components. Additional system 600 components that can be provided with
the solution(s) 602a include but are not limited to a sensor 14, a
catheter 12, tubing 606, a local analyzer 608, wires/cables for hard-wire
connections between system components, and the like.
[0445]In some embodiments, multiple solutions 602a can be infused through
a multi-lumen catheter 12, such as but not limited to a two-lumen or
three-lumen catheter. In some embodiments, the sensor 14 is disposed in
one of the catheter's lumens 12a, through which one or more calibration
solutions 602a can be passed, while other fluids (e.g., hydration fluids,
drugs, nutritional fluids) to be delivered to the patient are infused
through the other catheter 12 lumens 12a (e.g., second, third or more
lumens).
[0446]In some embodiments, the reservoir 602 is held by a support 612. The
support 612 can take many forms, such as an elevated support. In some
embodiments, the support 612 is an IV pole, such those commonly used in
medical care facilities. In some embodiments, the reservoir 602 is
suspended on the support 612, and the height of the reservoir 602 can be
adjusted (e.g., raised or lowered) to modulate solution 602a discharge
from the reservoir 602.
[0447]In some embodiments, the reservoir 602 and solution 602a can be
provided with one or more system 600 components, such as in a kit. In one
exemplary embodiment, a kit including the components to mix the solution
602a can include an analyte sensor 14 and a standard infusion set (e.g.,
catheter 12, cannula, IV tubing 606, etc.). In other embodiments, a kit
can include a premixed solution 602a, with an analyte sensor 14. In
various embodiments, a kit can contain instructions for use, such as for
mixing the solution 602a and applying it to the integrated sensor system
600. Advantageously, providing either a pre-mixed solution 602a or
solution components with one or more system 600 components (e.g., sensor
14, catheter 12, tubing 606, local analyzer 608) can increase efficiency
of medical care and provide ease of use to the nursing staff
Flow Regulators
[0448]Still referring to FIGS. 6 and 7, in some embodiments, a flow
regulator 602b controls the solution 602a flow rate from the reservoir
602 to the flow control device 604, which is described below. A variety
of flow regulators can be used with the preferred embodiments, including
but not limited to pinch valves, such as rotating pinch valves and linear
pinch valves, cams and the like. In one exemplary embodiment, the flow
regulator 602b is a pinch valve, supplied with the IV set and located on
the tubing 606 adjacent to and below the drip chamber. In some
embodiments, a flow regulator 602b controls the flow rate from the
reservoir 602 to a flow control device 604, which is described in the
section entitled "Flow Control Device." In some embodiments, a flow
regulator is optional; and a flow control device 604 controls the flow
rate (e.g., from the reservoir 602 to the catheter 14, described
elsewhere herein).
Flow Control Device
[0449]In preferred embodiments, the integrated sensor system 600 includes
a flow control device 604. In some embodiments, the flow control device
604 is configured to regulate the exposure of the sensor 14 to the
solution 602a and to host sample (e.g., blood or other bodily fluid). In
some embodiments, the flow control device 604 can include a variety of
flow regulating devices, such as but not limited to valves, cams, pumps,
and the like. In one exemplary embodiment, the flow control device 604
includes a simple linear pinch valve. In another exemplary embodiment,
the flow control device 604 includes two or more linear pinch valves. In
another exemplary embodiment, the flow control device 604 includes one or
more non-linear pinch valves. In another exemplary embodiment, the flow
control device 604 includes a global valve. In still another exemplary
embodiment, the flow control device 604 includes a gate valve, such as
but not limited to a rising stem or non-rising-stem valve. In another
exemplary embodiment, the flow control device 604 includes a butterfly
valve or a ball valve. In still another exemplary embodiment, the flow
control device 604 includes a pump, such as but not limited to volumetric
infusion pumps, peristaltic pumps, piston pumps and syringe pumps. In
still other exemplary embodiments, the flow control device 604 can be
configured to vary the pressure at the reservoir 602, such as but not
limited to a pressure cuff around an IV bag and/or raising/lowering the
reservoir adjust head pressure. In some embodiments, the flow control
device 604 includes a gravity-fed valve. In still other embodiments, the
flow control device 604 is configured to use flow dynamics at the
catheter 12, to regulate exposure to the sensor to solution or sample, as
described elsewhere herein. Although some exemplary glucose sensors are
described in detail herein, the system 600 can be configured to utilize a
variety of analyte sensors including a variety of measurement
technologies, such as enzymatic, chemical, physical, electrochemical,
spectrophotometric, polarimetric, calorimetric, radiometric, and the
like.
[0450]Referring now to a preferred embodiment wherein the sensor is an
enzyme-based sensor, it is known to those skilled in the art that the
rate of an enzymatic reaction is temperature dependent. Depending upon
the enzyme, temperature reductions generally slow enzymatic reaction
rates; temperature increases generally increase reaction rates. Since the
analyte sensors 14 described in the preferred embodiment herein depend
upon an enzyme (e.g., GOX) to detect the analyte (e.g., glucose)
temperature changes during sensor calibration can result in artifacts on
the sensor signal. For example, if the solution 602a temperature is
reduced (relative to body temperature), the enzymatic reaction will
proceed at a reduced rate (relative to the rate at body temperature),
causing the solution's analyte concentration to appear artificially low,
which can result in improper sensor calibration. An improperly calibrated
sensor can aberrantly measure the analyte concentration in the sample
(e.g., blood from the host). Aberrant readings of sample analyte
concentration can lead to improper treatment decisions by the medical
staff and/or the host. The effects of temperature on enzymatic reaction
rates can be mathematically described using a temperature coefficient.
Signal artifacts caused by temperature-related reductions in enzyme
reaction rate are referred to herein as temperature coefficient
artifacts.
[0451]Generally, the host tissue in which the catheter 12 has been
implanted surrounds an in vivo portion of the catheter 12. In preferred
embodiments, the flow control device 604 is configured to pass the
solution 602a through the catheter 12 at a rate such that the solution's
temperature substantially equilibrates with the temperature of the
surrounding host tissue. In one exemplary embodiment, the flow control
device 604 maintains a flow rate of from about 0.5 .mu.l/min or less to
about 1.5 ml/min or more. In one preferred embodiment, the flow rate is
from about 1 .mu.l/min to about 1.0 ml/min. In one exemplary preferred
embodiment, the flow rate is from about 0.01 ml/min to about 0.2 ml/min.
In another exemplary preferred embodiment, the flow rate is from about
0.05 ml/min to about 0.1 ml/min. Advantageously, since the flow control
device 604 infuses the solution 602a at a rate sufficient to allow
substantial temperature equilibration with the surrounding tissue, sensor
14 accuracy is improved and the integrated sensor system 600 has
substantially no temperature coefficient artifacts.
[0452]In some alternative embodiments, a faster flow rate that does not
allow for temperature equilibration is preferred. In such circumstances,
measurement inaccuracies due to temperature coefficient can be generally
eliminated mathematically using b.sub.offset and the calibration methods
described in the section entitled "Systems and Methods for Processing
Sensor Data."
[0453]In some embodiments, sample is taken up into the same catheter lumen
12a through which the solution 602a is infused into the host (described
elsewhere herein). Thus, it is preferred that mixing of the sample and
the solution 602a is prevented. Similarly, it can be advantageous to
detect when the sensor 14 is in contact with undiluted sample and/or
undiluted solution. In some preferred embodiments of the integrated
sensor system 600, the flow control device 604 is configured to
substantially prevent mixing of two or more fluids, such as but not
limited to the solution 602a and a host sample (e.g., blood). In
preferred embodiments, mixing can be substantially prevented by a
combination of factors, including specific gravity and flow rate. It is
known that two solutions with different specific gravities tend not to
mix, provided that the fluids are moved at a sufficiently slow rate
(e.g., flow rate). Human whole blood has a specific gravity of about
1.05-1.06, while an infusion solution of 5% dextrose and 0.225% NaCl has
a specific gravity of about 1.0189. Due to the difference in specific
gravities, a blood sample and the solution 602a tend to resist mixing
within the tubing 606 when the flow rate is sufficiently slow. In
preferred embodiments, the sample and the solution 602a are moved within
the catheter lumen 12a at a rate such that substantially no mixing occurs
therebetween. In some embodiments, the flow rate is from about 0.001
ml/min or less to about 2.0 ml/min or more. In preferred embodiments, the
flow rate is from about 0.01 ml/min to about 1.0 ml/min. In one exemplary
preferred embodiment, the flow rate is from about 0.02 ml/min to about
0.35 ml/min. In another exemplary preferred embodiment, the flow rate is
from about 0.0.02 ml/min to about 0.2 ml/min. In yet another exemplary
preferred embodiment, the flow rate is from about 0.085 ml/min to about
0.2 ml/min.
[0454]In preferred embodiments, the flow control device 604 can include a
variety of fluid flow-regulating devices known in the art. In some
embodiments, the flow control device 604 includes one or more valves,
such as but not limited to linear and non-linear roller valves, linear
and non-linear pinch valves, bi-directional valves (either linear or
non-linear), peristaltic rollers, cams, combinations thereof, and the
like. In some other embodiments, the flow control device 604 is
configured to generate sufficient "head pressure" to overcome the host's
blood pressure such that the solution 602a is infused into the host at a
controlled rate; this can include elevating the fluid reservoir 602
(e.g., gravity fed) and using a valve to control the fluid flow rate out
of the reservoir 602 and into the host. In one exemplary embodiment, the
fluid flows at a maximum rate (e.g., about 6.25 ml/hr) such that a
maximum fluid volume of about 150 ml/day can be infused into the host,
however ranges much higher and/or lower can be implemented with the
preferred embodiments.
[0455]In one exemplary embodiment, the flow control device 604 is a
rotating pinch valve that has first and second positions. The valve can
move between the two positions, for example, backward and forward, and
thereby move fluids in and out of the catheter, as described in the
section entitled "Flow Control Device Function." Namely, solution 602a
can be moved from the reservoir 602, over the electroactive surfaces of
the sensor 14 and into the host; and sample can be drawn up from the
host, to cover the electroactive surfaces of the sensor 14, and then
pushed back into the host, by movement of the valve between the first and
second positions.
[0456]In one exemplary embodiment, the flow control device includes a
rotating pinch valve as described with reference to FIGS. 8A through 8C.
Although FIGS. 8A to 8C describe one implementation of a rotating pinch
valve that can be implemented with the sensor system, some alternatives
include rotating pinch valves with multiple pinch surfaces, for example
around the circumference of the rotatable axle (FIG. 8, 804), which
enables the use of one valve for multiple infusion fluids (e.g., using
multiple IV lines).
[0457]In some embodiments, the flow control device 604 includes one or
more cams that regulate the flow rate. In one embodiment, the flow
control device 604 includes a plurality of fixed orifices, which are
opened and closed by the cams. As the cams are rotated, the flow
increases and/or decreases in response. In one exemplary embodiment, the
flow control device 604 includes three openings and three cams that mate
with the openings (one cam per opening); fluid can flow through each
opening at a given rate, X ml/min. Accordingly, when the cams close all
three openings, flow is stopped. When one of the openings is opened, the
fluid flows at X ml/min. If two openings are opened, fluid flows at
2.times.ml/min. Similarly, when the three openings are opened (e.g., by
turning the cams such that they no longer close the openings), the fluid
flows at 3.times.ml/min.
[0458]In another example, the flow control device 604 includes a plurality
of cams and an equal plurality to tubes 606 passing through the cams,
such that each cam can pinch closed the tube 606 that passes through it.
In an exemplary embodiment, the cams are arranged such that they pinch
and roll the tubing 606, such that fluid is pushed into the host and
sample taken up at pre-determined rates and times. For example, the flow
control device 604 can include two cams, each having a tube 606 threaded
therethrough. The cams are arranged such that each cam pinches and rolls
the tubing 606 passing therethrough to push fluid into the host at one or
more rates and to take up a blood sample.
[0459]In yet another example, the flow control device includes a rotating
ball valve controlled by a motor, wherein the direction of the ball valve
can be utilized to control a variety of functions, such as flow direction
of the fluid.
[0460]In some embodiments, an electronics module (not shown) is
incorporated into the flow control device 604, to provide local control
over flow control device function; in these embodiments, the flow control
device function can be transmitted to the local and/or remote analyzer
for processing. In other embodiments, a remote analyzer 610 and/or
electronics module, such as but not limited to a computer system,
controls the flow control device 604. System 600 components that regulate
the flow control device 604 are discussed in greater detail elsewhere
herein.
[0461]In a further embodiment, the flow control device 604 is a computer
controlled rolling pinch valve that acts on the exterior of sterile
tubing 606 in order to control the gravity flow of a solution 602a from
an elevated fluid reservoir 602 into the host. In preferred embodiments,
the flow control device 604 is configured to pinch and roll a small
volume of tubing 606 such that a sample of host blood is drawn up into
the catheter 12 (e.g., with a sensor 14 disposed therein) for analyte
measurement, and to then push the sample back into the host with a
solution (e.g., the calibration solution 602a). In general, the flow
control device 604 is configured to oscillate between drawing up a blood
sample and allowing flow of the calibration solution 602a at a
predetermined rate. In some embodiments, the flow control device 604
includes at least one "hard stop" that ensures that the flow control
device 604 does not move to a position that could endanger and/or injure
the host, such as by draining the IV bag 602 of fluid 602a or
inappropriately (e.g., excessively) withdrawing blood, for example.
Tubing Catheter
[0462]Referring again to FIGS. 6 and 7, in preferred embodiments, the
integrated sensor system 600 includes tubing 606 (e.g., sterile tubing
configured for use in intravascular fluid infusion) and a catheter 12, to
deliver the solution 602a from the reservoir 602 to the host. Generally,
the tubing 606 and catheter 12 are sterile, single use devices generally
used in medical fluid infusion, and may be referred to as an "infusion
set." An infusion set may include additional components, such as but not
limited to a cannula or needle for implanting the catheter, sterilization
fluid (e.g., on a gauze pad) for cleaning/sterilizing the insertion site
(e.g., the host's skin), tape, gauze, and the like. IV tubing is
available in a variety of sizes and configurations, which find use in the
preferred embodiments. For example, the tubing can be any size internal
diameter, such as from about 0.5 mm to about 5 mm internal diameter. In
various embodiments, the tubing can include a drip chamber and/or one or
more access devices, such as but not limited to stopcocks, diaphragms and
the like.
[0463]Catheters 12 are available in a variety of sizes and configurations.
Catheters 12 for use in conjunction with an analyte sensor 14 are
described in detail, elsewhere herein. Briefly, the catheter 12 can be
any single- or multi-lumen catheter having a straight or divided tubing
connector (e.g., straight-through, single shut off, double shut off,
non-spill couplings, valves, T-connectors, Y-connectors, X-connectors,
pinch clamps, leur locks, back-flow valves, and the like). In some
embodiments, the catheter 12 is configured with an integrally formed
sensor 14. In alternative embodiments, a non-integral sensor 14 is
configured for insertion into the catheter 12 after catheter insertion.
In some embodiments, the catheter 12 is a single lumen catheter that is
configured for infusion of a fluid. In preferred embodiments, an
indwelling sensor 14 is disposed within the catheter's lumen 12a. In some
embodiments, the catheter 12 and sensor 14 are provided to a user
together. In other embodiments, the catheter 12 and sensor 14 are
supplied separately. In an alternative embodiment, the catheter 12 is a
multi-lumen catheter configured for infusion of two or more solutions. In
preferred embodiments, a sensor 14 is disposed within one of the
catheter's multiple lumens 12a. For example, a calibration solution 602a
(e.g., 100 mg/dl glucose in saline) can be infused through the lumen 12a
in which the sensor 14 is disposed, while a hydration fluid (e.g.,
including a medication) can be infused through a second lumen.
Advantageously, a dual lumen catheter 12 allows non-interrupted system
use while other fluids are concurrently provided to the host.
[0464]In some embodiments, only the working electrode(s) of the sensor 14
are disposed within the catheter lumen 12a and the reference electrode is
disposed remotely from the working electrode(s). In other embodiments,
the sensor 14 is configured to intermittently protrude from the catheter
lumen 12a.
Sample-Contacting Sensor
[0465]In preferred embodiments, the integrated sensor system 600 is
configured such that at least the sensor's electroactive surfaces can be
exposed to a sample and the sample's analyte concentration can be
detected. Contacting the sensor 14 with the sample can be accomplished in
a variety of ways, depending upon sensor/catheter configuration. A wide
variety of catheter 12 and/or sensor 14 configurations can be implemented
in the preferred embodiments, to expose the sensor's electroactive
surfaces to a biological sample. In one exemplary embodiment, the
catheter 12 is disposed in the host's peripheral vascular system, such as
in a peripheral vein or artery, and a blood sample is taken up into the
catheter 12 such that the blood contacts the sensor's electroactive
surfaces. In another exemplary embodiment, the catheter 12 can be
disposed in the host's central vascular system or in an extracorporeal
blood flow device, such as but not limited to an arterial-venous shunt,
an extravascular blood-testing apparatus, a dialysis machine and the
like, wherein blood samples can be taken up into the catheter 12 such
that at least the sensor's electroactive surfaces are contacted by the
drawn up blood sample.
[0466]In one exemplary embodiment, the sensor 14 is configured to reside
within the catheter lumen 12a (e.g., not protrude from the catheter tip);
and the integrated sensor system 600 is configured to draw back a sample
into the catheter lumen 12a such that at least the sensor's electroactive
surfaces are contacted by the sample. In some embodiments, the sensor 14
is a small-structured sensor having a width of less than about 1 mm. In
one preferred embodiment, the sensor has a width of less than about 0.4
mm. In a more preferred embodiment, the sensor has a width of less than
about 0.2 mm. In some embodiments, the catheter 12 has an internal
diameter of from about 0.2 mm or less to about 2.0 mm or more, preferably
from about 0.5 mm to about 1.0 mm. In some embodiments, the sensor 14 is
configured such that its electroactive surfaces are at or adjacent to its
tip, and the flow control device 604 is configured to take up sample into
the catheter lumen 12a until the sample covers at least the electroactive
surfaces. In some embodiments, the electroactive surfaces are distal from
the sensor's tip and sample is drawn farther back into the catheter lumen
12a until the sample covers the electroactive surfaces. In some
embodiments, the tip of the sensor is disposed about 3 cm, 2 cm, or 1 cm
or less from a tip of the catheter.
[0467]In some embodiments, the sample taken up into the catheter's lumen
12a covers only a portion of the sensor's in vivo portion. In other
embodiments, the sample taken up into the catheter's lumen 12a covers the
entire in vivo portion of the sensor 14. In some embodiments, a sample
volume of from about 1 .mu.l or less to about 2 ml or more is taken up
into the catheter 12 and is sufficient to cover at least the
electroactive surfaces of the sensor 14. In some preferred embodiments,
the sample volume is from about 10 .mu.l to about 1 ml. In some preferred
embodiments, the sample volume is from about 20 .mu.l to about 500 .mu.l.
In other preferred embodiments, the sample volume is from about 25 .mu.l
to about 150 .mu.l. In more preferred embodiments, the sample volume is
from about 2 .mu.l to about 15 .mu.l.
[0468]In preferred embodiments, the sample taken up into the catheter's
lumen 12a remains within the in vivo portion of the catheter 12. For
example, in some embodiments, the sample is not drawn so far back into
the catheter 12 that it enters the ex vivo portion of the catheter 12,
the tubing 606 or the reservoir 602. In some embodiments, however, the
sample can be drawn back as far as the catheter but not into the IV
tubing. In some embodiments wherein the catheter 12 is implanted in a
host, the blood sample never leaves the host's body (e.g., a plane
defined by the host's skin). In some embodiments wherein the catheter 12
is implanted in an extracorporeal device, the sample does not
substantially exit the extracorporeal device. In preferred embodiments,
wherein blood is taken up into the catheter 12, the blood is returned to
the host (or extracorporeal device), which is described elsewhere herein.
In preferred embodiments, the sample is blood taken up from the host's
circulatory system and into the catheter 12 disposed within the
circulatory system.
[0469]In another exemplary embodiment of the integrated sensor system, the
sensor is configured to protrude from the catheter's orifice 12b, at
least intermittently. In preferred embodiments, the sensor is configured
to protrude sufficiently far out of the catheter's lumen 12a (e.g., into
the circulatory system proper) that the sensor's electroactive surfaces
are contacted by sample (e.g., blood). In a further embodiment, the
sensor is configured to intermittently protrude from the catheter orifice
12b, such as by moving back and forth, such that the electroactive
surfaces are alternately disposed within the catheter 12 and outside of
the catheter 12. In one exemplary embodiment of a catheter is implanted
in a host's vein, calibration solution 602a is provided within the
catheter 12 such that the sensor 14 is disposed within the catheter 12,
the sensor 14 is contacted by the calibration solution 602a and
calibration measurements can be obtained periodically, when the sensor 14
(e.g., electroactive surfaces) is moved outside of the catheter 12, the
sensor 14 is contacted by blood and blood analyte measurements can be
obtained.
[0470]In some embodiments of the integrated sensor system 600, the
catheter 12 and sensor 14 are configured to take advantage of flow
dynamics within the host's vascular system. By taking advantage of flow
dynamics, the system can be simplified, such that the flow control device
functions mainly to allow or block the flow of calibration solution.
[0471]FIG. 9 is a cut-away illustration of one exemplary embodiment, in
which a catheter 12 is implanted in a host's vessel 906, such as but not
limited to an artery or vein. The catheter 12 includes a sidewall 904
that can be configured to include one or more holes 902 (e.g., orifices
or openings configured for fluid passage, such as from the exterior
sidewall surface into the catheter lumen 12a). The catheter 12 can be
inserted into the host's vein (or artery, or an extracorporeal
circulatory device) such that the catheter points either in the direction
of blood flow (antegrade) or against the direction of blood flow
(retrograde). The catheter is configured such that in an antegrade
position, blood flows into the catheter lumen 12a via the holes 902 and
then out of the catheter orifice 12b. In a retrograde position, blood
enters the catheter lumen 12a via the catheter orifice 12b and flows out
of the lumen through the holes 902. In some embodiments, the sensor 14
can be disposed within the catheter lumen 12a such that blood flowing
between the holes 902 and the orifice 12b contacts at least the sensor's
electroactive surfaces. In some embodiments, the sensor 14 is configured
to be substantially immobile within the lumen 12a, while in other
embodiments the sensor 14 is configured to be substantially moveable
within the lumen 12a, as described in more detail elsewhere herein.
[0472]Generally, the holes 902 can be placed in any location on the
catheter's sidewall 904. In some embodiments, the holes 902 can be
located near or adjacent to the catheter orifice 12a. In other
embodiments, the holes 902 can be placed remotely from the catheter
orifice 12a. The size, shape and number of holes 902 can be selected to
optimize the sample volume and flow rate through the catheter lumen 12a.
For example, in some embodiments, the holes 902 are round, ellipsoid,
rectangular, triangular, star-shaped, X-shaped, slits, combinations
thereof, variations there of, and the like. Similarly, in some
embodiments, the catheter 12 can have from 1 to about 50 or more holes
902. In other embodiments, the catheter can have from 2 to about 10 or
more holes 902.
[0473]In some alternative embodiments, the catheter includes at least one
size wall orifice in place of an end tip orifice, which allows selective
exposure of the sensor to the host's biological sample there through. A
variety of alternative catheter configurations are contemplated in
conjunction with the preferred embodiments.
[0474]In one exemplary embodiment of the integrated sensor system 600, the
flow control device 604 is configured to intermittently block the
infusion of solution 602a through the catheter 12, which is configured
with side holes 902 as described above. Additionally, the analyte sensor
is disposed within the catheter lumen 12a such that sample passing
between the side holes 902 and the catheter orifice 12b bathes the
sensor's electroactive surfaces, during which time an analyte measurement
can be obtained. When the flow control device 604 does not block
infusion, the solution 602a contacts the sensor's electroactive surfaces;
and calibration measurements can be taken.
[0475]In some embodiments, a solution 602a can be infused into the
catheter 12 at a rate such that the flow of sample between the holes 902
and the orifice 12b is substantially blocked and at least the
electroactive surfaces are bathed in the solution 602a (e.g., undiluted
solution). In preferred embodiments, the sensor 14 can be calibrated
while it is bathed in the undiluted solution 602a.
[0476]In preferred embodiments, the sensor 14 is a small-structured sensor
with at least one electrode, such as a working electrode, as described
elsewhere herein. In some embodiments, the sensor 14 has two or more
electrodes, such as but not limited to working, reference and counter
electrodes. In some embodiments, the sensor 14 includes a reference
electrode disposed remotely from the working electrode, as discussed
elsewhere herein. In some embodiments, the sensor 14 includes two or more
electrodes that are separated by an insulator, such as described in U.S.
Patent Publication No. US-2007-0027385-A1, to Brister et al, herein
incorporated by reference in its entirety. In preferred embodiments, the
electrode is a fine wire, such as but not limited to a wire formed from
platinum, iridium, platinum-iridium, palladium, gold, silver, silver
chloride, carbon, graphite, gold, conductive polymers, alloys and the
like. In some exemplary embodiments, the sensor 14 includes one or more
electrodes formed from a fine wire with a diameter of from about 0.001 or
less to about 0.010 inches or more. Although the electrodes can by formed
by a variety of manufacturing techniques (bulk metal processing,
deposition of metal onto a substrate, and the like), it can be
advantageous to form the electrodes from plated wire (e.g., platinum on
steel wire) or bulk metal (e.g., platinum wire). It is believed that
electrodes formed from bulk metal wire provide superior performance
(e.g., in contrast to deposited electrodes), including increased
stability of assay, simplified manufacturability, resistance to
contamination (e.g., which can be introduced in deposition processes),
and improved surface reaction (e.g., due to purity of material) without
peeling or delamination.
[0477]In some embodiments, one or more electrodes are disposed on a
support, such as but not limited to a planar support of glass, polyimide,
polyester and the like. In some exemplary embodiments, the electrodes
include conductive inks and/or pastes including gold, platinum,
palladium, chromium, copper, aluminum, pyrolitic carbon, composite
material (e.g., metal-polymer blend), nickel, zinc, titanium, or an
alloy, such as cobalt-nickel-chromium, or titanium-aluminum-vanadium, and
are applied to the support using known techniques, such as but not
limited to screen-printing and plating. Additional description can be
found in U.S. Pat. No. 7,153,265, US patent publication 2006-0293576, US
patent publication 2006-0253085, U.S. Pat. No. 7,003,340, and U.S. Pat.
No. 6,261,440, all of which are incorporated in their entirety by
reference herein.
[0478]In some embodiments, an optional redundant sensor can be disposed
within the catheter lumen, in addition to the sensor 14 described
elsewhere herein. In one exemplary embodiment, a sensor 14 and a
redundant sensor are disposed within the lumen of a sensor implanted in a
host's peripheral vein, such that the electroactive surfaces of the
sensor 14 are more proximal to the catheter orifice 12b than the
electroactive surfaces of the redundant sensor; wherein blood is taken up
into the lumen 12a such that the electroactive surfaces of both the
sensor 14 and the redundant sensor are contact by the blood; such that
analyte can be detected by both the sensor 14 and the redundant sensor
and the redundant sensor measurements are used by the system 600 to
confirm the sensor's 14 measurements. In a further embodiment, both the
sensor 14 and the redundant sensor are intermittently concurrently
contacted by the solution 602a such that both the sensor 14 and the
redundant sensor can take calibration measurements of the solution 602a,
wherein the calibration measurements of the redundant sensor are at least
used to confirm the calibration measurements of the sensor 14. In another
embodiment, the calibration measurements from both the sensor 14 and the
redundant sensor are used to calibrate the sensor 14.
Local Analyzer
[0479]Referring to FIGS. 6 and 7, in some embodiments, the integrated
sensor system 600 includes a local analyzer 608 configured to operably
connect to a remote analyzer 610. In some embodiments, the local analyzer
608 is proximal to an analyte sensor 14 and the remote analyzer 610 is
configured to operably connect to the local analyzer. However,
alternative configurations are possible, such as the analyte sensor 14
can be operably connected to both the local and remote analyzers 608, 610
respectively. The remote analyzer 610 of the preferred embodiments is
discussed below. In various embodiments, one or more functions of the
local analyzer 608 can be transferred to the remote analyzer, as is
appreciated by one skilled in the art. Likewise, in some embodiments, one
or more functions of the remote analyzer 610 can be incorporated into the
local analyzer 608. In further embodiments, functions of the local and/or
remote analyzers 608, 610 can be disposed in one, two, three or more
physical bodies (e.g., separate housings), depending upon the integrated
sensor system 600 configuration and/or component combinations. For
example, in one embodiment, the local analyzer 608 includes a
potentiostat, a power source (e.g., battery or connection to an
electrical source), and data storage; and the local analyzer 608 is
configured such that the potentiostat is disposed on the sensor's fluid
coupler 20 and the remaining local analyzer 608 components are disposed
elsewhere between the local analyzer 608 and the remote analyzer 610
(e.g., connected by wiring).
[0480]Operable connections between the local and remote analyzers 608, 610
and the analyte sensor 14 can be accomplished by a hard wire (e.g., USB,
serial), RF communication, IR communication, and the like. In some
embodiments, operable connections include a connector known in the art,
such as but not limited to mating plug and socket units, screw
connectors, clips and the like. In some embodiments, the connectors are
separable. In other embodiments, the connectors are inseparable. In some
embodiments, the connectors include a lock, to prevent inadvertent
disconnection. In some embodiments, the local analyzer can be isolated
from the remote analyzer by an isolation transformer.
[0481]In some embodiments, the local analyzer 608 is operably connected to
the sensor 14 (e.g., the sensor electrode(s)), such as by a wire
connection. A detailed description of electronic components and
configurations is described elsewhere herein, for example, in the section
entitled "Sensor Electronics." In some embodiments, the local analyzer
608 is disposed on or adjacent to the sensor, such as on the sensor fluid
coupler 20. In one exemplary embodiment, the sensor's fluid coupler 20
includes a local analyzer housing that includes at least a potentiostat.
In some embodiments, the housing can include a battery and electronics,
such that the sensor 14 can be powered, and data can be collected and/or
transmitted to additional system electronics (e.g., electronics units
disposed remotely from the sensor, such as on the host's arm, on the
host's bed and in the remote analyzer, and the like). In some
embodiments, the local analyzer 608 includes a small housing that is
connected to the sensor 14 via a short wire (e.g., from about 1 cm or
less to about 10 cm or more) and is taped to the host's skin, such as
adjacent to the catheter's insertion site on the host's arm or hand. In a
further embodiment, the local analyzer 608 includes a connector, such as
but not limited to a "plug" configured to mate with a "socket" wired to
the sensor 14, such that an electrical connection can be made between the
local analyzer 608 and the sensor 14. In another embodiment, the sensor
14 includes a cable having a plug configured to connection to the local
analyzer 608 via a socket. In still another embodiment, both the sensor
14 and the local analyzer 608 include cables configured to mate with each
other via a plug and socket mechanism. Advantageously, a detachable
configuration allows catheter/sensor insertion without a cumbersome
connection to the local analyzer 608 as well as re-use of the local
analyzer 608. In an alternative exemplary embodiment, the local analyzer
608 is permanently connected to the sensor 14 and cannot be disconnected
therefrom; a single use, permanently connected configuration can simplify
application to the host, can reduce the possibility of
cross-contamination between hosts, does not require cleaning and/or
sterilization between hosts, and can reduce operator error during
application to the host.
[0482]In preferred embodiments, the local analyzer 608 includes at least
the minimal electronic components and/or programming required to energize
the sensor 14 and collect data therefrom, such as but not limited to a
potentiostat. However, in some embodiments, the local analyzer 608
includes additional electronic components that can be programmed to
analyze one or more components of the collected raw signal, or to store
data, calibration information, a patient ID and the like. In one
exemplary embodiment, the local analyzer 608 includes a potentiostat and
a battery back up. The battery back up can maintain a potential on the
sensor and store data (calibration and/or collected host data) for brief
periods of time when the electronics can be disconnected, such as when
the host is moved from one location to another. In one exemplary
embodiment, the local analyzer 608 is disposed on or adjacent to the
sensor 14 and is configured such that the host can be connected to a
first remote analyzer 610 at one station, and then disconnected from the
first remote analyzer 610, moved to a new location and connected to a
second remote analyzer 610 at the new location, and the local analyzer
608 retains sufficient data that the system 600 functions substantially
without initialization or substantial delay upon connection to the new
(second) remote analyzer 610. In another example, the host can be
disconnected from the first remote analyzer 610, taken to another
location for a procedure (e.g., for surgery, imaging, and the like) and
then reconnected to the first remote analyzer 610 upon return to the
original location without substantial loss of system 600 function upon
reconnection.
[0483]In some embodiments, the local analyzer 608 includes two or more
parts, such that only the potentiostat is disposed on or adjacent to the
sensor 14 (e.g., sensor fluid coupler 20) or the catheter (e.g., catheter
connector 18); other portions of the local analyzer 608 can be disposed
remotely from the host, such as in a separate housing wired to the sensor
and to the remote analyzer. In one exemplary embodiment, the two parts of
the local analyzer 608 can be separated (e.g., unplugged) such that the
host can be moved and the local analyzer 608 portion that is attached to
the host goes with the host while the remaining portion stays with the
remote analyzer 610.
[0484]In still other embodiments, all sensor electronics components are
disposed remotely from the host, such as in the remote analyzer 610. For
example, the sensor 14 can include an appropriate connector, plug and/or
wiring to connect the sensor 14 to the remote analyzer 610, which powers
the sensor 14, collects raw data from the sensor 14, calibrates the
sensor 14, analyzes and presents the data, and the like. In one example,
the sensor 14 includes a cable of sufficient length to permit plugging
the sensor 14 into a remote analyzer 610 disposed at the host's bedside.
[0485]In still other embodiments, the local analyzer 608 can be
incorporated into the remote analyzer 610, such as housed in the same
body as the remote analyzer 610, for example. In one exemplary
embodiment, both the local and remote analyzers 608, 610 are disposed in
a housing attached to a support 612 (e.g., connected to an IV pole,
placed on a bedside table, connected to the wall, clamped to the head of
the host's bed) and connected to the analyte sensor via a wire or cable.
In some embodiments, the cables/wires (e.g., for connecting the sensor to
the local analyzer and/or the remote analyzer, and/or connecting the
local analyzer to the remote analyzer) can be provided in the IV tubing
set.
Remote Analyzer
[0486]As discussed in the section entitled "Local Analyzer," the
integrated sensor system 600 includes a remote analyzer 610. In preferred
embodiment, the remote analyzer 610 is configured to at least communicate
with the local analyzer 608 and can be configured to control the flow
control device 604 described in the sections entitled "Flow Control
Device," and "Flow Control Device Function." Generally, the remote
analyzer 610 is powered from a standard 120VAC wall circuit or other
suitable power source, for example. In some embodiments, the remote
analyzer 610 is disposed at the host's bedside and can be configured to
be disposed on a support 612, such as but not limited to, mounted a
mobile IV drip pole, attached to the wall, clamped to the host's bed, or
sitting on a table or other nearby structure.
[0487]In preferred embodiments, the remote analyzer 610 includes a
display, such as but not limited to a printout, an LED display, a
monitor, a touch-screen monitor and the like. In some embodiments, the
remote analyzer 610 includes both a hard copy display, such as a printer
configured to print collected data, and a monitor. In some embodiments,
the remote analyzer 610 is a programmable touch-screen panel PC
configured to have different "screens" and "buttons" for control of
system components (e.g., the sensor 14, the flow control device 604,
etc.) and to display data, such as but not limited to host identification
and condition, host food intake, medication schedules and dosage
information, sensor identification, raw data, processed data, calibration
information, and the like, such as in tables and/or graphs. In further
preferred embodiments, the remote analyzer 610 is configured to be
programmed, such that the operator can initiate system functions such as
IV fluid line priming, starting and/or stopping the flow control device
604, select among two or more solutions (e.g., between glucose
concentrations), select the mode of data delivery (e.g., printer or
on-screen), send data to a central location (e.g., the nurse's station or
medical records), set alarms (e.g., for low and high glucose), and the
like.
[0488]In some embodiments, the system 600 is configured to integrate with
(e.g., be used in conjunction with) third party medical devices, such as
but not limited to a pulse-oxygen meter, a blood pressure meter, a blood
chemistry machine, and the like. In such embodiments, the local and/or
remote analyzers 608, 610 can be configured to communicate with the third
party medical devices, such as but not limited to a patient monitor.
Flow Control Device Function
[0489]In some embodiments, the remote analyzer 610 controls the function
of the flow control device 604. In some embodiments, the flow control
device includes electronics configured to control the flow control
device. The flow control device 604 can be configured to perform a number
of steps of operation, which are discussed below. Depending upon the
system configuration and physician preferences, in some embodiments, one
or more of the steps can be performed. In some embodiments, all of the
steps are performed. In some embodiments, the steps of operation can be
performed in the order in which they are presented herein. In other
embodiments, the order of steps of operation can be varied (e.g.,
repeated, omitted, rearranged), depending upon various parameters, such
as but not limited to the calibration solution 602a selected, the
particular infusion set selected, catheter 12 size, host condition,
analyte of interest, type of sample and location of sample collection,
integration with third party devices, additional infusion of fluids and
the like.
[0490]FIGS. 8A through 8C are schematic illustrations of a flow control
device in one exemplary embodiment, including its relative
movement/positions and the consequential effect on the flow of fluids
through the sensor/catheter inserted in a host. In general, steps
performed by the flow control device 604, include the steps of:
contacting the sensor 14 with calibration solution 602a (including sensor
calibration) and contacting the sensor with a biological sample to be
measured. In some embodiments, additional steps can be taken, such as but
not limited to keep a vein open (KVO) step and a wash step. In the
exemplary embodiment presented in FIGS. 8A though 8C, the flow control
device 604 is a roller valve configured to move between at least two
positions, 810 and 812, respectively. Movement of the flow control device
604 between positions 810 and 812 effectively concurrently moves the
pinch point 808 (e.g., the point at which tubing 606 is pinched) between
positions 810 and 812. Additional flow control device positions are
discussed below.
[0491]The top of FIGS. 8A through 8C are schematic drawings illustrating
positions of the flow control device 604. The bottom of FIGS. 8A through
8C, are a cut-away views of an implanted catheter 12, including an
indwelling sensor 14, illustrating the corresponding activity at the
implantation site, in response to movements of the flow control device
604. For simplicity, for purposes of discussion only, it is assumed that
the catheter 12 is implanted in a host's vein, that the sensor 12 does
not protrude from the catheter's orifice 12b and that the catheter 14
does not include side holes 902. However, one skilled in the art
appreciates that the catheter 14 could be implanted into any vessel of
the host or into a variety of extracorporeal devices discussed elsewhere
herein.
[0492]Step One: Contacting Sensor with Calibration Solution
[0493]In general, the system is configured to allow a calibration solution
to contact the sensor using a flow control device such as a pump, valve
or the like. In some embodiments, such as shown in FIGS. 8A through 8C,
the flow control device 604 is a valve configured with a first structure
802 and a second structure 806. For convenience, the first structure 802
is depicted as a roller connected to a rotatable axle 804, however any
flow control device such as described in the section entitled "Flow
Control Device," can be configured to utilize the concepts and/or
functions described herein. In general, when the flow control device is a
valve, the valve is configured to allow no flow, free flow and/or metered
flow through movement of the valve between one or more discreet
positions.
[0494]In the embodiment shown in FIGS. 8A through 8C, the flow control
device 604 is configured such that a tube 606 threaded between the first
and second structures 802, 806 (e.g., between the roller and the surface
against which the roller presses) is compressed substantially closed. For
convenience, the compressed location on the tubing is referred to herein
as the "pinch point" 808. In some embodiments, the flow control device
604 is configured such that the pinch point is moved along the tubing,
either closer to or farther from the host. As the pinch point 808 is
moved closer to the host, the tube 606 is progressively compressed,
causing fluid (e.g., solution 602) to be pushed into the host's vascular
system (see the corresponding illustration of the sensor within the
host's vessel at the bottom of FIG. 8A), at the catheter 12 implantation
site. Conversely, as the pinch point 808 is moved away from the host, the
portion of tubing 606 on the host side of the pinch point 808
progressively expands, causing sample (e.g., blood) to be drawn up into
the catheter lumen 12a. In an alternative embodiment, the flow control
device 604 is configured such that the pinch point is substantially
stationary and the first and second structures selectively compress the
tubing at the pinch point (e.g., the tube 606 is either pinched fully
closed or is fully open), which either stops or allows the flow of
solution 602a.
[0495]In the exemplary embodiment shown in FIG. 8A (bottom), the catheter
12 is implanted in the host's vein 906 (or artery), as described
elsewhere herein. A sensor 14 is disposed with the catheter 12. The
catheter 12 is fluidly connected to a first end of tubing 606 that
delivers the solution 602a to the catheter 12. The solution 602a can move
out of the catheter 12 and a sample of blood 814 can move in and out of
the catheter 12, via the catheter's orifice 12b. In some alternative
embodiments, the catheter 12 includes optional sidewall holes 902 (see
FIG. 9, described elsewhere herein) and the solution 602a and blood can
move in and out of the catheter 12 via the sidewall holes 902 and the
catheter orifice 12b. In some alternative embodiments, the sensor is
configured to move in and out of the catheter. In some embodiments, the
catheter orifice 12b is disposed in the sidewall 904 (e.g., near the
catheter's tip) instead of at the tip. Tubing 606 is fluidly connected to
the reservoir 602 on a second end (see FIGS. 6 and 7).
[0496]Referring now to a calibration phase to be performed by the
exemplary valve of FIG. 8A, in preferred embodiments, the flow control
device 604 is configured to perform a step of contacting the sensor 14
with solution 602a, wherein the flow control device 604 moves from
position 810 to position 812 (e.g., forward, toward the host/catheter).
When the flow control device 604 moves from position 810 to position 812,
the pinch point 808 is moved from position 810 to position 812. As the
pinch point 808 is moved from position 810 to position 812, a first
volume of the calibration solution 602a is pushed through the tubing 606,
toward the catheter 12.
[0497]Referring again to the bottom of FIG. 8A, a second volume of the
solution 602a, which is substantially equal to the first volume, is
pushed into the host's vein 906, in response to the first volume of
solution 602a moving toward the host. As the second volume of solution
602a is pushed through the catheter 12 and into the host's vein the
second volume contacts (e.g., bathes) the analyte sensor 14, including
the analyte sensor's electroactive surfaces. In some embodiments, the
volume (e.g., the first and second volumes of fluid) moved is from about
3 .mu.l or less to about 1 ml or more. In some preferred embodiments, the
volume is from about 10 .mu.l to about 500 .mu.l, or more preferably from
about 15 .mu.l to about 50 .mu.l. In general, the volume of fluid pushed
through the catheter in a particular phase (e.g., calibration phase) is
dependent upon the timing of the phase. For example, if a long phase,
such as a 20 minute calibration phase (e.g., as compared to a shorter 5
minute phase) were selected, the volume of fluid pushed during the long
phase would be 4.times. greater than the volume of fluid pushed during
the shorter phase. Accordingly, one skilled in the art appreciates that
the above described ranges of fluids infusion can be increased and/or
decreased simply be increasing or decreasing the measurement phase and/or
intervals (i.e., timing). In preferred embodiments, the fluid is moved at
a flow rate that is sufficiently slow that the calibration solution's
temperature substantially equilibrates with the temperature of the tissue
surrounding the in vivo portion of the catheter and/or temperature of
bodily fluid (e.g., blood). In preferred embodiments, the flow rate is
from about 0.25 .mu.l/min or less to about 10.0 ml/min or more. In one
exemplary embodiment, the flow control device 604 maintains a flow rate
from about 0.5 .mu.l/min or less to about 1.5 ml/min or more. In one
preferred exemplary embodiment, the flow rate is from about 1 .mu.l/min
to about 1.0 ml/min. In one exemplary preferred embodiment, the flow rate
is from about 0.01 ml/min to about 0.2 ml/min. In another exemplary
preferred embodiment, the flow rate is from about 0.05 ml/min to about
0.1 ml/min.
[0498]In some embodiments, the system is configured such that the speed of
the movement between the first and second discreet positions is regulated
or metered to control the flow rate of the fluid through the catheter. In
some embodiments, the system is configured such that the time of movement
between the first and second discreet positions is from about 0.25 to 30
seconds, preferably from about 0.5 to 10 seconds. In some embodiments,
the system is configured such that an amount of pinch of the tubing
regulates the flow rate of the fluid through the catheter. In some
embodiments, the fluid flow is regulated through a combination of
metering and/or pinching techniques, for example. Depending on the type
of flow control device (e.g., valve), a variety of methods of metering
and/or regulating the flow rate can be implemented as is appreciated by
one skilled in the art.
[0499]Preferably, the sensor is configured to measure a signal associated
with the solution (e.g., analyte concentration) during the movement of
the flow control device from position 810 to position 812 and/or during
contact of the sensor 14 with the solution 602a. Electronics, such as an
electronic module included in either the local or remote analyzer 608,
610 controls signal measurement and processing, such as described in more
detail elsewhere herein.
[0500]In general, a calibration measurement can be taken at any time
during the flow control device 604 movement from position 810 to position
812, and including a stationary (stagnant) time there after. In some
embodiments, one or more calibration measurements are taken at the
beginning of the flow control device 604 movement from position 810 to
position 812. In other embodiments, one or more calibration measurements
are taken at some time in the middle of the flow control device 604
movement from position 810 to position 812. In some embodiments, one or
more calibration measurements are taken near the completion of the flow
control device 604 movement from position 810 to position 812. In some
embodiments, one or more calibration measurements are taken after
completion of the flow control device 604 movement from position 810 to
position 812. In still other embodiments, the flow control device is
positioned such that fluid can flow followed by positioning the flow
control device such that there is no fluid flow (e.g., 0 ml/min) during
the calibration measurement. In preferred embodiments, one or more
calibration measurements are taken when the temperature of the solution
602a has substantially equilibrated with the temperature of the tissue
surrounding the in vivo portion of the implanted catheter 12. Processing
of calibration measurements and sensor calibration are described
elsewhere herein.
[0501]Step Two: Sample Collection and Measurement
[0502]In general, the system is configured to allow a sample (e.g., blood)
to contact the sensor using the flow control device. Referring now to the
top of FIG. 8B, the flow control device 604 is configured to draw back
(or take-in) a sample (e.g., blood) from the host. For example, to
collect a sample, the flow control device 604 reverses and moves backward
(e.g., away from the host/catheter), from position 812 to position 810,
thereby causing the pinch point 808 to move away from the host. As the
pinch point is moved from position 812 to position 810, the tube 606 (on
the host side of the pinch point 808) expands (e.g., the tube volume
increases).
[0503]Referring now to the bottom of FIG. 8B, as the tube volume
increases, a small, temporary vacuum is created, causing sample 814
(e.g., blood) to be taken up into the catheter lumen 12a. In some
embodiments, the flow control device 604 is configured to take up a
sufficient volume of sample 814 such that at least the sensor's
electroactive surfaces are contacted by the sample 814. In some
embodiments, a sample volume of from about 1 .mu.l or less to about 2 ml
or more is taken up into the catheter 12 and is sufficient to cover at
least the electroactive surfaces of the sensor 14. In some preferred
embodiments, the sample volume is from about 10 .mu.l to about 1 ml. In
some preferred embodiments, the sample volume is from about 20 .mu.l to
about 500 .mu.l. In other preferred embodiments, the sample volume is
from about 25 .mu.l to about 150 .mu.l. In more preferred embodiments,
the sample volume is from about 2 .mu.l to about 15 .mu.l.
[0504]In some embodiments, the sample taken up into the catheter is taken
up substantially no farther than the skin (or a plane defined by the skin
of the patient). In some embodiments, the sample is taken up into the
catheter substantially no farther than the catheter's inner lumen (e.g.,
substantially not into the IV tubing.)
[0505]In some embodiments, the rate of sample take-up is sufficiently slow
that the temperature of the sample substantially equilibrates with the
temperature of the surrounding tissue. Additionally, in some embodiments,
the rate of sample take-up is sufficiently slow such that substantially
no mixing of the sample 814 and solution 602a occurs. In some
embodiments, the flow rate is from about 0.001 ml/min or less to about
2.0 ml/min or more. In preferred embodiments, the flow rate is from about
0.01 ml/min to about 1.0 ml/min. In one exemplary preferred embodiment,
the flow rate is from about 0.02 ml/min to about 0.35 ml/min. In another
exemplary preferred embodiment, the flow rate is from about 0.0.02 ml/min
to about 0.2 ml/min. In yet another exemplary preferred embodiment, the
flow rate is from about 0.085 ml/min to about 0.2 ml/min.
[0506]As described above, in some embodiments, the system is configured
such that the speed of the movement between the first and second discreet
positions is regulated or metered to control the flow rate of the fluid
through the catheter. In some embodiments, the system is configured such
that the time of movement between the first and second discreet positions
is from about 0.25 to 30 seconds, preferably from about 0.5 to 10
seconds. In some embodiments, the system is configured such that the time
of movement between the first and second discreet positions is from about
0.25 to 30 seconds, preferably from about 0.5 to 10 seconds. In some
embodiments, the system is configured such that an amount of pinch of the
tubing regulates the flow rate of the fluid through the catheter. In some
embodiments, regulate the fluid flow through a combination of metering
and/or pinching techniques, for example. Depending on the type of flow
control device (e.g., valve), a variety of methods of metering and/or
regulating the flow rate can be implemented as is appreciated by one
skilled in the art.
[0507]Measurements of sample analyte concentration can be taken while the
electroactive surfaces are in contact with the sample 814. An electronics
module included in the local and/or remote analyzer 608, 610 controls
sample analyte measurement, as described elsewhere herein. In some
embodiments, one sample measurement is taken. In some embodiments, a
plurality of sample measurements are taken, such as from about 2 to about
50 or more measurements and/or at a sample rate of between about 1
measurement per second and about 1 measurement per minute. In some
embodiments, the rate is from about 1 measurement per 2 seconds to about
1 measurement per 30 seconds. In preferred embodiments, sample
measurements are taken substantially continuously, such as but not
limited to substantially intermittently, as described elsewhere herein.
[0508]Optional Step: Flush
[0509]In some exemplary embodiments, the flow control device 604 is
configured to perform one or more steps, in addition to steps one and
two, described above. A flush step, during which the sensor 14 and/or
catheter 12 are substantially washed and/or cleaned of host sample, is
one such optional step.
[0510]Referring now to the top of FIG. 8C, the exemplary flow control
device 604 performs a flush step by moving forward from position 810
(e.g., toward the host/catheter), past position 812 (e.g., around and
over the top of structure 804) and back to position 810. For convenience,
the movement illustrated by an arrow in the top of FIG. 8C is referred to
herein as the "flush movement."
[0511]Referring now to the bottom of FIG. 8C, the flush movement pushes
forward a volume of solution 602a (e.g., a third volume) that pushes the
collected blood sample 814 into the host. In some embodiments, the third
volume of solution 602a is substantially equal to the first and second
volumes described above. In some embodiments, the flush movement is
repeated at least one time. In some embodiments, the flush movement is
repeated two, three or more times. With the exception of the first flush
movement, which pushes the sample 814 back into the host, each repeat of
the flush movement pushes a volume of solution 602a into the host, for
example. In some embodiments, the flush movement pushes the third volume
of solution 602a into the host at a rate of from about 0.25 .mu.l/min or
less to about 10.0 ml/min or more. In preferred embodiments the flush
movement pushes the third volume of solution into the host at a rate of
from about 1.0 .mu.l/min to about 1.0 ml/min. In alternative embodiments,
the flow control device 604 is moved to a fully opened position (e.g., no
pinch) and the flow regulator 602b is set at a setting that allows more
solution (e.g., an increased volume and/or at a faster rate) to infuse
into the host than during the calibration phase (e.g., step one, above).
In preferred embodiments, the flush movement washes enough blood off of
the analyte sensor's electroactive surfaces that the sensor 14 can
measure the solution 602a substantially without any interference by any
remaining blood. In some embodiments, the flush step is incorporated into
step one, above.
[0512]Generally, the solution 602a is flushed through the catheter 12, to
ensure that a sufficient amount of the sample has been removed from the
sensor 14 and the catheter lumen 12a, such that a calibration measurement
can be taken. However, in some embodiments, sample is collected, measured
and flushed out, followed by collection of the next sample, substantially
without sensor calibration; the flush step can be executed between
samples to ensure that the sample being analyzed is substantially
uncontaminated by the previous sample. In some embodiments, a relatively
extended flush is used, while in other embodiments the flush is just long
enough to ensure no blood remains.
[0513]In some embodiments, the effectiveness of the flushing movement is
dependent upon the solution 602a composition (e.g., concentrations of
sodium chloride, glucose/dextrose, anticoagulant, etc.). Accordingly, the
amount of solution 602a required to ensure that substantially no sample
remains in the catheter 12 and/or on the sensor 14 can depend on the
solution 602a composition. For example, relatively more flush movements
may be required to completely remove all of the sample when a
non-heparinized solutions is selected than when a heparinized solution is
selected. In some embodiments, the effectiveness of the flushing movement
is also dependent upon the flush flow rate. For example, a relatively
faster flow rate can be more effective in removing sample from the sensor
than a slower flow rate, while a slower flow rate can more effectively
move a larger volume of fluid. Accordingly, in some embodiments, the
number of flush movements selected is dependent upon the calibration
solution and flow rate selected. In some embodiments, the flush step flow
rate is from about 0.25 .mu.l/min or less to about 10.0 ml/min or more,
and last for from about 10 seconds or less to about 3 minutes or more. In
one exemplary embodiment, about 0.33 ml of solution 602a is flushed at a
rate of about 1.0 ml/min, which takes about 20 seconds.
[0514]In some embodiments, the flush step returns the sample 814 (e.g.,
blood) to the host, such that the host experiences substantially no net
sample loss. Further more, the flush movement washes the sensor 14 and
catheter lumen 12a of a sufficient amount of sample, such that an
accurate calibration measurement (e.g.; of undiluted solution 602a) can
be taken during the next step of integrated sensor system 600 operations.
In some embodiments, the number of sequential flush movements is
sufficient to only wash substantially the sample from the sensor 14 and
catheter lumen 12a. In other embodiments, the number of sequential flush
movements can be extended past the number of flush movements required to
remove the sample from the sensor and catheter lumen, such as to provide
additional fluid to the host, for example.
[0515]At the completion of the flush step, the flow control device 604
returns to step one, illustrated in FIG. 8A. In some embodiments, the
steps illustrated in FIGS. 8A through 8C are repeated, until the system
600 is disconnected from the catheter/sensor, either temporarily (e.g.,
to move a host to an alternate location for a procedure) or permanently
(e.g., at patient discharge or expiration of sensor life time). In some
embodiments, additional optional steps can be performed.
[0516]Optional Step: Keep Vein Open (KVO)
[0517]Thrombosis and catheter occlusion are known problems encountered
during use of an IV system, such as when the fluid flow is stopped for a
period of time or flows at a too slow rate. For example, thrombi in, on
and/or around the catheter 12, such as at the catheter's orifice 12b can
cause an occlusion. Occlusion of the catheter can require insertion of a
new catheter in another location. It is known that a slow flow of IV
solution (e.g., saline or calibration fluid; with or without heparin) can
prevent catheter occlusion due to thrombosis. This procedure is know as
keep vein open (KVO).
[0518]In general, to infuse a fluid into a host, the infusion device must
overcome the host's venous and/or arterial pressure. For example, during
infusion of a hydration fluid, the IV bag is raised to a height such that
the head pressure (from the IV bag) overcomes the venous pressure and the
fluid flows into the host. If the head pressure is too low, some blood
can flow out of the body and in to the tubing and/or bag. This sometimes
occurs when the host stands up or raises his arm, which increases the
venous pressure relative to the head pressure. This problem can be
encountered with any fluid infusion device and can be overcome with a KVO
procedure. KVO can maintain sufficient pressure to overcome the host's
venous pressure and prevent "back flow" of blood into the tubing and/or
reservoir.
[0519]In some embodiments, the flow control device 604 can be configured
to perform a KVO step, wherein the fluid flow rate is reduced (but not
completely stopped) relative to the calibration and/or wash flow rates.
In preferred embodiments, the KVO flow rate is sufficient to prevent the
catheter 12 from clotting off and is relatively lower than the flow rate
used in step one (above). In preferred embodiments, the KVO flow rate is
sufficient to overcome the host vessel pressure (e.g., venous pressure,
arterial pressure) and is relatively lower than the flow rate used in
step one (above). In some embodiments, the KVO flow rate is from about
1.0 .mu.l/min or less to about 1.0 ml/min or more. In some preferred
embodiments, the KVO flow rate is from about 0.02 to about 0.2 ml/min. In
some more preferred embodiments, the KVO flow rate is from about 0.05
ml/min to about 0.1 ml/min). In some embodiments, the KVO flow rate is
less than about 60%, 50%, 40%, 30%, 20%, or 10% of the calibration and/or
flush flow rate(s). In some embodiments, the KVO step is performed for
from about 0.25 minutes or less to about 20 minutes or more. In preferred
embodiments, the solution 602a flows at a rate such that the temperature
of the solution 602a substantially equilibrates with the temperature of
the tissue surrounding the in vivo portion of the catheter 12.
Advantageously, equilibrating the solution 602a temperature with that of
the surrounding tissue reduces the effect of temperature on sensor 14
calibration and/or sample measurement, thereby improving sensor accuracy
and consistency. In some embodiments, the KVO step can be incorporated
into one or more of the flow control device steps of operation described
elsewhere herein, including steps one and two, and the flush step, above.
[0520]The KVO step can be executed in one or more ways. In some
embodiments, the flow control device 604 can be configured to move to at
least one addition position, wherein the tube 606 is partially pinched.
For example, the flow control device 604 is configured to move to a
position such that the pinch point 808 is partially closed/open. For
example, in the embodiment shown in FIGS. 8A through 8C, the flow control
device 604 can be moved forward somewhat past position 812, such that the
roller 802 causes the tube 606 to be partially pinched. In another
example, the flow control device 604 can be moved backwards somewhat
behind position 810, such that the roller 802 again causes the tube 606
to be partially pinched. In preferred embodiment, the amount of pinch can
be adjusted such that the desired KVO flow rate can be achieved. In some
alternative embodiments, KVO is performed by moving the flow control
device between positions 810 and 812 (e.g., see FIG. 8A) at a reduced
speed, such that the flow rate is from about 0.1 .mu.l/min or less to
about 0.5 ml/min or more. In some embodiments, the system is configured
such that the time of movement between the first and second discreet
positions is from about 0.25 to 30 seconds, preferably from about 5 to 15
seconds. In some preferred embodiments, the tubing is pinched fully
closed (e.g., between structures 802 and 806) during the movement from
position 810 and 812 (e.g., see FIG. 8A). In some preferred embodiments,
after the flow control device reaches position 812, the flow control
device flips over the top and back to position 810 (e.g., see FIG. 8C) at
a substantially rapid speed that the flow rate remains substantially
unchanged. In an even further embodiment, during the KVO step the flow
control device alternates between the slow and fast movements at least
two times, such that the KVO step lasts a period of time.
[0521]As disclosed above, the flow control device 604 can be configured a
variety of ways, which can require modifications to one or more of the
steps of operation described above. For example, in some embodiments, the
flow control device 604 can be configured to include a simple pinch
valve, wherein the valve can be configured to open, close or partially
open. In some embodiments, the flow control device 604 can be configured
to include a non-linear rolling pinch valve, wherein the roller can move
back and forth between opened, closed and partially opened positions, for
example.
[0522]In some embodiments, the flow control device 604 can include one
roller 802 (e.g., first structure) attached to an axle 804 and configured
to press against a curved surface 806 (e.g., second structure), such that
when the roller 802 is pressing against the curved surface 806 at or
between positions 810 and 812, the tubing 606 is pinched completely
closed and the flow control device 604 moves the roller 802 forward
(e.g., toward the host). In one exemplary embodiment, the flow control
device 604 can be configured to perform step one (above, contacting the
sensor 14 with solution 602a) by moving the roller 802 forward (e.g.,
rotating from position 810 to 812, see FIG. 8A), thereby causing solution
602a to flow over the sensor 14. In some embodiments, the flow control
device 604 is configured to perform step two (contacting the sensor 14
with sample) by moving the roller 802 backwards (e.g., rotating from
position 812 to 810, see FIG. 8B), causing blood 814 to enter the
catheter 12 and contact the sensor 14. Additionally, the flow control
device 604 can be configured to perform a wash or KVO step by moving the
roller 802 forward (from position 810) past position 812 and around the
axle 804 until position 810 is again reached a plurality of times
sequentially (e.g., see FIG. 8C). In a further example, the flow control
device 604 includes two, three or more rollers 802 arranged about axle
804. In some embodiments, the flow control device includes a plurality of
rollers arranged about the axle, wherein the flow control device performs
KVO by rotating the rollers about the axle a plurality of times, to
continuously push (e.g., for a period of time) the solution forward into
the host.
[0523]In one alternative embodiment, back flow can be substantially
stopped by incorporation of a one-way, pressure-controlled valve into the
system, such as at or adjacent to the catheter or sensor connector,
whereby fluid can flow into the host only when fluid pressure (e.g., head
pressure) is applied to the reservoir-side of the valve. In other words,
fluid can only flow in the direction of the host (e.g., toward the host),
not backwards towards the reservoir. In some embodiments, the valve is a
two-way valve configured such that the pressure required to open the
valve is greater than the venous pressure, such that back flow is
substantially prevented.
[0524]The preferred embodiments provide several advantages over prior art
devices. Advantageously, the movement of the solution 602a and sample
occur at a metered rate and are unaffected by changes in head pressure,
such as but not limited to when the host elevates his arm or gets up to
move around. Also, sample loss to the host is minimized, first by
returning all collected samples to the host; and second by substantially
preventing back-flow from the host (e.g., into the tubing or reservoir)
with a "hard stop" (e.g., a point beyond which the flow control device
cannot move fluid into or out of the host). For example, in one preferred
embodiment, the flow control device can be configured to deliver no more
than 25-ml of solution to the host per hour. In another exemplary
embodiment, the flow control device can be configured to draw back no
more than 100 .mu.l of blood at any time. Advantageously, the flow rate
of solution 602a and sample 814 is carefully controlled, such that both
the sample 814 and the solution 602a remain substantially undiluted.
Additionally, the solution 602a warms to the host's local body
temperature, such that the integrated sensor system 600 is substantially
unaffected by temperature coefficient and sensor 14 accuracy is
increased.
Systems and Methods for Processing Sensor Data
[0525]In general, systems and methods for processing sensor data
associated with the preferred embodiments and related sensor technologies
include at least three steps: initialization, calibration, and
measurement. Although some exemplary glucose sensors are described in
detail herein, the systems and methods for processing sensor data can be
implemented with a variety of analyte sensors utilizing a variety of
measurement technologies including enzymatic, chemical, physical,
electrochemical, spectrop
hotometric, polarimetric, calorimetric,
radiometric, and the like. Namely, analyte sensors using any known
method, including invasive, minimally invasive, and non-invasive sensing
techniques, configured to produce a data signal indicative of an analyte
concentration in a host during exposure of the sensor to a biological
sample, can be substituted for the exemplary analyte sensor described
herein.
[0526]In some embodiments, the sensor system is initialized, wherein
initialization includes application of the sensor and/or sensor system in
or on the host. In some embodiments, the sensor system includes a
computer system including programming configured for performing one or
more of the following functions: turning the system on, requesting and/or
receiving initial data (e.g., time, location, codes, etc), requesting
and/or receiving patient data (e.g., age, conditions, medications,
insulin dosing, etc), requesting and/or receiving calibration information
(e.g., manufacturer calibration lot data, reference information such as
solution(s) provided for calibration, etc.), and the like.
[0527]In some embodiments, the sensor system is configured with a
predetermined initial break-in time. In some embodiments, the sensor's
sensitivity (e.g., sensor signal strength with respect to analyte
concentration) and/or baseline can be used to determine the stability of
the sensor; for example, amplitude and/or variability of sensor
sensitivity and/or baseline may be evaluated to determine the stability
of the sensor signal. In alternative embodiments, detection of pH levels,
oxygen, hypochlorite, interfering species (e.g., ascorbate, urea, and
acetaminophen), correlation between sensor and reference values (e.g.,
R-value), and the like may be used to determine the stability of the
sensor. In some embodiments, the sensor is configured to calibrate during
sensor break-in, thereby enabling measurement of the biological sample
prior to completion of sensor break-in.
[0528]In one embodiment, systems and methods are configured to process
calibrated sensor data during sensor break-in. In general, signals
associated with a calibration and/or measurement phase of the sensor
system can be measured during initial sensor break-in. Using a rate
method of measuring an analyte (e.g., measuring the rate of change of a
step change), a sensor signal can be calibrated with a correction factor
to account for the rate of change of the break-in curve. In one exemplary
embodiment, the bottom of sequential step responses (e.g., of calibration
phases during sensor break-in) can be fit to a line or curve (e.g., using
linear or non-linear regression, such as least squares regression), to
extrapolate the rate of change of the curve of the sensor break-in.
Accordingly, the rate of change measured in a measurement phase can be
corrected to account for the rate of change of the sensor break-in curve,
and the sensor signal calibrated. By calibrating during sensor break-in,
sensor data can more quickly be provided (e.g., to the user interface)
after sensor insertion.
[0529]In some embodiments, systems and methods are configured to determine
an initial baseline value of the sensor. In general, baseline refers to a
component of an analyte sensor signal that is not substantially related
to the analyte concentration In one example of a glucose sensor, the
baseline is composed substantially of signal contribution due to factors
other than glucose (for example, interfering species,
non-reaction-related hydrogen peroxide, or other electroactive species
with an oxidation potential that overlaps with hydrogen peroxide).
[0530]In preferred embodiments, the sensor system includes a computer
system including programming configured to determine calibration
information and calibrate a signal associated with a biological sample
there from. In general, calibration of the signal includes initial
calibration, update calibration and/or re-calibration of the sensor
signal. Although some systems and methods for calibrating a sensor are
described in more detail elsewhere herein, for example in the section
entitled, "Sensor Electronics," additional and alternative methods for
providing calibration information and calibrating the sensor's signal are
provided in the following description and can be used in combination with
and/or alternative to the methods described elsewhere herein.
[0531]The term "calibration information" generally refers to any
information, such as data from an internal or external source, which
provides at least a portion of the information necessary to calibrate a
sensor. In some embodiments, calibration information includes steady
state information, such as baseline information and/or sensitivity
information obtained by processing reference data from an internal and/or
external reference source, which is described in more detail elsewhere
herein. In some embodiments, calibration information includes transient
information, such as rate of change information and/or impulse response
information obtained by processing a signal produced during exposure of
the sensor to a step change (e.g., sudden or nearly sudden change) in
analyte concentration, which is described in more detail elsewhere
herein.
[0532]In some embodiments, steady state information includes reference
data from an external source, such as an analyte sensor other than the
sensor of the sensor system configured to continuously measure the
biological sample, also referred to as external reference data or
external reference value(s). In some embodiments, calibration information
includes one, two, or more external reference values (e.g., from
self-monitoring blood glucose meters (finger stick meters), YSI Glucose
Analyzer, Beckman Glucose Analyzer, other continuous glucose sensors, and
the like). In some embodiments, one or more external reference values are
requested and/or required upon initial calibration. In some embodiments,
external reference value(s) are requested and/or required for update
calibration and/or re-calibration. In some embodiments, external
reference values are utilized as calibration information for calibrating
the sensor; additional or alternatively, external reference values can be
used to confirm the accuracy of the sensor system and/or to detect drifts
or shifts in the baseline and/or sensitivity of the sensor.
[0533]In one exemplary embodiment, at least one external reference value
in combination with at least one internal reference value together
provide calibration information useful for calibrating the sensor; for
example, sensitivity of a sensor can be determined from an external
reference value and baseline can be at least partially determined from an
internal reference value (e.g., a data signal indicative of an analyte
concentration in a reference solution during exposure of the sensor to
the reference solution, which is described in more detail elsewhere
herein).
[0534]In another exemplary embodiment, calibration information includes
two or more external reference values that provide calibration
information useful for calibrating the sensor; for example, at least two
SMBG meter values can be used to draw a calibration line using linear
regression, which is described in more detail elsewhere herein.
[0535]In yet another exemplary embodiment an external reference value is
utilized to confirm calibration information otherwise determined (e.g.,
using internal reference values).
[0536]In some embodiments, steady state information includes reference
data obtained from the analyte sensor to be calibrated, also referred to
as internal reference data or internal reference values. In one exemplary
embodiment, internal reference data includes a signal associated with
exposure of the sensor to one or more reference solutions (e.g.,
calibration solutions), which is described in more detail elsewhere
herein.
[0537]In some embodiments, the sensor system includes one or more
reference solutions (e.g., calibration solutions in some embodiments),
wherein the system is configured to expose the sensor to the one or more
reference solution(s) to provide calibration information, such as
baseline and/or sensitivity information for the sensor. In one exemplary
embodiment, a reference solution including a known analyte concentration
is provided, wherein the system is configured to expose the sensor to the
reference solution, and wherein the system is configured to produce a
data signal indicative of an analyte concentration in the reference
solution during exposure of the sensor to the reference solution, as
described in more detail elsewhere herein. In general the system can be
configured to obtain internal reference values at one or more time
points, intermittently, and/or continuously. Although much of the
description focuses on the use of a reference calibration solution to
provide an internal reference value, other sensor technologies, such as
optical sensing methods, are known to provide one or more internal
reference standards (e.g., of known absorbance, reflectance,
fluorescence, etc) to determine baseline and/or sensitivity information,
as is appreciated by one skilled in the art; accordingly, the systems and
methods described herein can be implemented with other types of internal
reference values.
[0538]In some embodiments, the sensor system is configured to use a steady
state measurement method, from which steady state information can be
obtained. Steady state information can be obtained during exposure of the
sensor to an analyte concentration when the signal has reached a
"plateau" wherein the signal is representative of the analyte
concentration; the term plateau does not limit the signal to a flat
signal, rather the plateau represents a time point or time period during
which the signal is substantially stable and a data point that represents
the analyte concentration can be reliably obtained.
[0539]FIG. 10 is a graph that schematically illustrates a signal produced
during exposure of the sensor to a step change in analyte concentration,
in one exemplary embodiment. The x-axis represents time; the y-axis
represents sensor signal (e.g., in counts). In general, a step change
occurs when a sensor is sequentially exposed to first and second
different analyte concentrations, wherein the signal (after the change
from exposure of the sensor to the first analyte concentration to
exposure of the sensor to the second analyte concentration) includes a
measurable rate of change (transient information) that subsequently
"plateaus" or substantially "plateaus" to a signal that substantially
represents the analyte concentration to which the sensor is exposed
(steady state information). As one example, a step change occurs when a
sensor is exposed to a reference solution of a first analyte
concentration and then subsequently exposed to a reference solution of a
second, different, analyte concentration. As another example, a step
change occurs when a sensor is exposed to a reference solution of a known
analyte concentration and then subsequently exposed to a biological
sample of unknown or uncalibrated analyte concentration.
[0540]Referring to FIG. 10, at a first time point 1002, a sensor is
exposed to a step change in analyte concentration, for example, from a
zero concentration reference analyte solution to a biological sample of
unknown or uncalibrated analyte concentration. During the initial signal
response to the step change, a rate of change 1004 of the signal can be
measured for a time period. In some embodiments, for example when the
step change is between two known reference solutions, the rate of change
information can provide transient information useful for calibrating the
sensor, which is described in more detail elsewhere herein. However, if
either of the first and/or second analyte concentrations of the step
response is not known, the rate of change information, alone, cannot
provide sufficient calibration information necessary to calibrate the
sensor.
[0541]Point 1006 represents a point in time that the signal response
shifts from transient information (e.g., rate of change) to steady state
information (e.g., plateau), in some embodiments. Namely, the signal,
beginning at point 1006, substantially accurately represents the analyte
concentration and can be used in steady state equations to determine an
analyte concentration, in some embodiments. In one exemplary embodiment
of steady state equations useful for calibrating the sensor system, the
calibration information is obtained by solving for the equation
y=m.times.+b, wherein: "y" represents the sensor data value (e.g.,
digitized in "counts") determined at a single point (or averaged value
over a window of data where signal is indicative of analyte
concentration, for example); "b" represents baseline (e.g., unrelated to
the analyte); "m" represents sensitivity (e.g., for a glucose sensor,
counts/mg/dL); and "x" is the concentration of the reference solution
(e.g., known analyte concentration in a reference calibration solution
(e.g., glucose in mg/dL)). In this exemplary embodiment, steady state
information includes sensitivity and baseline.
[0542]In some embodiments, the sensor data value (y) can be obtained from
a moving window that intelligently selects a plateau during exposure of
the sensor to an analyte concentration. In some embodiments, the sensor
system is configured to be exposed to two or more known reference
calibration solutions from which steady state information (sensitivity
and baseline) can be processed to calibrate the sensor system; namely, by
providing two known analyte concentrations, the steady state equation
described above can be utilized to solve for baseline and sensitivity of
the sensor, which can be utilized to define a conversion function or
calibration factor, such as described in more detail elsewhere herein.
[0543]Referring again to FIG. 10, point 1006 is a point that can be used
as "y" in the steady state equation described above. In some embodiments,
the point 1006 is easily determinable as it is the beginning of a signal
plateau 1008 (represented by a dashed line); accordingly, the system
includes programming to process the data signal to determine the signal
plateau and/or a time point therein. In general, a step change produces a
signal plateau in the signal response, which is indicative of a steady
state response to the analyte concentration measurement. In some
embodiments, the system includes programming configured determine the
time period (window) during which the signal has reached a plateau and
choose a single point or average point from that window.
[0544]In some situations, however, the point 1006 and/or plateau 1008 may
not be easily determinable. For example, in some sensor systems, the
diffusion of certain non-analyte species (e.g., baseline, background
and/or interfering species), which may diffuse more slowly than the
analyte (e.g., through a membrane system that covers the analyte sensor),
do not reach a steady state during the same time period that the analyte
reaches a steady state. In these situations, the signal may not "plateau"
in a measurable manner because of the reaction of the lagging species
through the membrane system, which generate additional signal over the
actual analyte plateau 1008. In other words, while the analyte
concentration may have reached a plateau, the baseline has not. Dashed
line 1010 represents the signal response to a step change in such a
situation, for example, wherein the signal does not substantially
"plateau" due to the lagging diffusion of certain non-analyte species,
resulting in a non-measurable analyte plateau. In these situations,
additional information is required in order to provide calibrated analyte
sensor data. Systems and methods for providing additional information
and/or to provide sufficient calibration information to calibrate an
analyte sensor in such situations are described in more detail below,
with reference to conjunctive measurements, for example.
[0545]In some embodiments, the sensor system is exposed to a reference
solution with a known analyte concentration of about zero, and wherein
the steady state information comprises baseline information about the
sensor in the reference solution. For example, a glucose sensor system
can be exposed to a 0 mg/dl glucose solution (e.g., saline solution
without any glucose concentration) and the signal associated with the
zero glucose concentration in the reference solution provides calibration
information (steady state) indicative of at least a portion of the
baseline of the sensor. However, the signal associated with the zero
glucose concentration in a reference solution (such as saline) may not be
equivalent to the baseline signal when the sensor is exposed to a
biological sample (e.g., blood) from which the sensor is configured to
obtain its analyte concentration measurement; accordingly, additional
calibration information may be required in order to determine baseline of
a biological sample (e.g., blood) in some embodiments. In some
embodiments, the calibration solution includes additional components
provided to overcome baseline in blood, for example. In some embodiments,
a factor can be determined (e.g., from historical data) to determine an
adjustment factor for a difference between baseline in the biological
sample (e.g., blood) and baseline in the reference solution. In some
embodiments, the difference in baseline of a biological sample (e.g.,
blood) and the baseline of the reference solution, also referred to as
b.sub.offset herein, can be determined using other techniques, such as
described in more detail below.
[0546]In general, the calibration information described above, including a
known baseline and sensitivity, can be used to determine a conversion
function or calibration factor applied to convert sensor data ("y") into
blood glucose data ("x"), as described in more detail elsewhere herein.
[0547]In some embodiments, systems and methods are configured to obtain
transient measurement information associated with exposure of the sensor
to a reference solution of known analyte concentration and/or a
biological fluid of unknown or uncalibrated analyte concentration. In
some embodiments, the system is configured obtain transient information
by exposing the sensor to a step change in analyte concentration and
process the rate of change of the associated signal. In some embodiments,
the system is configured to obtain transient information by exposing the
sensor to a step change in analyte concentration and processing the
impulse response of the associated signal.
[0548]In one exemplary embodiment, the sensor is exposed to a first
reference solution of a known analyte concentration and then to a second
reference solution of a known analyte concentration to determine the rate
of change of the signal response. In these embodiments, the equation
(.DELTA.y/.DELTA.t=r.DELTA.x) can be used to obtain the transient
information, wherein ".DELTA.x" is the difference between the two known
solutions that are being measured (e.g., 0 mg/dL to 100 mg/dL in an
exemplary glucose sensor), ".DELTA.y" is the measured difference between
the sensor data (e.g., in counts) corresponding to the analyte
concentration difference in known reference solutions (.DELTA.x),
".DELTA.t" is the time between the two "y" sensor measurements referenced
with .DELTA.y, and "r" represents the rate of change calibration factor,
or rate of change conversion function, that can be applied for that
particular sensor to obtain calibrated blood glucose measurements from
sensor rate of change data.
[0549]In some embodiments, transient information can be obtained from the
rate of change of a signal produced during exposure of the sensor to a
biological sample of unknown or uncalibrated analyte concentration. In
some embodiments, transient information can be obtained from the step
and/or impulse response of a signal produced during exposure of the
sensor to a step change in analyte concentration.
[0550]In some embodiments, neither steady state information, nor transient
calibration measurements are used in isolation in calibrating the sensor
system, but rather steady state and transient information are combined to
provide calibration information sufficient to calibrate sensor data such
as described in more detail, below. For example, in some embodiments,
wherein baseline is not completely known (e.g., b.sub.offset must be
determined), wherein a rate of change calibration factor is not easily
determinable (e.g., when multiple known reference solutions cannot be
pushed substantially immediately adjacent to each other to provide a rate
of change indicative of the step or impulse response), wherein the a
steady state measurement cannot be obtained (e.g., due to lagging species
affecting the analyte signal plateau), and the like. In some embodiments,
both steady state information and transient information are processed by
the system to provide sensor calibration, confirmation, and/or
diagnostics. In some embodiments, transient sensor information from
unknown or uncalibrated blood glucose measurements can be processed to
provide calibration information for the sensor system, such as described
in more detail below.
[0551]In some embodiments, once at least a portion of the calibration
information is determined, the sensor system is configured to expose the
sensor to a biological sample and measure a signal response thereto. In
some embodiments, the sensor can be continuously exposed to the
biological sample, wherein at least some external reference values are
used as calibration information for calibrating the sensor system. In
some embodiments, the sensor can be intermittently exposed to the
biological sample, wherein at least some internal reference values are
used as calibration information for calibrating the sensor system, also
referred to as auto-calibration in some exemplary embodiments.
[0552]In some embodiments, the sensor system is calibrated solely using
steady state information, such as described in more detail elsewhere
herein. In one such embodiment, the sensor system is configured to be
exposed to a biological sample and a value (y) determined from the signal
plateau, which is used in combination with a conversion function
(calibration factor) that uses steady state information (e.g.,
sensitivity and baseline) to obtain a calibrated analyte concentration
(e.g., glucose concentration in mg/dL or mmol/L) equivalent to the
measured sensor data value y.
[0553]In general, the sensor system of the preferred embodiments can be
configured to utilize any combination the steady state information (e.g.,
from external and/or internal sources) described in more detail elsewhere
herein. In some embodiments, the sensor system includes systems and
methods configured to calibrate the sensor based on one, two, or more
external reference values. In some embodiments, the sensor system
includes systems and methods configured to calibrate the sensor based on
one or more external reference values, which calibration can be confirmed
using an internal reference value (e.g., zero analyte concentration
reference solution). In some embodiments, the sensor system includes
systems and methods configured to calibrate the sensor based on one
external reference value in combination with one internal reference value
to determine baseline and sensitivity information. In some embodiments,
the sensor system includes systems and methods configured to calibrate
the sensor based on internal reference values, also referred to as
auto-calibration. In general, auto-calibration includes the use of one or
more reference solution to calibrate the sensor system. In some
embodiments, the sensor system includes systems and methods configured to
calibrate the sensor based on prior information, which is described in
more detail elsewhere herein. In some embodiments, the sensor system
includes systems and methods configured to calibrate the sensor based on
dual working electrodes, by substantially eliminating the baseline
component of the steady state calibration equation (e.g., (y=mx)).
[0554]In some embodiments, the sensor system includes systems and methods
configured to calibrate the sensor based solely on transient information
(e.g., rate of change, decay, impulse response, etc) described in more
detail elsewhere herein. In one exemplary embodiment, analyte
concentration can be determined from the change in sensor data responsive
to a step change (.DELTA.x), the time (.DELTA.t) elapsed between the
sensor data measurements .DELTA.y, and the rate of change calibration
factor/rate of change conversion function, such as described in more
detail above.
[0555]In some embodiments, the sensor system includes systems and methods
configured to calibrate the sensor based on conjunctive information,
wherein the calibration information used to calibrate the sensor system
includes both steady state information and transient information.
[0556]In one exemplary embodiment, the sensor system includes systems and
methods configured to calibrate the sensor based on a rate of change
(transient information) associated with a signal produced during exposure
of the sensor to a step change between a reference solution of known
analyte concentration (e.g., 0 mg/dl glucose) and a biological sample; in
this exemplary embodiment, a reference value (steady state information)
from an external analyte sensor (e.g., blood glucose meter) can be
obtained for the analyte concentration in the biological sample, thereby
providing sufficient information to solve for calibration using rate of
change of the signal response to the step change there between. One
advantage of using rate of change calibration methods includes its
insensitivity to baseline and interfering species.
[0557]In one preferred embodiment, a system is provided for monitoring
analyte concentration in a biological sample of a host, the system
including: a substantially continuous analyte sensor configured to
produce a data signal indicative of an analyte concentration in a host
during exposure of the sensor to a biological sample; a reference
solution including a known analyte concentration, wherein the system is
configured to expose the sensor to the reference solution, and wherein
the sensor is configured to produce a data signal indicative of an
analyte concentration in the reference solution during exposure of the
sensor to the reference solution; and a computer system including
programming configured to determine calibration information and calibrate
a signal associated with a biological sample there from, wherein the
calibration information includes steady state information and transient
information. In some embodiments, the calibration information is
determined from a signal associated with exposure of the sensor to the
reference solution and a signal associated with exposure of the sensor to
a biological sample.
[0558]One situation wherein steady state information and transient
information are useful together for calibrating a sensor system includes
a situation where a baseline measurement obtained from an internal
reference (b.sub.reference) provides only a portion of the baseline
information necessary for calibrating the sensor system. As one example,
the baseline of blood is different from the baseline of saline (e.g.,
reference) and compounds or molecules that make up the baseline in blood
can create artifacts (e.g., b.sub.offset), which can make calibration
using internally derived steady state information alone, difficult.
Namely, plateau 1008 (FIG. 10) in the signal responsive to the step
change in analyte concentration does not occur in blood, in some
embodiments, due to slow diffusion of baseline-causing
compounds/molecules to the sensor electroactive surface; instead, an
artifact 1010 (FIG. 10) is observed in the signal. Accordingly, in some
embodiments, baseline information useful for calibration of a sensor
system includes both b.sub.reference and b.sub.offset. A variety of
systems and methods of determining b.sub.offset, which can be useful in
providing calibration information and/or diagnostics and fail-safes, has
been discovered, as described in more detail elsewhere herein.
[0559]In some embodiments, b.sub.offset can be determined from transient
information derived from a signal associated with exposure of the sensor
to a biological sample, wherein the biological sample is of unknown or
uncalibrated analyte concentration.
[0560]In one preferred embodiment, a system for monitoring analyte
concentration in a biological sample of a host is provided, the system
including: a substantially continuous analyte sensor configured to
produce a data signal indicative of an analyte concentration in a host
during exposure of the sensor to a biological sample; a reference
solution including a known analyte concentration, wherein the system is
configured to expose the sensor to the reference solution, and wherein
the system is configured to produce a data signal indicative of an
analyte concentration in the reference solution during exposure of the
sensor to the reference solution; and a computer system including
programming configured to determine calibration information and calibrate
a signal associated with a biological sample there from, wherein the
calibration information is determined from a signal associated with
exposure of the sensor to the reference solution and a signal associated
with exposure of the sensor to a biological sample, wherein the
biological sample is of unknown or uncalibrated analyte concentration.
[0561]In some embodiments, systems and methods are configured to process
an impulse response of a signal associated with exposure of the sensor to
a biological sample, wherein the biological sample is of unknown or
uncalibrated analyte concentration, in order to determine an offset
between a baseline measurement associated with a reference solution and a
baseline measurement associated with a biological sample (e.g.,
b.sub.offset).
[0562]FIG. 11 is a graph that schematically illustrates a derivative of
the step response shown in FIG. 10. FIG. 11 can also be described, as the
impulse response of the signal associated when a sensor is exposed to a
step change to a biological sample of unknown or uncalibrated analyte
concentration, in one exemplary embodiment. In this embodiment, the
impulse response can be defined by a sum of two exponentials functions
(e.g., (ae.sup.-k1*t-ae.sup.-k2*t), where k1 and k2 are time constants
characteristic of the sensor), wherein the impulse response starts at 0
at t=0 and is expected to decay to 0 as t becomes large (as time passes).
The impulse response reaches a peak, shown as point 1050 in FIG. 11,
which represents the maximum rate of change of the associated signal (see
FIG. 10, for example). Additionally, although it is expected that the
signal will decay to 0 as t becomes large, FIG. 11 illustrates a plateau
1052 above the y-axis; namely, wherein the plateau 1052 does not hit 0.
[0563]It has been discovered that the positive value 1054 of the plateau
substantially represents the slope of the b.sub.offset artifact 1010
(FIG. 10). Accordingly, when the slope is drawn from t=0 of the step
response (see line 1012 of FIG. 10), the "y" value 1016 of that slope
line at the end of the step response 1014, represents b.sub.offset.
Accordingly, b.sub.offset can then be added to the equation y=m.times.+b
(where b=b.sub.reference+b.sub.offset) and a conversion function
(calibration factor) can be determined to calibrate the sensor system
(i.e., using both steady state information and transient information and
including using the signal associated with exposure of the sensor to a
biological sample of unknown or uncalibrated analyte concentration.)
[0564]In some alternative embodiments, systems and methods are configured
to process an impulse response (such as shown in FIG. 11) associated with
a step change (such as shown in FIG. 10) to determine a time point of a
steady state measurement during which an analyte concentration can be
obtained. As described above, in some circumstances, it can be difficult
to determine a steady state time point (e.g., 1006 in FIG. 10) at which
time point the signal accurately represents the analyte concentration.
Accordingly, systems and methods configured to determine the time point
(e.g., 1006 in FIG. 10) in the step response associated with exposure of
the sensor to a biological sample of unknown or uncalibrated analyte
concentration have been discovered, which time point accurately
represents the analyte concentration in the biological sample. Because
the impulse response can by defined by exponentials (discussed above),
systems and methods can be configured to process the exponential equation
(s) with variable parameters to determine a best-fit to the impulse
response curve determined from exposure of the sensor to the biological
sample. It has been discovered that this best fit of the impulse response
provides sufficient information to determine the time point 1056 (FIG.
11) at which the decay curve should have decayed to the y-intercept;
namely, the time point 1056 where the decay curve should have hit y=0
indicates the (steady state) time point in the step response (e.g., 1006
in FIG. 10) that accurately represents the analyte concentration without
the b.sub.offset artifact 1010. Accordingly, (y=m.times.+b) can then be
used to calibrate the sensor system, including the signal value "y" at
the time indicated by the extrapolated impulse response curve (e.g., and
using sensitivity and baseline information determined from one or more
reference calibration solutions, such as described in more detail
elsewhere herein.
[0565]In some other alternative embodiments, systems and methods are
configured to compare steady state information and transient information
for a plurality of time-spaced signals associated with biological samples
of unknown or uncalibrated analyte concentration to determine an offset
between a baseline measurement associated with a reference solution and a
baseline measurement associated with the biological samples.
[0566]In some exemplary embodiments, b.sub.offset is determined by
plotting level (i.e., the point at which the step response plateaus or
ends) vs. rate (i.e., maximum rate of change of the step response
determined from the peak of the impulse response curve) for a plurality
of step responses (e.g., time-spaced signals) and drawing a regression
line of the plotted points, such as described in more detail with
reference to FIG. 12.
[0567]FIG. 12 is a graph that illustrates level vs. rate for a plurality
of time-spaced signals associated with exposure of the sensor to
biological samples of unknown or uncalibrated analyte concentration. The
y-axis represents maximum rate of change for each step response; the
x-axis represents level (signal level (e.g., in counts) obtained at the
plateau of the signal and/or the end of the step response.) Each point
1080 on the plot represents level vs. rate for each of the plurality of
time-spaced signals. A regression line 1082 is drawn using known
regression methods, as is appreciated by one skilled in the art. The
point 1084 at which the line 1082 crosses the y-axis represents the
signal associated with a reference (e.g., 100 mg/dL calibration solution)
plus b.sub.offset. Accordingly, b.sub.offset can be determined by
subtracting the signal associated with the reference from the point 1084
at which the line 1082 crosses the y-axis. Thus, b.sub.offset determined
from the plot as described above, can be included in the equation
y=m.times.+b (where b=b.sub.reference+b.sub.offset) and a conversion
function (calibration factor) can be determined to calibrate the sensor
system (i.e., using both steady state information and transient
information and including using the signal associated with exposure of
the sensor to a biological sample of unknown or uncalibrated analyte
concentration.)
[0568]In some embodiments, b.sub.offset is an adjustable parameter,
wherein the sensor system includes systems and methods configured to
determine b.sub.offset with each measurement cycle (each time the sensor
is exposed to the biological sample) and to adjust the calibration factor
(conversion function), including b.sub.offset with each measurement
cycle, responsive to a change in b.sub.offset above a predetermined
threshold, and/or responsive to external information, for example.
[0569]In some embodiments, systems and methods are provided to detect a
shift in the baseline and/or sensitivity of the signal based on a
comparison of steady state information and transient information, such as
described in more detail with reference to FIG. 12. In some embodiments,
systems and methods are provided to correct for a shift in the baseline
and/or sensitivity of the signal based on a comparison of steady state
information and transient information. In some embodiments, systems and
methods are provided to initiate a calibration responsive to detection of
a shift in the baseline and/or sensitivity of the signal based on a
comparison of steady state information and transient information.
[0570]Referring again to FIG. 12, regression line 1082 is shown for a
selected plurality of time spaced signals. In some embodiments, multiple
regression lines can be drawn for a plurality of different windows of
time spaced signals (e.g., time-shifted windows). In these embodiments, a
comparison of a regression line from a first window of time spaced
signals as compared to a regression line drawn from a second window of
time spaced signals can be used to diagnose a shift and/or drift in
sensor sensitivity and/or baseline. For example, in FIG. 12, line 1082
represents a regression line drawn for a first window of data over a
first period of time; dashed line 1086 represents a regression line drawn
for a second window of data over a second period of time; and dashed line
1088 represents a regression line drawn for a third window of data over a
third period of time. In this example, dashed line 1086 is shifted along
the y-axis from the first line 1082, indicating a drift or shift in the
sensor's baseline from the first time period to the second time period;
dashed line 1088 is shifted along the x-axis from the first line 1082,
indicating a drift or shift in the sensor's sensitivity from the first
time period to the third time period. Accordingly, a shift in the
regression line can be used to diagnose a shift or drift in the sensor's
signal and can be used to trigger a corrective action, such as update
calibration and/or re-calibration using any of the methods described
herein. Additionally or alternatively, the shift in the line can be used
to correct a shift or drift in the sensor's signal; for example, the
amount of shift in the line can be used to update calibration accordingly
(e.g., the change in y-value between two regression lines can be
representative of a corresponding change in baseline between two time
periods, and the calibration information updated accordingly). One
skilled in the art appreciates that some combination of shift or drift of
the baseline and sensitivity can occur in some situations, which can be
similarly detected and/or corrected for.
Diagnostics and Fail-Safes
[0571]In some embodiments, the system includes programming configured to
diagnose a condition of at least one of the sensor and the host
responsive to calibration information. In some embodiments, the system
intermittently or continuously determines at least some calibration
information (e.g., sensitivity information, b.sub.offset, and the like),
each time the sensor is exposed to a reference solution and/or a
biological sample.
[0572]In one embodiment, systems and methods are configured to find a
plateau and/or stable window of data in response to exposure of the
sensor to at least one of a reference solution and a biological sample.
In some embodiments, if the system cannot find the plateau and/or stable
window of data, the system is configured to "fail-safe;" for example, in
some circumstances, a lack of plateau and/or stable window of data may be
indicative of dilution and/or mixture of the reference solution (e.g.,
calibration solution) with the biological sample (e.g., blood), and/or
interruption/disruption of expected/desired fluid flow. Additionally, in
some circumstances, a lack of plateau and/or stable window of data may be
indicative of interfering species in the signal.
[0573]In general, the term "fail-safe" includes modifying the system
processing and/or display of data in some manner responsive to a detected
error, or unexpected condition, and thereby avoids reporting and/or
processing of potentially inaccurate or clinically irrelevant analyte
values.
[0574]In another embodiment, systems and methods are configured to process
a signal responsive to exposure of the signal to a reference and/or
biological sample to determine whether the signal is within a
predetermined range; if the signal falls outside the range, the system is
configured to fail-safe.
[0575]In some embodiments, systems and methods are configured to determine
calibration information including sensitivity information, wherein the
system includes programming configured to diagnose an error responsive to
a change in sensitivity above a predetermined amount. For example, in a
sensor system as described in more detail with reference to the exemplary
embodiment of FIGS. 8A to 8C, the system can be configured to determine a
sensitivity value during each calibration phase; and wherein the system
can be configured to fail-safe when the sensitivity of a calibration
phase differs from the previously stored sensitivity by more than a
predetermined threshold. In this exemplary embodiment, fail-safe can
include not using the sensitivity information to update calibration, for
example. While not wishing to be bound by theory, the predetermined
threshold described above allows for drift in the sensitivity of the
sensor, but prevents large fluctuations in the sensitivity values, which
may be caused by noise and/or other errors in the system.
[0576]In some embodiments, systems and methods are configured to diagnose
error in the sensor system by ensuring the sensor signal (e.g., raw
signal of the reference solution(s)) is within a predetermined range. In
some embodiments, the sensor signal must be within a predetermined range
of raw values (e.g., counts, current, etc). In some embodiments, one or
more boundary lines can be set for a regression line drawn from the
calibration phase. For example, subsequent to performing regression, the
resulting slope and/or baseline are tested to determine whether they fall
within a predetermined acceptable threshold (boundaries). These
predetermined acceptable boundaries can be obtained from in vivo or in
vitro tests (e.g., by a retrospective analysis of sensor sensitivities
and/or baselines collected from a set of sensors/patients, assuming that
the set is representative of future data). Co-pending U.S. patent
application Ser. No. 11/360,250, filed on Feb. 22, 2006 and entitled,
"ANALYTE SENSOR," which is incorporated herein by reference in its
entirety, describes systems and methods for drawing boundaries lines. In
some embodiments, different boundaries can be set for different reference
solutions.
[0577]In some embodiments, systems and methods are configured for
performing diagnostics of the sensor system (e.g., continuously or
intermittently) during exposure of the sensor to a biological sample,
also referred to as the measurement phase, for example, such as described
in more detail above with reference to FIGS. 8A to 8C. In some
embodiments, diagnostics includes determination and/or analysis of
b.sub.offset. In some embodiments, systems and methods are provided for
comparing sequential b.sub.offset values for sequential measurement
phases. In some embodiments, the system includes programming configured
to diagnose an error and fail-safe responsive to a change in the
b.sub.offset above a predetermined amount. In some embodiments, the
system includes programming configured to re-calibrate the sensor
responsive to changes in the b.sub.offset above a predetermined amount.
In some embodiments, the system includes programming configured to detect
an interfering species responsive to a change in the b.sub.offset above a
predetermined amount.
[0578]In some embodiments, the system includes programming configured to
diagnose a condition of the host's metabolic processes responsive to a
change in b.sub.offset above a predetermined amount. In some embodiments,
the system includes programming configured to display or transmit a
message associated with the host's condition responsive to diagnosing the
condition. While not wishing to be bound by theory, it is believed that
changes in b.sub.offset can be the result of an increase (or decrease) in
metabolic by-products (electroactive species), which may be a result of
wounding, inflammation, or even more serious complications in the host;
accordingly, changes in b.sub.offset can be useful in diagnosing changes
in the host's health condition.
[0579]In some embodiments, the system includes programming configured to
detect sensor error, noise on the sensor signal, failure of the sensor,
changes in baseline, and the like, responsive to a change in b.sub.offset
above a predetermined amount.
[0580]In some embodiments, the system includes programming configured to
determine a time constant of the sensor. One method of calculating a time
constant for a sensor includes determining an impulse response to a step
change, wherein time at the peak of the impulse response represents a
time constant for the sensor. While not wishing to be bound by theory, it
is believed that the time constant determined from the peak of the
impulse response should remain substantially the same throughout the life
of the sensor. However, if a shift in the time constant (between step
changes and their associated impulse response curves) above a
predetermined range is detected, it can be indicative of an unexpected
sensor condition or error, for example. Accordingly, by comparing time
constants from a plurality of impulse response curves (derived from a
plurality of step responses), programming can be configured to diagnose a
sensor condition or error and initiate programming (e.g., fail-safe),
accordingly.
[0581]Accordingly, the system can "fail-safe," including performing one or
more of the following fail-safe responses: temporarily or permanently
suspending (e.g., discontinuing) display of analyte data, updating
calibration or re-calibrating the sensor, requesting external reference
values, using external reference value(s) as confirmation of a detected
condition, using external reference value(s) to update calibration or
re-calibrate the sensor, shutting the system down, processing the sensor
data to compensate for the change in b.sub.offset, transmitting one or
more messages to the user interface or other external source regarding
the sensor condition, and the like.
Auto-Calibration
[0582]Some preferred embodiments are configured for auto-calibration of
the sensor system, wherein "auto-calibration" includes the use of one or
more internal references to calibrate the sensor system. In some
embodiments, auto-calibration includes systems and methods configured to
calibrate the sensor based solely on internal reference values. However,
in some alternative embodiments of auto-calibration, one or more external
reference values can be used to complement and/or confirm calibration of
the sensor system.
[0583]In some preferred embodiments, the system is configured to
intermittently expose the sensor to a biological sample; however
configurations of the sensor system that allow continuous exposure of the
sensor to the biological sample are contemplated. In some embodiments,
the system is configured to intermittently or periodically expose the
sensor to a reference, however configurations of the sensor system that
allow one or more independent or non-regular reference measurements
initiated by the sensor system and/or a user are contemplated. In the
exemplary embodiment of a sensor system such as described with reference
to FIGS. 8A to 8C, the system is configured to cycle between a
measurement phase and calibration phase (with optional other phases
interlaced therein (e.g., flush and KVO)).
[0584]In general, timing of auto-calibration can be driven by a variety of
parameters: preset intervals (e.g., clock driven) and/or triggered by
events (such as detection of a biological sample at a sensor). In some
embodiments, one or more of the phases are purely clock driven, for
example by a system configured to control the timing housed within a flow
control device, remote analyzer, and/or other computer system. In some
embodiments, one or more of the phases are driven by one or more events,
including: exposure of the sensor to a biological sample (e.g., blood)
exposure of sensor to a reference (e.g., calibration solution),
completion of calibration measurement, completion of analyte measurement,
stability of signal measurement, sensor for detecting a biological
sample, and the like.
[0585]In one exemplary embodiment, calibration and measurement phases are
driven by cleaning of sensor; namely, systems and methods are configured
to detect when the sensor is in the biological sample and/or in the
reference solution (e.g., calibration solution), wherein the system is
configured to switch to appropriate phase responsive to detection of that
sample/solution.
[0586]In another exemplary embodiment, an AC signal is placed on top of a
DC signal (e.g., in an amperometric electrochemical analyte sensor),
wherein systems and methods are configured to analyze an impedance
response to the AC signal and detect a biological sample thereby.
[0587]In yet another exemplary embodiment, systems and methods are
configured for analyzing the sensor's signal, wherein a change from a
known reference solution (e.g., a known analyte concentration) can be
detected on the signal, and the switch from the calibration phase to the
measurement phase occur responsive thereto; similarly, the system can be
configured to switch back to the calibration phase responsive to
detection of the known signal value associated with the reference
solution.
[0588]In yet another exemplary embodiment, systems and methods are
configured to switch between phases responsive to one or more sensors
configured to detect the biological sample and/or reference solution at a
particular location.
[0589]In some embodiments, the sensor system is partially or fully
controlled by a clock (e.g., predetermined time intervals), which timing
can be confirmed by any of the events (e.g., triggers or sensors)
described above.
[0590]In one exemplary embodiment, systems and methods are provided to
enable auto-calibration of an integrated glucose sensor system with
minimal user interaction. In this exemplary embodiment, the integrated
sensor system is provided with the components described above, including
a fluids bag, a flow control device, IV tubing, a flow control device, a
remote analyzer, a local analyzer and a sensor/catheter, for example. At
system start-up, a health care worker inserts the catheter and sensor
into a host and injects a first reference solution (e.g., zero glucose
saline solution) into the IV tubing, wherein the system is configured to
allow a predetermined time period (e.g., 20 minutes) for the first
reference solution to pass through the IV tubing and into the catheter.
Subsequently, the health care worker couples the fluids bag to the IV
tubing, wherein the fluids bag includes a second reference solution
(e.g., 100 mg/dl glucose solution) configured to follow the first
reference solution in the IV line. After injecting the first reference
solution and coupling the second reference solution, the health care
worker initiates the integrated sensor system (e.g., through the remote
analyzer touch screen) after which the integrated sensor system
automatically calibrates and functions for 24 hours without necessary
user interface (for system calibration and/or initiation). In some
embodiments, the sensor system is re-calibrated every 24 hours by
injection of a new first reference solution (e.g., zero glucose saline
solution).
[0591]In the above-described exemplary embodiment, the system is
configured to calibrate the sensor with the first and second reference
solution and using the methods described in the section entitled,
"Systems and Methods for Processing Sensor Data." Additionally, the
system is configured to automatically detect the difference in signal
associated with the first and second reference solutions, for example,
through steady state detection of a difference in signal level.
EXAMPLES
Example 1
Glucose Sensor System Trial in Dogs
[0592]Referring now to FIG. 4, glucose sensor systems of the embodiment
shown in FIG. 1 were tested in dogs. The glucose sensors were built
according to the preferred embodiments described herein. Namely, a first
sensor (Test 1) was built by providing a platinum wire, vapor-depositing
the platinum with Parylene to form an insulating coating, helically
winding a silver wire around the insulated platinum wire (to form a
"twisted pair"), masking sections of the electroactive surface of the
silver wire, vapor-depositing Parylene on the twisted pair, chloridizing
the silver electrode to form a silver chloride reference electrode, and
removing a radial window on the insulated platinum wire to expose a
circumferential electroactive working electrode surface area thereon,
this assembly also referred to as a "parylene-coated twisted pair
assembly."
[0593]An electrode domain was formed over the electroactive surface areas
of the working and reference electrodes by dip coating the assembly in an
electrode solution and drying. An enzyme domain was formed over the
electrode domain by subsequently dip coating the assembly in an enzyme
solution and drying. A resistance domain was formed over the enzyme
domain by spraying the resistance domain solution on the sensor
construct.
[0594]After the sensor was constructed, it was placed in the protective
sheath and then threaded through and attached to the fluid coupler.
[0595]A second sensor (Test 2) was constructed in the same manner as the
first, except that the silver wire was disposed within (e.g., coiled
within) the fluid coupler. Accordingly, only the platinum working
electrode (a single wire) was inserted into the catheter during the
experiment.
[0596]Prior to use, the sensors were sterilized using electron beam.
[0597]The forelimb of an anesthetized dog (2 years old, 40 pounds) was cut
down to the femoral artery and vein. An arterio-venous shunt was placed
from the femoral artery to the femoral vein using 14 gauge catheters and
1/8-inch IV tubing. A pressurized arterial fluid line was connected to
the sensor systems at all times. The test sensor systems (test 1 and test
2) included a 20 gauge.times.1.25-inch catheter and took measurements
every 30 seconds. The catheter was aseptically inserted into the shunt,
followed by insertion of the sensor into the catheter. A transcutaneous
glucose sensor (control) of the type disclosed in U.S. Publ. No.
US-2006-0155180-A1 was built and placed in the dog's abdomen according to
recommended procedures. The dog was challenged with continuous
incremental IV infusion of a 10% dextrose solution ("glucose challenge")
until the blood glucose concentration reached about 400 mg/dL.
[0598]FIG. 4 shows the experimental results. The thick line represents
data collected from the Test 1 sensor. The thin line represents data
collected from the Test 2 sensor. Diamonds represent data collected from
a hand-held blood glucose meter (SMBG) sampled from the dog's abdomen.
Raw glucose test data (counts) are shown on the left-hand Y-axle, glucose
concentrations for the "SMBG" controls are shown on the right-hand
y-axle, and time is shown on the X-axle. Each time interval on the X-axle
represents 29-minutes (e.g., 10:04 to 10:33 equals 29 minutes).
Immediately upon insertion into a catheter, each test sensor began
collecting data with substantially no sensor equilibration time (e.g.,
break-in time). Each test sensor responded to the glucose challenge
substantially similarly to the control sensor. For example, each device
shows the glucose signal increasing from about 3200 counts at 10:33 to
about 6000-6700 counts at 11:31. Then, each device showed a rapid
decrease in glucose signal, to about 4700 counts at 12:00. Additionally,
the response of the test sensors and the control sensor were
substantially similar (e.g., the majority of the test data was
substantially equivalent to the SMBG data at each time point). From these
experimental show that an indwelling glucose sensor system (as described
herein) in contact with the circulatory system can provide substantially
continuous glucose monitoring in a clinical setting.
Example 2
Glucose Sensor System Trial in Pigs
[0599]Referring now to FIG. 5, four glucose sensor systems of the
embodiment shown in FIG. 1 were tested in a pig (.about.104 lb), using
the protocol described for Example 1, above. Glucose was continuously
infused at increasing rates through a distally placed IV catheter until a
readout of 300-400 mg/dl blood glucose was achieved (total 300 ml of a
10% dextrose IV solution). FIG. 5 shows the experimental results. Lines
indicated the data from the four sensors (Test 1 through Test 4).
Diamonds represent control measurements made with a hand-held glucose
meter (SMBG). Raw glucose test data (counts) are shown on the left-hand
Y-axle, glucose concentrations for the "SMBG" controls are shown on the
right-hand y-axle, and time is shown on the X-axle. Test results show
that though the sensors varied in sensitivity, each test sensor responded
to glucose challenge substantially similarly to the control sensor
(SMBG). These experimental results show that an indwelling glucose sensor
system (of the preferred embodiments) in contact with the circulatory
system can substantially continuously track glucose in a clinical
setting.
Example 3
Glucose Sensor System with Flow Control Device Trial in Pigs
[0600]Referring now to FIG. 13, a glucose sensor was built according to
the preferred embodiments described herein. Namely, a test sensor was
built by providing a platinum wire, vapor-depositing the platinum with
Parylene to form an insulating coating, helically winding a silver wire
around the insulated platinum wire (to form a "twisted pair"), masking
sections of the electroactive surface of the silver wire,
vapor-depositing Parylene on the twisted pair, chloridizing the silver
electrode to form a silver chloride reference electrode, and removing a
radial window on the insulated platinum wire to expose a circumferential
electroactive working electrode surface area thereon, this assembly also
referred to as a "parylene-coated twisted pair assembly."
[0601]An electrode domain was formed over the electroactive surface areas
of the working and reference electrodes by dip coating the assembly in an
electrode solution and drying. An interference domain was formed over the
electrode domain by subsequently dip coating the assembly in an
interference domain solution and drying. An enzyme domain was formed over
the interference domain by subsequently dip coating the assembly in an
enzyme solution and drying. A resistance domain was formed over the
enzyme domain by spraying the resistance domain solution on the sensor
construct.
[0602]The test sensor was then located within a 20 gauge catheter and
inserted in the femoral vein of a non-diabetic pig. The catheter was
connected to an integrated sensor system 600 of the preferred
embodiments. The flow control device 604 (e.g., a roller valve as
depicted in FIGS. 8A-8C) was configured to move between steps one and
two, as described in the section entitled "Flow Control Device Function,"
above. A 107-mg/dL glucose solution was used to calibrate the sensors
(e.g., flows from the reservoir 602, through the tubing 606, to the
catheter 12). To mimic a diabetic's hyperglycemic state, a gradual
infusion of 26% dextrose was given, until the pig's blood glucose was
about 600 mg/dl. Then to mimic a hypoglycemic state, 10 U Humulin N was
given, until the pig's blood glucose was about 50 mg/dl. Then, the pig's
blood glucose was raised to about 100 mg/dl by a second 26% dextrose
infusion.
[0603]FIG. 13 is a graphical representation showing uncalibrated glucose
sensor data and corresponding blood glucose values over time in a pig.
Raw counts are represented on the left Y-axis. Glucose concentration is
shown on the right Y-axis. Time is shown on the X-axis. Test measurements
(e.g., measurements of blood glucose concentration obtained with the test
sensor, raw counts) are shown as small, black dots. Control measurements
(e.g., jugular vein blood samples analyzed on a Yellow Springs Instrument
(YSI) glucose analyzer) are shown as diamonds.
[0604]During the experiment, the system was configured to alternate
between calibration measurements (with the 107 mg/dl glucose solution)
and blood glucose measurements, as described in the sections entitled
"Step one: Contacting Sensor with Calibration Solution and Calibration"
and "Step Two: Sample Collection and Measurement," respectively.
Accordingly, as the experiment proceeded the test signal oscillated
between calibration solution (107 mg/dl) and blood glucose measurements.
The sensor (test) blood glucose measurement correlated tightly with the
control blood glucose measurements. For example, as the pig's blood
glucose concentration increased (due to infusion of glucose), so did the
test measurements, reaching about 550 mg/dl at about 12:20. Similarly, as
the pig's blood glucose concentration decreased (due to infusion of
insulin), so did the test measurements, decreasing to about 50 mg/dl at
about 14:45.
[0605]From these data, it was concluded that a glucose sensor system of
the preferred embodiments (including a valve as described with reference
to FIGS. 8A to 8C) accurately and sensitively measures intravenous
glucose concentration over a wide dynamic range.
Example 4
Glucose Sensor System with Flow Control Device Trial in Humans
[0606]Referring now to FIG. 14, a glucose sensor, constructed as described
in Example 3, and an integrated sensor system (as described in Example 3)
were tested in a volunteer, diabetic host. The flow control device was
configured as shown in FIGS. 8A-8C. The system was configured to
alternate between a calibration phase and a blood glucose measurement
phase, as described elsewhere herein. At sensor/catheter initialization,
a 0 mg/dl glucose saline solution filled syringe was injected into the IV
tubing and the fluids bag including 100 mg/dl glucose heparinized saline
solution was subsequently coupled to the tubing. The system was then
turned on (e.g., sensor initialized). The 0 mg/dl glucose saline solution
passed over the sensor, after which the 100 mg/dl glucose heparinized
saline solution subsequently passed over the sensor allowing for initial
calibration information to be collected. The system, including a flow
control device as described with reference to FIGS. 8A to 8C, then
oscillated between exposure of the sensor to a blood sample and exposure
of the sensor to the 100 mg/dl glucose heparinized saline solution. The
sensor auto-calibrated by a combination of calibration information
obtained from measurement of the 0 mg/dl-glucose and 100 mg/dl-glucose
saline solutions and the step-change-response of the sensor to the blood
sample, according to the methods described in the section entitled
"Systems and methods for Processing Sensor Data." No external
measurements (e.g., blood glucose measurements by YSI or finger stick)
were used to calibrate the system in this example. During the experiment,
the flow control device cycled between step one (measuring the 100
mg/dl-glucose solution) and step two (blood sample take up and measuring
the blood glucose concentration), such that one cycle was completed every
5-minutes. The experiment was conducted for a period of about 2.5 days.
The host followed her usual schedule of meals and insulin injections.
[0607]FIG. 14 is a graphical representation showing calibrated venous
blood glucose sensor measurements (test, black dots) and corresponding
control blood glucose measurements (YSI, large circles) over time in the
volunteer diabetic host. Glucose concentration is shown on the Y-axis and
time on the X-axis. Test measurements tracked closely with control
measurements, ranging from about 350 mg/dl, at about 10:00 and about
15:30, to about 50 mg/dl, at about 11:45. From these data, it has been
concluded that 1) the sensor calibration methods of the preferred
embodiments accurately calibrate the sensor and 2) the glucose sensor
system of the preferred embodiments accurately measures intravenous
glucose concentration over a wide dynamic range, for two or more days, in
humans.
[0608]Methods and devices that are suitable for use in conjunction with
aspects of the preferred embodiments are disclosed in U.S. Pat. No.
4,994,167; U.S. Pat. No. 4,757,022; U.S. Pat. No. 6,001,067; U.S. Pat.
No. 6,741,877; U.S. Pat. No. 6,702,857; U.S. Pat. No. 6,558,321; U.S.
Pat. No. 6,931,327; U.S. Pat. No. 6,862,465; U.S. Pat. No. 7,074,307;
U.S. Pat. No. 7,081,195; U.S. Pat. No. 7,108,778; and U.S. Pat. No.
7,110,803.
[0609]Methods and devices that are suitable for use in conjunction with
aspects of the preferred embodiments are disclosed in U.S. Patent
Publication No. US-2005-0176136-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No.
US-2005-0251083-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No. US-2005-0143635-A1; U.S.
Patent Publication No. US-2005-0181012-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No.
US-2005-0177036-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No. US-2005-0124873-A1; U.S.
Patent Publication No. US-2005-0115832-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No.
US-2005-0245799-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No. US-2005-0245795-A1; U.S.
Patent Publication No. US-2005-0242479-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No.
US-2005-0182451-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No. US-2005-0056552-A1; U.S.
Patent Publication No. US-2005-0192557-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No.
US-2005-0154271-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No. US-2004-0199059-A1; U.S.
Patent Publication No. US-2005-0054909-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No.
US-2005-0112169-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No. US-2005-0051427-A1; U.S.
Patent Publication No. US-2003-0032874-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No.
US-2005-0103625-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No. US-2005-0203360-A1; U.S.
Patent Publication No. US-2005-0090607-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No.
US-2005-0187720-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No. US-2005-0161346-A1; U.S.
Patent Publication No. US-2006-0015020-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No.
US-2005-0043598-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No. US-2003-0217966-A1; U.S.
Patent Publication No. US-2005-0033132-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No.
US-2005-0031689-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No. US-2004-0186362-A1; U.S.
Patent Publication No. US-2005-0027463-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No.
US-2005-0027181-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No. US-2005-0027180-A1; U.S.
Patent Publication No. US-2006-0020187-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No.
US-2006-0036142-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No. US-2006-0020192-A1; U.S.
Patent Publication No. US-2006-0036143-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No.
US-2006-0036140-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No. US-2006-0019327-A1; U.S.
Patent Publication No. US-2006-0020186-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No.
US-2006-0020189-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No. US-2006-0036139-A1; U.S.
Patent Publication No. US-2006-0020191-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No.
US-2006-0020188-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No. US-2006-0036141-A1; U.S.
Patent Publication No. US-2006-0020190-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No.
US-2006-0036145-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No. US-2006-0036144-A1; U.S.
Patent Publication No. US-2006-0016700-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No.
US-2006-0142651-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No. US-2006-0086624-A1; U.S.
Patent Publication No. US-2006-0068208-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No.
US-2006-0040402-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No. US-2006-0036142-A1; U.S.
Patent Publication No. US-2006-0036141-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No.
US-2006-0036143-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No. US-2006-0036140-A1; U.S.
Patent Publication No. US-2006-0036139-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No.
US-2006-0142651-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No. US-2006-0036145-A1; U.S.
Patent Publication No. US-2006-0036144-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No.
US-2006-0200022-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No. US-2006-0198864-A1; U.S.
Patent Publication No. US-2006-0200019-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No.
US-2006-0189856-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No. US-2006-0200020-A1; U.S.
Patent Publication No. US-2006-0200970-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No.
US-2006-0183984-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No. US-2006-0183985-A1; U.S.
Patent Publication No. US-2006-0195029-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No.
US-2006-0229512-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No. US-2006-0222566-A1; U.S.
Patent Publication No. US-2007-0032706-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No.
US-2007-0016381-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No. US-2007-0027370-A1; U.S.
Patent Publication No. US-2007-0027384-A1; U.S. Patent Publication No.
US-2007-0032717-A1; and U.S. Patent Publication No. US-2007-0032718 A1.
[0610]Methods and devices that are suitable for use in conjunction with
aspects of the preferred embodiments are disclosed in U.S. application
Ser. No. 09/447,227 filed Nov. 22, 1999 and entitled "DEVICE AND METHOD
FOR DETERMINING ANALYTE LEVELS"; U.S. application Ser. No. 11/515,342
filed Sep. 1, 2006 and entitled "SYSTEMS AND METHODS FOR PROCESSING
ANALYTE SENSOR DATA"; U.S. application Ser. No. 11/654,135 filed Jan. 17,
2007 and entitled "POROUS MEMBRANES FOR USE WITH IMPLANTABLE DEVICES";
U.S. application Ser. No. 11/675,063 filed Feb. 14, 2007 and entitled
"ANALYTE SENSOR"; U.S. application Ser. No. 11/543,734 filed Oct. 4, 2006
and entitled "DUAL ELECTRODE SYSTEM FOR A CONTINUOUS ANALYTE SENSOR";
U.S. application Ser. No. 11/654,140 filed Jan. 17, 2007 and entitled
"MEMBRANES FOR AN ANALYTE SENSOR"; U.S. application Ser. No. 11/654,327
filed Jan. 17, 2007 and entitled "MEMBRANES FOR AN ANALYTE SENSOR";U.S.
application Ser. No. 11/543,396 filed Oct. 4, 2006 and entitled "ANALYTE
SENSOR"; U.S. application Ser. No. 11/543,490 filed Oct. 4, 2006 and
entitled "ANALYTE SENSOR"; U.S. application Ser. No. 11/543,404 filed
Oct. 4, 2006 and entitled "ANALYTE SENSOR"; U.S. application Ser. No.
11/681,145 filed Mar. 1, 2007 and entitled "ANALYTE SENSOR"; and U.S.
application Ser. No. 11/690,752 filed Mar. 23, 2007 and entitled
"TRANSCUTANEOUS ANALYTE SENSOR".
[0611]All references cited herein, including but not limited to published
and unpublished applications, patents, and literature references, are
incorporated herein by reference in their entirety and are hereby made a
part of this specification. To the extent publications and patents or
patent applications incorporated by reference contradict the disclosure
contained in the specification, the specification is intended to
supersede and/or take precedence over any such contradictory material.
[0612]The term "comprising" as used herein is synonymous with "including,"
"containing," or "characterized by," and is inclusive or open-ended and
does not exclude additional, unrecited elements or method steps.
[0613]All numbers expressing quantities of ingredients, reaction
conditions, and so forth used in the specification are to be understood
as being modified in all instances by the term "about." Accordingly,
unless indicated to the contrary, the numerical parameters set forth
herein are approximations that may vary depending upon the desired
properties sought to be obtained. At the very least, and not as an
attempt to limit the application of the doctrine of equivalents to the
scope of any claims in any application claiming priority to the present
application, each numerical parameter should be construed in light of the
number of significant digits and ordinary rounding approaches.
[0614]The above description discloses several methods and materials of the
present invention. This invention is susceptible to modifications in the
methods and materials, as well as alterations in the fabrication methods
and equipment. Such modifications will become apparent to those skilled
in the art from a consideration of this disclosure or practice of the
invention disclosed herein. Consequently, it is not intended that this
invention be limited to the specific embodiments disclosed herein, but
that it cover all modifications and alternatives coming within the true
scope and spirit of the invention.
* * * * *